AO2 PIW Pgs-a.pm6 - Hartman Office Furniture, Inc.
Transcription
AO2 PIW Pgs-a.pm6 - Hartman Office Furniture, Inc.
Walls Introduction Walls Introduction The basic building blocks for planning with the Action Office Series 2 system are structural panels. Most often, they are connected to one another, but they can also be connected to fixed architectural walls. Series 2 panels, available powered and nonpowered, come in a wide variety of finishes, coverings, and sizes. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 3 Walls Structure Structure PAINTED PANEL TOP CAPS VERTICAL FRAME BETWEEN PANELS WIDER-PROFILE PANEL BASE Action Office Series 2 panels define and divide space, hold wall-attached components, and distribute power and voice/data cables. The panels come in a wide range of heights, widths, finishes, and types to offer a variety of design options. Series 2 panels can be attached to one another or to architectural walls but cannot be attached to Action Office Series 1 or Series 3 panels or to Ethospace® frames. Series 1 panels and connectors, when fitted with conversion base kits, are compatible with Series 2 panels and connectors. Series 2 panels have several distinguishing characteristics: They have a wider profile at the base (5/8" wider on each side of the panel run), with a 5"-high, dual-hinged side cover on each side of the cable management raceway. Series 2 panels have a painted top cap. The panels are available powered or nonpowered; either way, they are shipped complete with the cable management raceway already in place at the panel base. No additional field assembly is required to prepare the panels for immediate or future installation. Series 2 panels have the capacity to meet current and future needs for power. The panels provide access to power both at work surface height (with the cable management panel) and at the panel base. There are also channels for cabling at the base of the panels and vertically within the cable management panel. An optional panel-top voice/data cable channel can provide continuous horizontal cable management for equal-height panels, allowing separation of data cables in the panel top from electrical components or cables in the panel base. An optional cable/energy barrier is also available to provide separation within the panel base. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 4 Walls Structure Overview of Panels 1 ‡«•"-THICK PANEL 3 ⁄«¢" THICK AT BASE 1" SLOTS EVERY 1" FOR ATTACHING COMPONENTS HINGED SIDE COVERS LEVELING GLIDES (MAXIMUM 1 ‹«¢" OF HEIGHT ADJUSTABILITY) Panels Series 2 panels have slotted hanger rails for adjusting the height of wall-attached components in 1" increments. Panels are available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights and in 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. The special-purpose cable management panel is 6" wide and is available in all panel heights except 32" high. All Series 2 panels measure 1 7/8" thick with a 3 1/4"-thick panel base; this provides the distinctive, wider-base profile of this panel series. Leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the floor to the underside of the panel base.) The painted panel top cap comes with the Series 2 panel (it is not ordered separately). All panels, except for glazed and door panels, are available powered and nonpowered, with a 5"-high cable management raceway at the base with hinged side covers. On the powered panels, the side covers have removable receptacle cutouts; nonpowered panel side covers are available with or without receptacle cutouts. (Nonpowered panels can be retrofitted for power, however, using the base power adapter.) A base cover option that provides a prepunched communication port location on the left half of the base cover on each side accepts commercially available communication ports; this provides access to voice and data communications cables at the panel base. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 5 Walls Structure There are two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side in 24"-, 30"-, 36"-, 42"-, 48"-, and 60"-wide panels. There are no receptacle locations at the base in 12"- and 18"-wide panels. The cable management panel provides two receptacle locations (one on the 40"-high panel) on each side of the panel at work surface height, as well as one prepunched communication port opening at work surface height and two more near the panel base. Powered panels come with electrical harnesses already installed in the base for all connections. The powered panel is available with an optional energy/cable barrier in the base to separate the electrical system from the voice/data cables; it can also be added later in the field. POWERED PANEL HINGED SIDE COVERS ALL ELECTRICAL CONNECTIONS MADE WITH A SINGLE HARNESS OPTIONAL COMMUNICATION PORT LOCATION (1 PER SIDE) 2 RECEPTACLE LOCATIONS (PER SIDE) ON PANELS 24" WIDE OR WIDER NONPOWERED PANEL ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS AVAILABLE TO CONVERT NONPOWERED PANEL TO POWERED PANEL 5" GLIDES LOCATED UNDERNEATH BASE— 1 ‹«¢" ADJUSTMENT L SIDE COVERS AVAILABLE WITH OR WITHOUT RECEPTACLE LOCATIONS (OPTIONAL) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 6 Walls Structure Ergonomic Considerations for Panels WORK SURFACES AT VARIABLE HEIGHTS TO MEET INDIVIDUAL WORK NEEDS TACKBOARDS FOR VISUAL REMINDERS HANGING WORK SURFACES FOR FEWER FURNITURE LEGS OPEN PANEL FRAME FOR SHARED EQUIPMENT PANELS AT DIFFERENT HEIGHTS FOR DIFFERENT LEVELS OF PRIVACY AND FOR VISUAL APPEAL GLAZED PANEL FOR MORE NATURAL LIGHT IN WORKSTATION CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FOR ACCESS TO POWER AND CABLES FOR EQUIPMENT AT WORK SURFACE HEIGHT TOOL BARS AND TOOLS TO ORGANIZE WORK SLOTS AT 1" INCREMENTS FOR ADJUSTABILITY OF COMPONENTS The selection of appropriate types and sizes of Series 2 panels is important in planning for ergonomic considerations in the workplace. Work surfaces, storage, and other components are important as well. (Please note, however, that other factors— such as job design and the design of office machines and tools—are equally significant.) Because the hanger rails in Series 2 panels have slots in 1" increments, it is possible to position work surfaces, storage, and other work-organizing components within easy reach and to provide workstations that meet individual preferences for working sitting down or standing up. Vertical adjustability of work surfaces creates work environments that accommodate the needs of workers with disabilities; and hanging work surfaces eliminate furniture legs, which may cause problems for workers with limited mobility. Since Series 2 panels come in various widths, the expanse of work surfaces and the accessibility of storage can be modified for different work processes. Likewise, varying the panel heights and types can be helpful in locating hang-on components where they can easily be reached and where they can provide maximum efficiency. The varied panel heights provide design flexibility to meet the need for different levels of privacy and communication. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 7 Walls Structure Glazed panels allow workers a sense of connection to the environment outside the workspace without compromising the privacy and noise control workers need. Being able to look into the distance can also relieve the eyestrain of particularly intensive tasks, like reading, writing, or looking at a computer screen. Open panel frames can increase air circulation, especially where electronic equipment may generate intense heat. Using glazed panels and placing walls so that they block less of the natural light coming into a building can help open up interior offices to outside light. Where fullheight barriers are required for privacy or acoustics, placing them perpendicular, rather than parallel, to the windows allows more light to reach inner offices. Where office walls must run parallel to the windows, keeping walls lower and using glazed panels for higher walls still allows light to penetrate to inner offices. Clustering offices with lower walls nearer the windows and full-height private offices around the building core also allows all offices to receive light. Each of these efforts at opening up the interior to outside light can be a positive factor in employee productivity and satisfaction. Another ergonomic benefit is easy access to power and energy. Because cable management panels can be placed at any point along the panel run to bring access to electricity and telecommunications, receptacles and cable communication modules can be located at a point that is easy to reach at the work surface height, even for workers with disabilities. In addition, if equipment needs to be moved to another place on the work surface for better work flow, cable management panels can be moved to a location accessible to the equipment. Tool bars and their accessories can be used to organize work for greater accessibility, better work flow, and more work surface area. Also, marker boards and tackboards that are easily seen and reached provide a place for visual reminders without causing workers to stretch, twist, or overreach. Note: This planning guide includes comments and suggestions about how certain products may enable customers to comply with the letter and spirit of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) of 1990. While these are generally useful as guidelines, they are not all-inclusive of ADA solutions. Accommodating a worker with disabilities may require additional adaptations and applications based on the individual’s particular needs. It is recommended that, in each case, the designer work with the individual to ensure complete accommodation of those needs within the specific work process. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 8 Walls Structure Acoustical Considerations for Panels While the acoustical performance of panels is an important element in controlling sound, it is just one of many acoustical factors in the work environment. It must, therefore, be considered in relationship to those other factors that affect acoustical control—the building design itself (including ceilings, floor coverings, and window treatments), the background or ambient noise, and the overall layout of the offices. In terms of performance, there are three factors that demonstrate a panel’s acoustical properties: Noise Reduction Coefficient (NRC), Sound Transmission Class (STC), and Noise Isolation Class (NIC'). NRC Measurement NRC measures the ability to absorb sound; an NRC of at least .65 represents good acoustical ratings, with ratings of .80 or above in the optimal range. STC Measurement STC measures the ability to stop sound from being transmitted (through the panel core to the other side); an STC of at least 14 is good, with an STC of 22 or above representing optimal acoustical ratings. NRC MEASURES ABILITY TO ABSORB SOUND SOUND L STC MEASURES ABILITY TO STOP SOUND SOUND Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 9 Walls Structure NIC' Measurement NIC' measures the speech privacy afforded by panels in a typical workstation configuration; it is one of three basic interzonal rating systems that tests how all the components of a particular open-plan space function together to control sound. The rating is, in effect, a combined NRC and STC rating. At an NIC' rating of 16, 54 percent of speech is understood; at an NIC' rating of 18, 34 percent of speech is understood; at an NIC' rating of 21, only 8 percent of speech is understood. MEASURING NIC' FOR SPEECH PRIVACY IN TYPICAL WORKSTATION CONFIGURATION SOUND METER ABSORPTIVE WALLS SOUND SOURCE EXPERIMENTAL CONFIGURATION OF WORKSTATIONS SOUND MEASUREMENT LOCATIONS L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 10 Walls Structure Panel Types Action Office Series 2 panels offer a number of alternatives for controlling sound. The acoustical panel has optimal ratings for both absorbing sound and stopping its transmission (NRC rating of .80 and STC rating of 22). The fabric-covered panel is not designed to absorb sound (NRC rating of .10) as much as it is meant to stop sound (a high STC rating of 25). The tackable acoustical-barrier panel combines a high level of sound control with tackability, without sacrificing panel strength. This panel is designed to deliver different functions at different levels (zones of performance)—for example, superior acoustical control and tackability in the upper portion, where they’re most needed, and superior strength and durability in the lower portion, where they will have the most effect. The tackable acoustical-barrier panel has an NIC' rating of 23, an STC of 28, and an NRC rating of .60 in the user area (.45 across the entire panel). It is designed to provide effective sound control in environments where workstations are smaller in size, where panel heights are lower, and where there are more components and other items hanging on the panel. Depending on the acoustical needs, all three panel types may be used together to control sound. Series 2 Panel Sound-Control Performance Sound-Controlling Panels NRC Rating STC Rating NIC' Rating Acoustical Panel .80 22 — Fabric-Covered Panel .10 25 — Tackable AcousticalBarrier Panel .60 (user area) .45 (overall) 28 23 While an NIC' rating is the most relevant predictor of speech privacy in the open-plan office, it is not yet in widespread use; therefore, many panels do not carry an NIC' rating. It is important, then, to be able to effectively judge the relationship between a panel’s NRC and STC ratings and the tradeoffs they require, for it is the relative balance between the NRC and STC ratings that determines how effectively a panel can control sound. For example, a higher STC can offset the need for a higher NRC— and vice versa. In fact, a high NRC alone is not necessarily a reliable indicator of effective acoustical performance. In many situations, a lower NRC coupled with a higher STC may deliver the most effective acoustical performance. Because there is no one “ideal” relationship between the NRC and the STC, both should be taken into account for the best effect; the balance should be skewed to favor either absorption or lack of transmission—whichever is the more important objective. For example, where phone conversations may need to take place in areas with noisy equipment, NRC (sound absorption) may be the deciding factor. Where preserving the confidentiality of conversations within a workstation is important or where eliminating distractions between one workstation and the next is critical, STC (sound transmission blocking) may be the more decisive factor. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 11 Walls Structure Panel Heights In addition to the appropriate choice of panel type, the height of a panel run has a significant impact on sound control in an environment. In general, the higher the panel, the better the acoustical control. Some panel heights—32" and 39" high, for example—are not offered in an acoustical option, since the acoustical effect would be so minimal. (The exception is the tackable acoustical-barrier panel, which provides tacking capability as well as acoustical control and is available in heights from 39" to 85". This panel concentrates its sound control capabilities above work surface height, where most office sound—conversation, equipment sounds, etc.—occurs.) Component Placement The placement of components can also have an impact on a panel’s capacity for sound control. Hanging a flipper door unit on a panel, for example, decreases the amount of sound that is transmitted through the panel; hanging the flipper door unit on an acoustical panel, however, actually decreases the amount of acoustical surface readily available to absorb sound. So, the choice of panel type, the height of the panel run, and the number of components on the panels work together to affect the ability of the panel system to control sound. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 12 Walls Structure Summary of Panel Types and Sizes This chart summarizes the types of Action Office Series 2 panels available and the heights and widths in which they can be specified. Panel Type Height Hard-Surfaced Panel (A1110.) Generalpurpose divider; enameled surface Width 30" 36" 12" 18" 24" 42" 48" 60" 32" 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Fabric-Covered Panel (A1120.) Generalpurpose divider; covered in fabric 32" 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Tackable Acoustical-Barrier Panel (A1125.) For high degree of sound control and high degree of tackability and strength; different performance levels for top and bottom portions; fabric covered on both sides 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Acoustical Panel (A1130.) For reducing sound; fabric covered on both sides 53" 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Glazed Panel (A1160.) For see-through capability; translucent acrylic insert; available nonpowered only 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Open Panel Frame (A1150.) For high degree of accessibility or for shared use of equipment 62" 67" 85" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Door Panel (A1190.) For selective privacy; available with laminate or veneer door and glazed side panel; nonpowered only; lockable 85" Cable Management Panel (A1180.) For vertical distribution of electrical power and voice/data cables; consists of cable management panel frame and panel faces (A1181., A1182.) to cover each side; vinylor fabric-covered panel faces 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" L 6" ● ● ● ● ● ● ● Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 13 Walls Structure Hard-Surfaced Panel A1110. Description This structural panel has enameled surfaces, a painted top cap, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. It is UL listed and has a Class A fire-retardant rating. The powered panel has a factoryinstalled electrical harness that distributes double-sided, four-circuit power within a cable management raceway. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. 12"- and 18"wide panels have no receptacle or communication port locations. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights and 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 14 Walls Structure Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) ENAMELED SURFACE ON BOTH SIDES 1 ‡«•" This panel is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is available with or without base receptacle locations. Powered panels 12" or 18" wide have no baseline receptacle or communication port locations; powered panels 24" to 60" wide have two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side. 5" 3 ⁄«¢" The powered version of this panel comes with an electrical harness for four-circuit power already installed in the base; it is also available with an optional cable/ energy barrier between the electrical system and the voice/data cables. This barrier is also available as a separate product to retrofit a panel on site. Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. Converting a nonpowered panel to a powered panel requires a base power adapter. Extending power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to the next adjacent panel requires a panel passthrough power jumper. Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a power entry product. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 15 Walls Structure Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL DRAW ROD, OR SPACER …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. See “Determining Proper Support" in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER REQUIRES NO OTHER CONNECTOR …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 16 Walls Structure Order optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit (A1322.) • Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit (A1323.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (A1331.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted (NP239.) Order optional energy distribution components separately: • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, with Side Covers (A1354.) • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, without Side Covers (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) • Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet (G1313.) • Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet (NP289.) Order optional cable management components separately: • Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.) • Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical (AO383.) • Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel (A1380.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.–237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 17 Walls Structure Fabric-Covered Panel A1120. Description This structural panel has fabric surfaces, a painted top cap, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. It is UL listed and has a Class A fireretardant rating, except when upholstered with Customer’s Own Material (COM). The powered panel has a factoryinstalled electrical harness that distributes double-sided, four-circuit power within a cable management raceway. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. 12"- and 18"wide panels have no receptacle or communication port locations. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights and 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 18 Walls Structure Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. FABRIC COVERING ON BOTH SIDES 1 ‡«•" The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) The fabric-covered panel, while not designed specifically to control sound, has a Noise Reduction Coefficient (NRC) rating of .10 and a Sound Transmission Class (STC) rating of 25. This panel is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is available with or without base receptacle locations. 5" 3 ⁄«¢" NRC RATING OF .10, STC RATING OF 25 Powered panels 12" or 18" wide have no baseline receptacle or communication port locations; powered panels 24" to 60" wide have two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side. The powered version of this panel comes with an electrical harness for four-circuit power already installed in the base; it is also available with an optional cable/ energy barrier between the electrical system and the voice/data cables. This barrier is also available as a separate product to retrofit a panel on site. Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. Converting a nonpowered panel to a powered panel requires a base power adapter. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 19 Walls Structure Extending power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to the next adjacent panel requires a panel passthrough power jumper. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a power entry product. Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT DRAW ROD, OR SPACER …IN STRAIGHT LINE …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER REQUIRES SPACER …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 20 Walls Structure • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) Order optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit (A1322.) • Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit (A1323.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (A1331.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted (NP239.) Order optional energy distribution components separately: • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, with Side Covers (A1354.) • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, without Side Covers (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) • Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet (G1313.) • Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet (NP289.) Order optional cable management components separately: • Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.) • Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical (AO383.) • Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel (A1380.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.– 237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 21 Walls Structure Tackable Acoustical-Barrier Panel A1125. Description This structural sound-barrier panel has fabric surfaces, a painted top cap, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. The panel surface above the standard work surface height (approximately 29" from the floor) is tackable and has a Noise Reduction Coefficient (NRC) of .60. It has a Sound Transmission Class (STC) rating of 28 and is UL listed. The panel has a Class A fire-retardant rating, except when upholstered with Customer’s Own Material (COM). The powered panel has a factoryinstalled electrical harness that distributes double-sided, four-circuit power within a cable management raceway. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. 12"- and 18"wide panels have no receptacle or communication port locations. Dimensions Available in 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights and 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 22 Walls Structure Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. FABRIC COVERING ON BOTH SIDES 1 ‡«•" The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) This panel is constructed to control sound and provide tackability above the work surface and to provide structural strength and durability below the work surface height. The tackable acoustical-barrier panel has a Noise Reduction Coefficient (NRC) rating of .60 in the user area and .45 overall, a Sound Transmission Class (STC) rating of 28, and an NIC' rating of 23. 29" 5" 3 ⁄«¢" The tackable area in a tackable acoustical-barrier panel is the area above the standard work surface height—approximately 29" above the floor. For applications resulting in heavy component loading on a tackable acoustical-barrier panel (for example, where more than four load-bearing components are used), a Component Brace (A3910.) for the hanging components is recommended. For applications requiring the component brace, see “Need for Additional Support” in the “Determining Proper Support” section. NRC RATING OF .60 IN USER AREA AND .45 OVERALL, STC RATING OF 28, NIC' RATING OF 23 TACKABLE AREA OF PANEL 29" This panel is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is available with or without base receptacle locations. Powered panels 12" or 18" wide have no baseline receptacle or communication port locations; powered panels 24" to 60" wide have two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 23 Walls Structure The powered version of this panel comes with an electrical harness for four-circuit power already installed in the base; it is also available with an optional cable/energy barrier between the electrical system and the voice/data cables. This barrier is also available as a separate product to retrofit a panel on site. Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. Converting a nonpowered panel to a powered panel requires a base power adapter. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT DRAW ROD, OR SPACER …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Extending power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to the next adjacent panel requires a panel passthrough power jumper. Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a power entry product. Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. REQUIRES SPACER …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 24 Walls Structure Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) Order optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit (A1322.) • Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit (A1323.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (A1331.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted (NP239.) Order optional energy distribution components separately: • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, with Side Covers (A1354.) • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, without Side Covers (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) • Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet (G1313.) • Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet (NP289.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 25 Walls Structure Order optional cable management components separately: • Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.) • Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical (AO383.) • Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel (A1380.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.–237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) Order the Component Brace (A3910.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 26 Walls Structure Acoustical Panel A1130. Description This sound-reducing, structural panel has fabric surfaces, a painted top cap, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. It has a Noise Reduction Coefficient (NRC) rating of .80 and a Sound Transmission Class (STC) rating of 22. The panel is UL listed and has a Class A fire-retardant rating, except when upholstered with Customer’s Own Material (COM). The powered panel has a factoryinstalled electrical harness that distributes double-sided, four-circuit power within a cable management raceway. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. 12"- and 18"wide panels have no receptacle or communication port locations. Dimensions Available in 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights and 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 27 Walls Structure Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. ACOUSTICAL CONTROL ON BOTH SIDES 1 ‡«•" The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) This panel is designed for areas needing a high degree of sound reduction. This panel is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is available with or without base receptacle locations. 5" 3 ⁄«¢" NRC RATING OF .80, STC RATING OF 22 Powered panels 12" or 18" wide have no baseline receptacle or communication port locations; powered panels 24" to 60" wide have two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side. The powered version of this panel comes with an electrical harness for four-circuit power already installed in the base; it is also available with an optional cable/ energy barrier between the electrical system and the voice/data cables. This barrier is also available as a separate product to retrofit a panel on site. Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. Converting a nonpowered panel to a powered panel requires a base power adapter. Extending power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to the next adjacent panel requires a panel passthrough power jumper. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 28 Walls Structure Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a power entry product. Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT DRAW ROD, OR SPACER …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER REQUIRES SPACER …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 29 Walls Structure Order optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit (A1322.) • Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit (A1323.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (A1331.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted (NP239.) Order optional energy distribution components separately: • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, with Side Covers (A1354.) • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, without Side Covers (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) • Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet (G1313.) • Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet (NP289.) Order optional cable management components separately: • Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.) • Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical (AO383.) • Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel (A1380.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.– 237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) Limitations Acoustical panels have a more limited component load and stricter support requirements than hard-surfaced panels. (See “Determining Proper Support” for specifics.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 30 Walls Structure Glazed Panel A1160. Description This nonpowered structural panel has a painted frame and top cap, a translucent acrylic insert, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. It cannot be used as a return panel. Dimensions Available in 62", 67", and 85" heights and 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. Actual panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. GLAZED PANEL ALLOWS COMPLETE VERTICAL VISUAL ACCESS A glazed panel allows visual communication for people with a hearing impairment. The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) The glazed panel offers clear glazing for complete see-through capability or smoked glazing for translucence only. While the glazed panel allows power to pass through the base (using a passthrough power jumper) to adjacent panels, it does not allow for access to power. (Its use to distribute power may be subject to local codes.) Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a separate power entry product. Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 31 Walls Structure Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT DRAW ROD, OR SPACER REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR …AT ANGLE …IN STRAIGHT LINE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. Two glazed panels attached to one another, with load-bearing components on them, require a connector brace (Service Part No. 239842). A glazed panel attached to an open panel frame, with load-bearing components on them, requires the same connector brace. REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER REQUIRES SPACER …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 32 Walls Structure Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) Order the Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) separately. For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.– 237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) Limitations The glazed panel cannot be used as a return panel. Glazed panels have a more limited component load and stricter support requirements than hard-surfaced panels. (See “Determining Proper Support” for specifics.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 33 Walls Structure Open Panel Frame A1150. Description This structural panel has an opening for communicating and sharing equipment. It has a painted frame and top cap, cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. The panel cannot be used as a return panel. It is UL listed and has a Class A fire-retardant rating. The powered panel has a factoryinstalled electrical harness that distributes double-sided, four-circuit power within a cable management raceway. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Available in 62", 67", and 85" heights and 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. Actual panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 34 Walls Structure Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. An open panel frame allows visual communication for people with a hearing impairment. Using a turntable for shared equipment with an open panel frame requires a minimum panel width of 42" for sufficient inside clearance. A pass-through cover (ordered separately) is also required to fill the gap between the back-to-back work surfaces. VARIETY OF PANEL HEIGHTS AND WIDTHS TO ACCOMMODATE SIZE OF EQUIPMENT TO BE SHARED ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT SHARED THROUGH OPEN PANEL FRAME The leveling glides provide a maximum of 1 3/4" of height adjustability to compensate for uneven floors. (The 1 3/4" adjustment is measured from the underside of the panel base cover to the floor.) This panel is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is available with or without base receptacle locations. Powered panels have two baseline receptacle locations and one optional communication port location per side. The powered version of this panel comes with an electrical harness for four-circuit power already installed in the base; it is also available with an optional cable/energy barrier between the electrical system and the voice/data cables. This barrier is also available as a separate product to retrofit a panel on site. OPEN PANEL FRAMES 42" AND WIDER ALLOW SUFFICIENT INSIDE CLEARANCE FOR TURNTABLE AND SHARED EQUIPMENT OPTIONAL PASS-THROUGH COVER FILLS GAP BETWEEN BACK-TO-BACK WORK SURFACES Panel top caps are included with the panels. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Panel-top distribution requires that all panels, panel frames, and connections be of equal height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 35 Walls Structure Converting a nonpowered panel to a powered panel requires a base power adapter. CONNECTING PANELS OF EQUAL HEIGHT Extending power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to the next adjacent panel requires a panel passthrough power jumper. Connecting this panel directly to the building’s electrical supply requires a power entry product. Connecting panels of equal heights in a straight line requires a draw rod, cable management panel draw rod, or spacer. Connecting a panel to a spacer of the same height requires only a spacer, but no additional draw rod. Connecting panels of equal heights at an angle requires a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. Connecting panels of unequal heights in a straight line requires the appropriate change-of-height draw rod and panel/ panel change-of-height finished end. Connecting panels of unequal heights at an angle requires the appropriate two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector and the panel/connector change-of-height finished end. Connecting a panel to a spacer of a different height requires a spacer and a panel/connector changeof-height finished end. Covering the exposed end of a panel used at the end of a panel run requires a finished end. Two open panel frames attached to one another, with load-bearing components on them, require a connector brace (Service Part No. 239842). An open panel frame attached to a glazed panel, with load-bearing components on them, requires the same connector brace. REQUIRES SEPARATE DRAW ROD, CABLE MANAGEMENT DRAW ROD, OR SPACER …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD AND PANEL/ PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …IN STRAIGHT LINE REQUIRES 2-, 3-, OR 4WAY CONNECTOR AND PANEL/CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …AT ANGLE CONNECTING PANEL TO SPACER See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. REQUIRES SPACER …OF EQUAL HEIGHT L REQUIRES SEPARATE PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END …OF DIFFERENT HEIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 36 Walls Structure Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Wall Start (AO210.) • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Change of Height (AO219.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.) • Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.) Order optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit (A1322.) • Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit (A1323.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (A1331.) • Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted (NP239.) Order optional energy distribution components separately: • Base Power Adapter, with Side Covers, 4 Circuit (A1354.) • Base Power Adapter, without Side Covers, 4 Circuit (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) • Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet (G1313.) • Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet (NP289.) Order optional cable management components separately: • Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.) • Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical (AO383.) • Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel (A1380.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 37 Walls Structure For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.– 237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) Order the Pass-Through Cover (A2399.) separately. Limitations The open panel frame cannot be used as a return panel. Open panel frames have a more limited component load and stricter support requirements than hard-surfaced panels. (See “Determining Proper Support” for specifics.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 38 Walls Structure Door Panel A1190. Description This 85"-high, 48"-wide panel has a painted frame and top cap, a glazed side panel, a door, two cable management side covers, and adjustable glides. The door can be installed to swing left or right and to open in or out. The door cannot be keyed alike. Electrical wires and voice/data cable cannot be routed through this panel. Shipped knocked down. The panel has a laminate or veneer door. Dimensions Height is 85"; width is 48". Actual door width is 36". Planning Considerations All doors have a 10 1/2"-wide side panel, which is available with either clear glazing for complete see-through capability or smoked glazing for translucence only. CABLE MANAGEMENT CAN CONTINUE THROUGH OPTIONAL TOP CHANNELS ACROSS TOPS OF DOOR PANEL AND ADJACENT PANELS Panels adjacent to the door panel must be the same height as the door panel. Neither electrical wires nor voice/data cables can be routed through the top cap included with this panel. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data cable channel. Connecting panels to the door panel in a straight line requires a draw rod for each connection, ordered separately. The 36"-wide door permits wheelchair access, with an opening clearance of 32" with the door at a 90° angle. The lever handle option conforms to the guidelines of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA). ENERGY CANNOT BE TRANSMITTED THROUGH DOOR PANELS See “Determining Proper Support” in this section for guidelines on panel configurations. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 39 Walls Structure Options Order optional panel connection components separately: • Draw Rod (AO215.) • Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.) • 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.) • Spacer (A1260.) • 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.) • 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.) • Finished End (A1250.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– 233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.–237.) • Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap (NP238.) Limitations The door panel can be used at the end of a run only if it is adjacent to a perpendicular wall attached to the door panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 40 Walls Structure Cable Management Panel Frame A1180. Description This 6"-wide structural frame holds cable management panel faces on each side and has a top cap and cable management side covers. It is UL listed. The 39"-high powered frame has one receptacle location per side; 47"- to 85"high powered frames have two receptacle locations per side. Receptacle locations are at work surface height. The powered frame includes a harness to extend baseline power to an adjacent panel and a harness to route power to work surface height. Electrical components are UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Available in 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights. Width is 6". Panel depth is 1 7/8". Panel base height is 4 5/8" (5" nominal) and depth is 3 1/4". Planning Considerations The panel hanger rail is slotted at 1" increments to allow for vertical adjustment of panel-attached components. The panel frame forms two separate vertical chases to house power and voice/data cables. It includes a metal conduit to carry electrical power from the baseline to the work surface and a pass-through harness at the base. Another conduit carries voice/data cables between the baseline and the ceiling, or from either the baseline or the ceiling to communication port locations in the panel frame. The cable capacity is 59 4-pair Category 5 cables when the panel is nonpowered, and 50 4-pair Category 5 cables when the panel is powered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 41 Walls Structure Each side of the panel frame is enclosed with a separate panel face, which provides access to power and voice/data cables at standard vertical locations. Nonpowered panel faces are one piece; powered panel faces are segmented, with the joint at 27" high, to allow access to the interior of the cable management panel frame without removing the work surface. On powered panel frames, access options include two duplex receptacle locations above the work surface, or two duplex receptacle locations and one communication port location above the work surface and two port locations below it. (The 39"-high panel holds only one duplex receptacle.) The frame can also be used as an enclosed chase for cables, with no point of access. The powered panel frame accepts duplex receptacles and accommodates most manufacturers’ communications modules (purchased separately from the manufacturer). Panel top caps are included with the panel frames. This top cap does not accommodate horizontal cable distribution. To distribute cables horizontally along the top of this panel and adjacent Series 2 panels requires a voice/data channel. (This alternative raceway provides an additional 24 4-pair Category 5 cable capacity, as well as a channel for cables that is physically separated from the panel’s baseline electrical system. Cable distribution within this voice/data channel is horizontal only; it does not allow for vertical distribution to or from the cable management panel.) Panel-top cable distribution requires all panels, panel frames, and connections to be of equal height. L WITH OPTIONAL TOP CHANNEL, VOICE/DATA CABLES CAN TRAVEL HORIZONTALLY ACROSS CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME—BUT CANNOT TRAVEL VERTICALLY FROM PANEL TOP CHANNEL PANEL FRAME CAN BRING BASE ELECTRICAL POWER TO WORK SURFACE HEIGHT VOICE/DATA CABLES AND POWER CAN TRAVEL HORIZONTALLY ALONG BASE AND VERTICALLY IN CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME 90Å CONNECTOR ELECTRICAL POWER DISTRIBUTION SIDE AWAY FROM CONNECTOR VOICE/DATA DISTRIBUTION SIDE NEXT TO CONNECTOR Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 42 Walls Structure A cable management panel frame can be connected to a panel of the same height or to a connector of equal or greater height. Connecting the panel frame to an adjacent panel of equal height requires a cable management panel draw rod. Attaching a panel frame to a Series 2 connector requires only the wedge block package included with the panel frame. Connecting a panel frame to a connector that is higher requires a panel/connector change-of-height finished end on the adjacent taller connector. In connecting the cable management panel frame to a two-way, three-way, or four-way 90° connector, the electrical side of the panel should be positioned away from the connector and the cable management side next to the connector. In connecting the cable management panel frame to a spacer, the electrical side of the panel should be positioned next to the connector and the cable management side away from the connector. CONNECTING CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME TO ANOTHER PANEL… REQUIRES SEPARATE CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL DRAW ROD PANEL OF SAME HEIGHT CONNECTING CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME TO CONNECTOR… CONNECTOR OF GREATER HEIGHT Options Order these components separately: • Cable Management Panel Face (A1181. for Side 1 and A1182. for Side 2) • Communication Port Faceplate, Reducer (G1189.A) • Communication Port Faceplate, Extender (G1189.B) To connect a cable management panel frame to another panel of equal height, order a Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel (AO214.), separately. To connect a cable management panel frame to a connector that is higher, order a Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.), separately. L REQUIRES CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL DRAW ROD TO MATCH HEIGHT OF SHORTER CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME CONNECTOR OF SAME HEIGHT REQUIRES ONLY WEDGE BLOCK PACKAGE INCLUDED WITH CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 43 Walls Structure Order the following optional power entry products separately: • Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit, without Side Covers (A1355.) • Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper (A1342.) For optional electrical access, order the following components separately: • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (K1311.) • Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.) For optional panel-top cable distribution, order the following components separately: • Voice/Data Cable Channel (NP227.– NP233., NP271.) • Voice/Data Channel Connector (NP251., NP234.– NP237.) • Ceiling Power Entry (NP239.) Limitations The cable management panel frame cannot be used as the last panel in a run, because it will not accept any finished end. In order to prevent deflection, two cable management panel frames must not be attached to each other. The cable management panel cannot be connected directly to a panel of a different height or a lower connector (it can be connected to a higher connector). The cable management panel frame cannot route cables vertically through its interior from the optional panel-top voice/data cable channel; vertical cable distribution through the panel frame must originate in the panel frame base or the ceiling. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 44 Walls Structure Cable Management Panel Face A1181. Side One A1182. Side Two Description This panel face attaches to side one or side two of a cable management panel frame. The panel face has a vinyl or fabric surface. The 39"-high powered panel face has one receptacle location per side; 47"- to 85"-high powered panel faces have two receptacle locations per side. Receptacle locations are at work surface height. The powered panel face is manufactured in two pieces with a joint just below work surface height; the nonpowered panel face has no joint. Dimensions Available in heights to fit 39"-, 47"-, 53"-, 62"-, 67"-, and 85"-high cable management panel frames. Width is 6". The joint dividing the segmented versions is approximately 27" above the floor. Planning Considerations One panel face is required for each side of the frame; the frame and each panel face are ordered separately. The panel face comes in a one-piece nonpowered version or a two-piece segmented powered version, with options for four-circuit power or fourcircuit power plus communication ports. The panel face for both powered versions is manufactured in two separate sections, an upper and a lower, which can each be removed to allow access to the interior of the cable management panel frame without removing the work surface. REMOVABLE PANEL FACE SNAPS ON AND OFF The panel face is field installed and is removable for cable access. The actual panel face is shorter than the cable management panel frame, to allow for the base cover. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 45 Walls Structure SIDE 1 OPTIONS The panel face for side one provides cable access on the left and electrical power access on the right; the panel face for side two provides cable access on the right and electrical power access on the left. The panel face accommodates most manufacturers’ communications modules (purchased separately from the manufacturer). The panel face can also be field cut to accommodate custom communication port locations by selecting the panel face most closely matching the required locations and adding custom cutouts. (The number of custom ports must be limited to maintain the structural integrity of the panel face; this can be assured by maintaining a minimum of 1 1/2" between cutouts. Also, the placement of the cutouts must not interfere with the placement of hanging components.) If only a few custom ports will be cut, an ordinary utility knife will suffice. If more custom ports are needed, contact the Herman Miller Customer Service Department for the appropriate dies and punch. Options Order the Communication Port Faceplate (G1189.A and G1189.B) separately. Purchase preconfigured cable communication modules/faceplates separately from their manufacturers. ACCESS TO POWER ONLY ACCESS TO POWER… NO POWER OR CABLE ACCESS HA OR FA …AND TO VOICE/DATA CABLES HB OR FB HC OR FC SIDE 2 OPTIONS ACCESS TO POWER ONLY ACCESS TO POWER… NO POWER OR CABLE ACCESS HA OR FA …AND TO VOICE/DATA CABLES HB OR FB HC OR FC OPTIONAL PORT ACCESS (CUT IN FIELD)— FOR VOICE/DATA CABLES ONLY, NOT POWER SPACING OF AT LEAST 1 ⁄«™" REQUIRED BETWEEN ACCESS HOLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 46 Walls Structure Carpet Gripper G1190. Description These molded, clear plastic grippers fit onto the adjustable glides of frames and panels for added stability on carpet. They cannot be used on hard floors. Package contains 25. Planning Considerations Carpet grippers have a minimal effect on the height of the panels. Limitations Do not use on hard floors. CARPET GRIPPERS GLIDE FITS INTO CUPPED CAVITY OF CARPET GRIPPER CARPET GRIPPER HELPS PREVENT PANEL OR FRAME FROM SLIDING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 47 Walls Determining Proper Support Determining Proper Support Every wall run requires support. The Action Office system was designed to hold the maximum number of components per panel. To support a full load of components and ensure safe, supported, and stable configurations, Action Office walls must be supported properly and at appropriate intervals. All support requirements for the Action Office system should be used carefully: • when designing and specifying • when installing components and equipment • when reconfiguring workstations during the life of the facility Caution: Failure to follow these guidelines can result in product failure and/or personal injury. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 48 Walls Determining Proper Support Types of Support The Action Office system provides two different types of wall support: those that are wall height and those that are work surface height. Wall-height supports include support walls (panels used as returns), wall starts, and Liaison® cabinets; work surface-height supports include work surface support panels, work surface support pedestals, and Arrio™ freestanding work surfaces. Wall-Height Supports SUPPORT WALL WALL START LIAISON CABINET Support Walls Support walls are return panels mounted at right angles to a wall run. (A wall run consists of panels connected in a straight line.) Support walls are used to stabilize panels used alone or walls carrying load-bearing (and in some cases non-loadbearing) components. Rigid connectors are used to connect support walls. The following panels are structurally acceptable for use as support walls: • hard-surfaced panels • fabric-covered panels • tackable acoustical-barrier panels • acoustical panels • cable management panels connected to any of the above (but not used as the last panel in the support wall) Open panel frames and glazed panels should not be used as support panels. Although peninsula work surfaces are also placed perpendicular to a wall run, they cannot be used as support elements for the run. Wall Starts Wall starts allow panels to be installed at right angles to structural, load-bearing building walls, columns, or full-height V-Walls. Note: Herman Miller, Inc., defines a structural wall as a load-bearing wall constructed of materials such as poured concrete, concrete block, or a composite board (drywall) attached to metal or wood studs. The composite board (drywall) must be a minimum of 5/8" thick. The wood studs must be a nominal 2" x 4" size, and the metal studs must be C channel, 20-gauge thick and of a nominal 2" x 4" size. Whether of wood or metal, the studs must be on centers no greater than 24", be limited to a maximum height of 14', and be restrained at the floor and the ceiling. Liaison Cabinets Liaison cabinets can be integrated into a run of Action Office panels to provide support. (Refer to the Liaison cabinet system planning information for support considerations.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 49 Walls Determining Proper Support Work Surface-Height Supports WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL—END WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PEDESTAL ARRIO FREESTANDING WORK SURFACES Work Surface Support Panels End work surface support panels offer a lower (work surface-height) alternative to support walls (return panels). The work surface support panel generally functions as the end support—a full-depth supporting panel used below the end of a work surface to replace a return panel, connector, and work surface support bracket. It can also be used as a mid-run support in a wall run of panels with work surfaces attached, as a stabilizer to allow longer, uninterrupted panel runs. (There is no separate mid-run support for Series 2.) Work Surface Support Pedestals Work surface support pedestals are storage units used beneath work surfaces for end or mid-run support; like work surface support panels, they support both a panel run and the work surfaces. As mid-run supports, they can be used as stabilizers to allow longer, uninterrupted panel runs. Arrio Freestanding Systems Work Surfaces Arrio work surfaces include fixed- and adjustable-height freestanding table desks, three-legged corner table desks, and freestanding peninsulas that, when integrated with Herman Miller systems furniture, provide support to panels. The supporting Arrio work surfaces can be used either perpendicular or parallel to the wall run and be positioned at the end of the wall run or at interim points along the wall where support is required. (Refer to the Arrio freestanding systems furniture planning information for support considerations.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 50 Walls Determining Proper Support Types of Components Whether wall-height or work surface-height support is used, it is important to know the type of components that hang on the panels in order to determine the panel’s load capacity. Components that hang on panels fall into two categories: those that are load-bearing and those that are non-load-bearing (and have no effect on the panel’s load capacity). Components that fall into each category are listed in the “Component Types” chart. All load-bearing components must be accounted for in determining the support requirements of panels, although not all load-bearing components require the same degree of support. (Work surfaces, hanging pedestals, and lateral files create the greatest stress.) Some components, like marker boards, are considered non-loadbearing because they create little or no stress on the supporting panel. They are not counted in determining component load. Component Types Load-Bearing Components Non-Load-Bearing Components Rectangular Work Surfaces (All) Peninsula Work Surfaces Corner Work Surfaces (All) Transaction Surfaces Work Surface-Attached Pedestals Display Shelves Suspended Lateral Files Tackboards, Marker Boards Flipper Door Units Tool Bars with Work Tools Shelves Coat Bars and Shelves L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 51 Walls Determining Proper Support Support Considerations for Wall-Height Support The following considerations are critical for determining proper support when using support walls and wall starts: • • • • • • • Placement of support Width of support Height of support Need for additional support Frequency of support Component load capacity Liaison work cabinets These support considerations are interdependent: Changing one of them may affect the requirements for the others. For example, a run of panels of a certain length and height has a maximum number of load-bearing components that it can carry; if the length of the wall run is reduced, however, those same-height panels can carry a greater number of components. This ability to adjust one factor to compensate for another allows designers and specifiers to meet users’ specific needs for privacy, space, and amount of storage and work surface area. The basic support requirements for most wall-height support situations are covered in this section. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 52 Walls Determining Proper Support Placement of Support Support panels must be attached to both ends of a wall run, regardless of the length of the wall run or the presence of hanging components. RIGHT! ANY WALL RUN REQUIRES SUPPORT ON BOTH ENDS WRONG! NEEDS SUPPORT ON BOTH ENDS Other than assuring support on both ends of a wall run, the major consideration for placing support walls is whether or not the wall run carries any load-bearing components. Support must be placed on the side(s) of the wall carrying load-bearing components. RIGHT! SUPPORT WALLS MUST BE ATTACHED TO SIDE(S) OF WALL RUN CARRYING LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS L WRONG! SUPPORT WALLS REQUIRED ON SIDE(S) OF WALL RUN SUPPORTING LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 53 Walls Determining Proper Support Width of Support Panels without Load-Bearing Components Panels used in a freestanding (U ) configuration with no components or with only nonload-bearing components must have returns at least 30" wide for runs up to 60" long and at least 36" wide for runs greater than 60" long. UP TO 60" GREATER THAN 60" AT LEAST 30" ONLY NON-LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS ATTACHED RETURNS MUST BE AT LEAST 30" WIDE FOR RUNS UP TO 60" LONG WITH SUPPORT WALLS ON ONLY 1 SIDE AT LEAST 36" ONLY NON-LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS ATTACHED RETURNS MUST BE AT LEAST 36" WIDE FOR RUNS GREATER THAN 60" LONG WITH SUPPORT WALLS ON ONLY 1 SIDE When support walls are used on both ends and on both sides (in an H configuration) as support to a panel run with no components or with non-load-bearing components, the minimum width for the support walls is 12". AT LEAST 12" AT LEAST 12" ONLY NON-LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS ATTACHED RETURNS MUST BE AT LEAST 12" WIDE FOR RUNS WITH SUPPORT WALLS ON BOTH SIDES The maximum width of a support wall is 60". After that, it becomes a wall run that itself needs support at both ends; therefore, panel combinations used as support cannot exceed 60" in width. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 54 Walls Determining Proper Support Panels with Load-Bearing Components For panels carrying load-bearing components, the width of the support wall is determined independently for each side of the wall run—by the support requirements for the components attached to that side of the wall run. 24" 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE REQUIRES 24"-WIDE SUPPORT WALL 18" 16"-DEEP SHELF REQUIRES 18"-WIDE SUPPORT WALL WIDTH OF SUPPORT WALL DETERMINED INDEPENDENTLY FOR EACH SIDE OF WALL RUN The minimum width of a support wall is determined by the depth of the deepest component attached to the wall run (at its extended depth, if applicable). If, for example, a panel within a wall run holds a 24"-deep work surface and another panel in the same run holds a 16"-deep shelf, a 24"-wide support wall is required at each end of the wall run. 24" 24" 16"-DEEP SHELF 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE REQUIRES 24"-WIDE SUPPORT WALL AT EACH END WIDTH OF SUPPORT WALL DETERMINED BY DEPTH OF DEEPEST COMPONENT ATTACHED TO WALL RUN A wall run holding a lateral file requires a support wall at least 24" wide because, even though the component itself is only 15 1/2" deep, the center of gravity extends to 22" when the drawer is pulled out. (Technically, the drawer extends to 28", but the center of gravity, at 22", is more critical.) 22" 24" 24" CENTER OF GRAVITY WITH OPEN LATERAL FILE DRAWER ATTACHED LATERAL FILE REQUIRES 24"-WIDE SUPPORT WALL AT EACH END WIDTH OF SUPPORT WALL DETERMINED BY EXTENDED DEPTH OF DEEPEST COMPONENT ATTACHED TO WALL RUN See “Support Considerations for Work Surface-Height Support” for alternative support methods. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 55 Walls Determining Proper Support A corner work surface requires a support wall matching or exceeding the width of the corner work surface: 36", 42", 48", or 60". 24" 48" 24" X 48" CORNER WORK SURFACE DIFFERENT WIDTH OF SUPPORT REQUIREMENTS ON EACH END FOR CORNER WORK SURFACE A wall start attached to a building’s structural wall or column always fulfills the support requirements for a wall run with or without load-bearing components. COLUMN LOAD-BEARING STRUCTURAL WALL WALL START WALL START WALL START ATTACHED TO STRUCTURAL WALL OR COLUMN ALWAYS FULFILLS SUPPORT REQUIREMENTS FOR 1 END OF WALL RUN L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 56 Walls Determining Proper Support The “Component Support Requirements” chart gives a listing of minimum support requirements for the most commonly used components and configurations in a wall run. Note that, in general, larger or heavier components require a wider support wall for support. In contrast, a wall run with no components or only non-load-bearing components requires a 30"- or 36"-wide return support panel to compensate for the lack of component weight on the run. Component Support Requirements Components Used in Wall Run Minimum Support Requirements (Per End) • No components • Non-load-bearing components • 30"-wide support wall in run up to 60" long and with no support walls on opposite side (U configuration) • 36"-wide support wall in run greater than 60" long and with no support walls on opposite side (U configuration) • 12"-wide support panels on both sides (H configuration) • Wall start attached to structural wall or column • Shelves: 15 1/2" high (13" or 16" deep) or 7 1/2" high • Flipper door unit • 18"-wide support wall with support walls on both sides (H configuration) • 24"-wide support wall with no support walls on opposite side (U configuration) • Wall start attached to structural wall or column • Work surface, 24" deep (except peninsula) • 24"-wide support wall or work surface support panel • Wall start attached to structural wall or column • Work surface, 30" deep (except peninsula) • 30"-wide support wall or work surface support panel • Wall start attached to structural wall or column • Lateral file • 24"-wide support wall • Wall start attached to structural wall or column L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 57 Walls Determining Proper Support Height of Support The height of support needed to stabilize a configuration is determined by the height of the panel and the number of load-bearing components on the panel. For example, a 67"-high panel with four load-bearing components requires a 53"-high support wall at each end of the wall run. If one component were removed, a 39"-high support panel would be sufficient. In a panel run where height support requirements vary, the most stringent requirements (i.e., the support guidelines for the highest panel) apply. SUPPORT GUIDELINES FOR HIGHEST PANELS IN WALL RUN APPLY Support considerations related to panel height assume that differences in height between adjacent panels are no greater than 28". This restriction applies between panels in a run as well as between the panel run and its support panels. 28" OR LESS 28" OR LESS Any time a change in height occurs within a panel configuration, lateral files and work surfaces must be installed no higher than the height of the lowest panel in that configuration. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 58 Walls Determining Proper Support The “Height of Support” chart illustrates the support panel height requirements under varying conditions. It shows the minimum height requirements of support panels for representative numbers of load-bearing components. Height of Support Height of Tallest Panel in Wall Run Minimum Height of Support Wall Required to Support Load-Bearing Components 32" 32" 1–3 Components 39" 1–3 Components 47" 1 Component 39" 47" 2–3 Components 4 Components 53" 62" 53" 1–3 Components 4 Components* 62" 1–3 Components* 4 Components* 5–6 Components 4–5 Components* 6 Components* 1 Component 2–3 Components 67" 85" 1–3 Components 67" 85" 4–5 6–8 Components* Components* *Only hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels can support more than 3 load-bearing components per panel. (See the loading information for other panels under “Component Load Capacity.”) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 59 Walls Determining Proper Support Need for Additional Support Component braces, which must be ordered separately from the components, must be used with tackable acoustical-barrier panels under the following conditions: • where four flipper door units, shelves, or lateral files are used in any combination; • where a flipper door unit or shelf is used above a work surface and suspended pedestal; • where more than four load-bearing components are used in any combination. Note: Because of the way the component brace clips over the bottom edges of two adjacent components, the components to which the additional support is attached must hang on adjacent panels and align at the bottom. Ganging plates, shipped with all squared-edge work surfaces, should be used on all squared-edge work surfaces hung adjacent to one another along a wall run. COMPONENT BRACES ENSURE ADEQUATE SUPPORT AND MUST BE USED UNDER CERTAIN CONDITIONS GANGING PLATES SHOULD BE USED ON ALL ADJACENT SQUARED-EDGE WORK SURFACES Work surface brackets should be used on the front corners of all work surfaces used on 85"-high panels. The brackets will also provide additional support on other panel heights. 85" L WORK SURFACE BRACKETS SHOULD BE USED ON FRONT CORNERS OF WORK SURFACES ON 85"-HIGH PANELS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 60 Walls Determining Proper Support Effect of Panel Type Whether panels are load bearing or not, support is required—at the beginning and end of the wall run and possibly within the wall run itself. Because of the variety of Action Office panels available and the different type of construction for each one, load capacity or frequency of support may differ from the general guidelines. Frequency of Support The length of the wall run between support walls depends on the type of panel used in the run and on the components attached to the panels. Whenever panels with different support requirements are used in the same wall run, the most stringent support requirements must be followed. Hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels—and cable management panels when used in conjunction with those panels—require support every 10' when used in a run carrying any number of load-bearing components. MAXIMUM SPAN BETWEEN SUPPORTS—10' WITH ANY NUMBER OF LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS 10' HARD-SURFACED, FABRIC-COVERED, TACKABLE ACOUSTICAL-BARRIER, OR CABLE MANAGEMENT PANELS When an acoustical panel is used in a run carrying load-bearing components, the limit is 8' or 10' between support walls (8' with three components per panel, 10' with two components). MAXIMUM SPAN BETWEEN SUPPORTS—8' WITH 3 LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS PER PANEL MAXIMUM SPAN BETWEEN SUPPORTS—10' WITH 2 LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS PER PANEL 10' 8' WITH ONE OR MORE ACOUSTICAL PANELS Glazed panels and open panel frames have an 8' wall run limit. MAXIMUM SPAN BETWEEN SUPPORTS—8' 8' GLAZED AND OPEN PANEL FRAMES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 61 Walls Determining Proper Support Any single panel, whether it carries load-bearing components or not, requires support at each end. In a wall run, if the panels carry no load-bearing components, support is required at the beginning and the end of the wall run, and only every 12' in between, no matter what type of panel is in the run. MAXIMUM SPAN BETWEEN SUPPORTS—12' WITH NON-LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS 12' ALL PANEL TYPES Frequency of Support Type of Panel With Load-Bearing Components With Non-Load-Bearing Components Hard-Surfaced Every 10' Every 12' Fabric-Covered Every 10' Every 12' Tackable AcousticalBarrier Every 10' Every 12' Acoustical Every 8' (with 3 components) Every 10' (with 2 components) Every 12' Glazed Every 8' Every 12' Open Panel Frame Every 8' Every 12' Door Panel Every 8'* Every 12'* Cable Management Panel Every 10'* Every 12'* *In combination with other panels L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 62 Walls Determining Proper Support Component Load Capacity Action Office hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels, and cable management panels used with them, are designed to support any number of load-bearing components that can fit on the panel. Within the physical limitations imposed by their height, there is no load-bearing component limit on these panels. (When these panels are used in conjunction with a cable management panel, the load-bearing component capacity remains the same.) Other panel types, however, have unique construction properties that affect load capacity. Acoustical Panels Acoustical panels are designed to support the sound-control efforts in an office. To achieve the maximum sound-control benefit, as well as to account for their different construction, it is advisable to minimize the number of components hung on these panels. Acoustical panels—no matter what height—have a maximum load capacity of three load-bearing components per side, only one of which can be a work surface. It is possible to have more than one work surface only if there are no other load-bearing components on the panel. Also, these panels cannot carry three of the same loadbearing components per side, except shelves or flipper door units. Frequency of support for acoustical panels also differs from the guidelines for hardsurfaced, fabric-covered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels. With two components (on one or both sides) on the panel, the frequency of support (at 10') is the same as any other panel, but the frequency of support increases to every 8' when a third component is added. The chart that follows summarizes the maximum capacities—by component—for acoustical panels: Load Capacities for Acoustical Panels Length of Wall Run Maximum Number of Load-Bearing Components Per Panel Per Side 8' 3 • 3 shelves or flipper door units • 1 work surface, plus 2 shelves or 2 flipper door units • 2 work surfaces with no other load-bearing components, including hanging pedestals • 1 suspended lateral file plus 2 shelves or 2 flipper door units • 2 suspended lateral files with no other load-bearing components 10' 2 • 2 shelves or flipper door units • 1 work surface, plus 1 shelf or 1 flipper door unit 12' 0 • No load-bearing components L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 63 Walls Determining Proper Support When hanging lateral files, work surfaces, or work surfaces with hanging pedestals on any configuration of acoustical panels, the following additional guidelines must also be observed: • None of the components can be installed above the 62" height. • None of the components can be installed above the height of the lowest panel in the configuration. If additional components (more than the stated limits) are hung on any acoustical panel, then one of the following two options must be applied: • Counterbalancing must be applied. (Components of equal load are hung on the panel’s other side to offset the load on the first side.) • The wall run length must be reduced to a maximum of 6' between support walls. Glazed Panels and Open Panel Frames Glazed panels and open panel frames are panels designed to provide visual access or pass-through functions for shared equipment. The number of load-bearing components per panel is the same as for acoustical panels (a maximum of three), but these panels are to be used only in runs up to 8' long. If additional components (more than the stated limits) are hung on any glazed panel or open panel frame, then one of the following two options must be applied: • Counterbalancing must be applied. (Components of equal load are hung on the panel’s other side to offset the load on the first side.) • The wall run length must be reduced to a maximum of 6' between support walls. Liaison Work Cabinets Liaison work cabinets are often integrated into a run of Action Office Series 2 panels. The dimensions of Liaison work cabinets are not included when adding up panel widths to determine the length of the wall run and the proper frequency of support. (See the Liaison cabinet system planning information for specifics about support guidelines for work cabinets.) 30" 30" 30" RETURN (REQUIRED FOR 60" WALL RUN) LIAISON CABINET WIDTH NOT INCLUDED IN DETERMINING SUPPORT FOR WALL RUN L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 64 Walls Determining Proper Support Support Considerations for Work Surface-Height Support The second type of support for Action Office wall runs comprises work surface-height support products: end work surface support panels, work surface support pedestals, and Arrio freestanding work surfaces, which can be used as either end or mid-run support. Unlike wall-height supports, work surface support panels and support pedestals can be used as support only for a wall run with work surfaces along its entire length. Work surface support panels and pedestals can replace support walls under some conditions. They are used as stabilizers to allow longer, uninterrupted runs, replacing a return panel, connector, and work surface support bracket. When work surface support panels or pedestals are used, all work surfaces along the entire wall run must be ganged together to ensure maximum support, and work surface brackets must be used at the front outside corners of the work surface run. WHEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANELS OR PEDESTALS ARE USED (END OR MID-RUN) THE FOLLOWING CONDITIONS MUST BE MET— WORK SURFACE BRACKETS FOR ADDITIONAL SUPPORT WORK SURFACES MUST BE GANGED WORK SURFACES MUST BE USED THE ENTIRE LENGTH OF THE WALL RUN The following considerations are critical for determining proper support when using work surface-height supports: • • • • Placement of support Depth of support Panel height and component load Length of wall run and frequency of support This section outlines some of the design guidelines that must be met to ensure the proper performance of end work surface support panels or support pedestals used as work surface-height support. The guidelines for proper support when using Arrio freestanding work surfaces are covered under “Determining Proper Support” in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 65 Walls Determining Proper Support Placement of Support A work surface support panel or work surface support pedestal can be used at one end of a wall run only. The other end must be supported by a support wall. RIGHT! WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL OR PEDESTAL CAN BE USED AT 1 END OF WALL RUN WRONG! WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL OR PEDESTAL CANNOT BE USED AT BOTH ENDS OF WALL RUN Likewise, if a work surface support panel or pedestal is used at the end of a wall run, then a work surface-height support cannot be placed as the next support in the wall run. RIGHT! WORK SURFACE-HEIGHT SUPPORT PANELS AND PEDESTALS CAN BE USED SINGLY OR IN MULTIPLES WITHIN WALL RUN AS LONG AS WALL RUN IS SUPPORTED AT BOTH ENDS BY WALL-HEIGHT RETURNS WRONG! IF WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL OR PEDESTAL IS USED AT END OF WALL RUN, THEN WORK SURFACE-HEIGHT SUPPORT CANNOT BE PLACED AS NEXT SUPPORT IN WALL RUN For placement of Arrio work surfaces used as support, see the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 66 Walls Determining Proper Support Depth of Support The depth of the work surface support panel used at the end of a wall run must match the depth of the work surface it supports—for example, the 24"-deep end support panel must be used to support a 24"-deep work surface, and the 30"-deep end support panel to support a 30"-deep work surface. RIGHT! WIDTH OF SUPPORT PANEL MATCHES DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE WRONG! MUST USE SUPPORT PANEL IN WIDTH THAT MATCHES DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE With support pedestals used at the end of a panel run, the 20"-deep support pedestal must be used to support a 24"-deep work surface and the 24"-deep pedestal must be used to support a 30"-deep work surface. FILLER MAKES SUPPORT PEDESTAL FLUSH WITH FRONT EDGE OF WORK SURFACE The work surface support pedestal can be used within a wall run to extend the length of that wall run and to stabilize the longer run. As an alternative, the 24"-deep work surface support panel end can be used in the middle of a run to support 24"- or 30"-deep work surfaces. Note, however, that neither mid-run work surface support alternative allows the panel base cover to flip down to provide access to wiring and cabling. DOES NOT ALLOW ACCESS TO CABLE MANAGEMENT BASE END WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL OR SUPPORT PEDESTAL CAN BE USED AS MID-RUN STABILIZER WITH CERTAIN LIMITATIONS When using Arrio freestanding work surfaces for support, see the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide for requirements. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 67 Walls Determining Proper Support Panel Height and Component Load The maximum height for panels in a run utilizing work surface support panels or pedestals is 67". (Because of the extreme difference in height between the panels in the wall run and the work surface support, panels 85" high can be used only if they hold no load-bearing components other than work surfaces.) Because the work surface support panel is attached to both the work surface and the panel, there is no restriction on maximum difference in height between adjoining panels. The maximum component load per panel when supported by a work surface support panel or pedestal is as follows: • one flipper door unit • one tackboard • one work surface 85" 67" MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 67" FOR PANELS IN WALL RUN; MAXIMUM LOAD PER PANEL— FLIPPER DOOR UNIT, TACKBOARD, AND WORK SURFACE MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 85" IF PANELS IN WALL RUN HOLD NO LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS OTHER THAN WORK SURFACE Suspended lateral files cannot be used on the same wall run as the work surface support panel or pedestal. WRONG! WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL OR PEDESTAL CANNOT BE USED ALONG SAME WALL RUN AS PANEL-HUNG LATERAL FILES Load and height allowances are also affected by the length of the wall run; see “Length of Wall Run and Frequency of Support” for further guidelines. See also “Determining Proper Support” in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide when Arrio work surfaces are used for support. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 68 Walls Determining Proper Support Length of Wall Run and Frequency of Support A wall run supported by a work surface support panel or pedestal on one end must meet the following guidelines. When using Arrio freestanding work surfaces for support, see the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide for requirements. • Maximum length of wall run with hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels is 10'. MAXIMUM SPAN 10' WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL (OR PEDESTAL) HARD-SURFACED, FABRIC-COVERED, OR TACKABLE ACOUSTICALBARRIER PANEL • Maximum length of wall run with a 6"-wide cable management panel is 8' plus the 6"-wide panel (a total of 8'-6"). MAXIMUM SPAN 8'-6" WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL (OR PEDESTAL) CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL • Maximum length of wall run with acoustical panels is 8'. MAXIMUM SPAN 8' ACOUSTICAL PANELS WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL (OR PEDESTAL) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 69 Walls Determining Proper Support End work surface support panels or support pedestals used within a run of work surfaces can be used as stabilizers to increase the length of the run between support walls if the following guidelines are met. (As with other uses of work surface-height support, work surfaces must be used the entire length of the wall run, and the work surfaces must be secured at their front corners with ganging clips.) • All wall runs (any panel type) between 10' and 16' must have one mid-run stabilizer (an end support panel or a support pedestal), and the mid-run stabilizer must be centered. A 16' panel run of acoustical panels requires work surface brackets at both ends of the wall run. 16' (MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 67") RETURN WALL RETURN WALL WORK SURFACE SUPPORT (CENTERED) MAXIMUM RUN OF 16' WITH MID-RUN STABILIZER (MUST BE CENTERED)— APPLICABLE FOR ANY PANEL TYPE • To extend the wall run to a maximum of 20', two mid-run stabilizers (centered) are required; only hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, or tackable acoustical-barrier panels with a maximum height of 67" can be used. 20' (MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 67") RETURN WALL RETURN WALL WORK SURFACE SUPPORT (CENTERED) MAXIMUM RUN OF 20' WITH 2 MID-RUN STABILIZERS (MUST BE POSITIONED NEAR CENTER OF RUN)— APPLICABLE FOR HARD-SURFACED, FABRICCOVERED, AND TACKABLE ACOUSTICAL-BARRIER PANELS ONLY L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 70 Walls Determining Proper Support • To extend the wall run to a maximum of 24', two mid-run stabilizers (equally spaced) are required, and the panel height of the wall is limited to a maximum of 53". Under this condition, hanging components are limited to the low shelf, small tackboard, and work tool bar with tools in addition to the work surface. 24' (MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 53") RETURN WALL RETURN WALL WORK SURFACE SUPPORT (CENTERED) MAXIMUM RUN OF 24' WITH 2 MID-RUN STABILIZERS (LIMITED LOADING) There is an exception to these length-of-run guidelines: a group of workstations of any height using only work surfaces along its entire length and carrying no load-bearing components above the work surface height. Because of the absence of load-bearing components above the work surface height, this configuration is stable enough to carry no length-of-run limitations. The only support required is mid-run support (work surface support panels or pedestals) every 10' along the entire length of the wall run. UNLIMITED RETURN WALL RETURN WALL MID-RUN SUPPORT EVERY 10' UNLIMITED LENGTH OF WALL RUN (NO LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS ABOVE WORK SURFACE HEIGHT) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 71 Walls Determining Proper Support A Summary of Work Surface Support Panel/Support Pedestal Considerations The following chart summarizes, by length of run, the support required, the maximum height allowed, and the maximum number of components allowed when using work surface support components. Work Surface Support Panel and Support Pedestal Requirements* Length of Wall Run Maximum Height of Panels in Wall Run 8' 67" • Used at 1 end only • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged 10' 67" • Used at 1 end only • Requires use of hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, or tackable acoustical-barrier panels only • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged • Requires use of front ganging clip 10' – 16' 67" • Requires use of wall-height support, not work surface-height support components, at ends • Requires mid-run support (centered) • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged 18' – 20' 67" • Requires use of wall-height support, not work surface-height support components, at ends • Requires use of hard-surfaced, fabric-covered, or tackable acoustical-barrier panels only • Requires 2 mid-run supports (centered) • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged • Requires use of front ganging clip 22' – 24' 53" • Requires use of wall-height support, not work surface-height support components, at ends • Requires 2 mid-run supports • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run; other hanging components limited to low shelf, small tackboard, and work tool bar with tools • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged Unlimited 85" • Requires use of wall-height support, not work surface-height support components, at ends • Requires mid-run support every 10' • Requires work surfaces across entire width of wall run—no other load-bearing components • Requires all work surfaces to be ganged Work Surface Support Requirements (Panel or Pedestal) * See the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide for work surface support requirements when Arrio work surfaces are used as work surface-height support. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 72 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls RECTANGULAR PAINTED TOP CAPS ON PANELS, CONNECTORS, AND FINISHED ENDS There is a range of choices in hardware for connecting panels (of equal or unequal heights) to one another or to architectural walls, and for finishing off a panel run. With finished-end products, exposed changes of panel height are given a finished look. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 73 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Making Panel Connections With Series 2 connecting hardware, panels can be connected in a straight line, using draw rods or spacers, or in as many as four different 90° connections, using 90° connectors or wall starts. The connecting hardware for Series 2 panels is easy to assemble and reconfigure. The metal draw rod/wedge block mechanism pulls the panels together and automatically aligns the tops of the panels. The result is a strong, rigid, panel-to-panel joint that retains its strength and rigidity through numerous reconfigurations. Adjoining panels can be of equal height or can vary by as much as 28". Such panelto-panel, in-line changes of height are possible without spacers or other corner connectors. When baseline cable management is used, changes in height do not interfere with this capability. When optional panel-top voice/data cable channels are used, panels must be of equal height. Finished ends and change-of-height products give the layout a finished appearance at the end of a wall run or at the point where there is a change of height between adjacent panels. CONNECTION USING 2-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR FINISHED END CONNECTION USING 3-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR CONNECTION USING CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL TO PROVIDE ELECTRICAL AND DATA ACCESS PANELS CONNECTED IN STRAIGHT LINE WITH DRAW ROD 90Å CONNECTION USING WALL START CONNECTION USING 4-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR PANELS CONNECTED IN STRAIGHT LINE USING SPACER (USED INSTEAD OF DRAW ROD TO BALANCE USE OF 3-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR ON OPPOSITE WALL) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 74 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Wall Attachment Hardware Wall strips, along with their fasteners, are used to attach Action Office hanging components to architectural walls. When centered on a modular dimension ranging from 24" to 96" in 6" increments, wall strips can accept standard-width Series 2 wallattached components in much the same way as a panel does. (Note that wall strips may also be centered on other dimensions to match the widths of work surfaces that do not match panel widths.) CENTER AT MODULAR DIMENSION RANGING FROM 24" TO 96" IN 6" INCREMENTS TO ACCEPT MOST STANDARD-WIDTH WALL-ATTACHED COMPONENTS POSITION FLUSH TO FLOOR Note: Action Office Series 2 panels can also be connected to V-Wall® full-height walls, a floor-to-ceiling partition system designed to complement Series 2 panels. V-Wall products are available in matching trim and surface finishes to provide an aesthetically integrated facility with the privacy of ceiling-height walls. While V-Wall products can be used alone, they are fully compatible with Series 2 panel-attached components and can intersect with Series 2 panels. This capability to interface allows complete planning continuity, whether utilizing full- or partial-height dividers. (Call 1-800-255-9255 for planning information for V-Wall products.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 75 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Planning for Dimensional Gain All connections, except those using the straight-line draw rod, add inches to a panel run. This factor must be kept in mind, especially where panel runs are long and space is limited, or where two opposite panel runs must be of equal length. The various connections and their dimensional gain are as follows: Straight-line connection made with Draw Rod (AO215.): No dimensional gain. IN GA NO Straight-line connection made with Spacer (A1260.): Add 3 1/2" to the panel run for each connection. +3 " ⁄«™ A 90° connection made with 2-Way 90° Connector (A1220.): Add 3 1/2" for each connection, in both directions. ™" ⁄« +3 L +3 ⁄«™ " Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 76 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls A 90° connection made with 3-Way 90° Connector (A1230.): Add 3 1/2" to panel run for each connection of two panels abutting one another in a straight line and 3 1/2" for each perpendicular connection. ™" ⁄« +3 +3 ⁄«™ " A 90° connection made with 4-Way 90° Connector (A1240.): Add 3 1/2" to panel run for each connection. +3 ⁄«™ " +3 " ⁄«™ A 90° connection made with Wall Start (AO210.) and Draw Rod (AO215.) of same height as the wall start: Add 13/16" for each 90° connection. +⁄ ‹«¡ §" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 77 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Trim made with Finished End (A1250.): Add 5/8" for each finished end. «•" + fi L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 78 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls This chart serves as a quick reference to dimensional gain with Action Office Series 2 connecting and finishing hardware. Dimensional Gain from Connecting and Finishing Hardware Hardware Dimensional Gain (Per Connection or Finished End) Frame Connectors Draw Rod Spacer 2-Way 90° Connector 3-Way 90° Connector 4-Way 90° Connector Wall Start None 3 1⁄ 2" 3 1⁄ 2" 3 1⁄ 2" 3 1⁄ 2" 13⁄16" Finished Ends Finished End 5⁄ 8" Note: Work surface support panels add no dimensional gain to panel run. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 79 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Wall Strip AO213. Description This wall strip attaches with wall fasteners to a structural wall to support hanging components. Two wall strips are required to hang a component. The 60"-high wall strip requires 8 fasteners; the 72"-high wall strip requires 9 fasteners; and the 84"-high wall strip requires 11 fasteners. Dimensions Available in 60", 72", and 84" heights. Width is 1"; depth is 3/4". Planning Considerations Wall strips have slots that allow hanging components to be adjusted vertically in 1" increments. Two wall strips are required to hang components—one on each end of the product; the wall strips should be centered on modular dimensions that match the wall-attached components to be hung. Components can be hung to the left and to the right from each wall strip—one component from the slot on the left and one from the slot on the right. Finishing the exposed edge of a wall strip requires attachment of a trim strip. 1" SLOTS EVERY 1" FOR ATTACHING COMPONENTS CENTER AT MODULAR DIMENSIONS TO MATCH WALL-ATTACHED COMPONENTS TO BE HUNG The selection of the appropriate wall fastener package depends on whether the wall strips are to be fastened to concrete block or poured walls, to drywall, or to metal or wood studs. Wall strips are shipped without fasteners. Wall strips should be attached flush to the floor for maximum stability. POSITION FLUSH TO FLOOR L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 80 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls When using wall strips in a corner formed by two architectural walls, the first wall strip should be centered 1 1/2" from the corner; this achieves modular dimensions for components at 90° angles. Using a wall strip in a corner formed by a panel and an architectural wall requires that the wall strip be flush to a wood shim 11/16" x 1 1/2". (The wood block shim, which must be provided by the installer, is required to maintain proper alignment of modular components hung perpendicular to one another.) 1 ⁄«™" 1 ⁄«™" CENTER STRIPS 1 ⁄«™" FROM CORNER 1 ⁄«™" Options Order the appropriate Wall Fasteners (AO291.) separately. Order the Trim Strip (AO212.) separately. Limitations To ensure stability, wall strips may not be cut to a shorter length. WOOD SHIM (SUPPLIED BY INSTALLER) ⁄⁄«¡§" SHIM WALL START SHIM REQUIRED TO MAINTAIN MODULAR DIMENSION WITH PERPENDICULAR WORK SURFACE WALL STARTS L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 81 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Trim Strip AO212. Description This strip finishes one exposed edge of a wall strip. Dimensions Available in 60", 72", and 84" heights. Planning Considerations Select the trim strip to match the height of the wall strip. The Wall Strip (AO213.) is ordered separately. Wall Fastener AO291. Description This black panhead fastener attaches a wall strip to a wall. Package contains 100. Dimensions Available in 1 1/2"- and 3"-long sheet metal screws and 3"-long machine screw types to fit 60"-, 72"-, and 84"high wall strips. Planning Considerations Select the appropriate wall fastener to accommodate the following wall types: • No. 10 x 1 1/2" panhead sheet metal screw for use with cement blocks, poured walls, and brick • No. 10 x 3" panhead sheet metal screw for use with studs or TC toggles in drywall • No. 10 x 3" machine screw for use with wing toggles or mollys in drywall WALL STUD The drywall must be a minimum of 5/8" thick. Each 60"-high wall strip requires 10 fasteners; each 72"-high wall strip requires 12 fasteners; and each 84"-high wall strip requires 14 fasteners. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 82 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Wall Start AO210. Description This assembly connects an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel to an architectural wall, column, or panel of equal height at a 90° angle. Dimensions Available in 27", 34", 42", 48", 57", 62", and 80" heights. Planning Considerations For Action Office Series 1 panels, the wall start is ordered to match the panel height. For Action Office Series 2 panels, the wall start is 5" shorter than the actual panel to allow for the height of the panel base and top cap. CONNECTS PANEL TO STRUCTURAL WALL OR BUILDING COLUMN AT 90Å ANGLE DRAW ROD The connection requires a draw rod. When a wall start is used in conjunction with wall strips, a wood shim is required to maintain proper modular dimensions. See the wall strip product information in this section for more information. The wall start adds 13/16" to a panel run. See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. Options Order the Draw Rod (AO215.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 83 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Draw Rod AO215. Description This draw rod connects Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels of equal heights in a straight line. Dimensions Available in 27", 34", 42", 48", 57", 62", and 80" heights. Planning Considerations This draw rod is used to connect an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel to another Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel of the same height or to a wall start of equal height. The connections must be in a straight line. 5" SHORTER THAN SERIES 2 PANEL For Action Office Series 1 panels, the draw rod is ordered to correspond to the panel height. For Action Office Series 2 panels, the draw rod is ordered 5" shorter than the actual panel height to allow for the height of the base. The chart below lists the draw rod heights and the corresponding Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel heights. 180Å Draw Rod Action Office Series 1 Panel Action Office Series 2 Panel 27" 34" 42" 48" 57" 62" 80" 27" 34" 42" 48" — 62" 80" 32" 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 84 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Draw Rod, Change of Height AO219. Description The change-of-height draw rod connects Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels of unequal heights in a straight line. Dimensions Available in 27", 34", 42", 48", 57", and 62" heights. Planning Considerations This change-of-height draw rod is used to connect an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel to another Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel that is higher or lower. The panels must be in a straight line. WEDGE BLOCK HOOKS For Action Office Series 1 panels, the change-of-height draw rod is ordered to correspond to the height of the lower panel. For Action Office Series 2 panels, the draw rod is ordered 5" shorter than the actual panel height (of the lower panel) to allow for the height of the base. MATCHES HEIGHT OF LOWER PANEL REQUIRES PANEL/PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END The chart below lists the draw rod heights and the corresponding Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel heights. Finishing off the exposed end of the higher panel requires a change-ofheight finished end. 180Å CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT DRAW ROD CONNECTS 2 PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHT IN STRAIGHT LINE The height difference between two connected panels is limited to a maximum of 28". Options Order the Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.), separately. L Change-of-Height Draw Rod Action Office Series 1 Panel Action Office Series 2 Panel 27" 34" 42" 48" 57" 62" 27" 34" 42" 48" — 62" 32" 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 85 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Draw Rod, Cable Management Panel AO214. Description This draw rod connects a cable management frame to an Action Office Series 2 panel of equal height in a straight line. Dimensions Actual heights are 34", 42", 48", 57", 62", and 80". Planning Considerations This draw rod is used only with a cable management panel—to connect it to an Action Office Series 2 panel of equal height in a straight line. CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL The height of the draw rod corresponds to the height of the cable management panel; but the draw rod is ordered 5" shorter than the actual height of the cable management panel to allow for the height of the base. The chart below lists the draw rod heights and the corresponding panel heights. Cable Management Panel Draw Rod Cable Management Panel 34" 42" 48" 57" 62" 80" 39" 47" 53" 62" 67" 85" L 5" SHORTER THAN PANEL TO ALLOW FOR BASE AND TOP CAP Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 86 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls 2-Way 90° Connector A1220. Description This connector joins two panels of equal or unequal heights at a 90° angle and has a cable management side cover. The connector has an enameled or fabric surface. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights to match standard panel heights. Planning Considerations Connecting two panels of equal height requires a 90° connector the same height as the panels. ORDER CONNECTOR TO MATCH HIGHER PANEL REQUIRES CHANGEOF-HEIGHT FINISHED END TO COVER EXPOSED PORTION Connecting two panels of unequal heights requires a 90° connector the height of the higher panel; a separate change-of-height finished end finishes the exposed end of the connector. Adjacent panels with cable/energy barriers also require a cable/energy barrier for the connector. The connector adds 3 1/2" to a panel run. See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. Options Order the Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.), separately. 90Å 90Å CONNECTS 2 PANELS OF EQUAL OR UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Order Cable/Energy Barrier, Connector (A1381.1), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 87 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Spacer A1260. Description This spacer joins two panels of equal or unequal heights in a straight line and also compensates for dimensional gain in a panel run. It has two cable management side covers. The spacer has enameled or fabric surfaces. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights to match standard panel heights. Planning Considerations Connecting two panels of equal height requires a spacer the same height as the panels. Connecting panels of unequal heights requires a spacer the height of the higher panel; a separate panel/ connector change-of-height finished end finishes off the exposed end of the spacer. ORDER CONNECTOR TO MATCH HIGHER PANEL REQUIRES PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGEOF-HEIGHT FINISHED END TO COVER EXPOSED PORTION Adjacent panels with cable/energy barriers also require a cable/energy barrier for the spacer. The spacer adds 3 1/2" to a panel run. See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. Options Order the Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.), separately. 180Å 180Å CONNECTS 2 PANELS OF EQUAL OR UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Order Cable/Energy Barrier, Connector (A1381.2), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 88 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls 3-Way 90° Connector A1230. Description This connector joins three panels of equal or unequal heights at 90° angles and has a cable management side cover. The connector has an enameled or fabric surface. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights to match standard panel heights. Planning Considerations Connecting three panels of the same height requires a connector the same height as the panel. Connecting panels of unequal heights requires a three-way 90° connector the height of the highest panel; a separate panel/connector change-of-height finished end finishes each exposed end of the connector. ORDER CONNECTOR TO MATCH HIGHEST PANEL REQUIRES PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGEOF-HEIGHT FINISHED END TO COVER EXPOSED PORTION 90Å Adjacent panels with cable/energy barriers also require a cable/energy barrier for the 90° connector. The connector adds 3 1/2" to a panel run. See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. Options Order the Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.), separately. 180Å CONNECTS 3 PANELS OF EQUAL OR UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Order Cable/Energy Barrier, Connector (A1381.3), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 89 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls 4-Way 90° Connector A1240. Description This connector joins four panels of equal or unequal heights at 90° angles and has an enameled surface. It does not require a cable management side cover. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights to match standard panel heights. Planning Considerations Connecting four panels of the same height requires a connector the same height as the panels. Connecting panels of unequal heights requires a four-way 90° connector the height of the highest panel; order a separate panel/connector change-ofheight finished end to finish each exposed end of the connector. Adjacent panels with cable/energy barriers also require a cable/energy barrier for the 90° connector. ORDER CONNECTOR TO MATCH HIGHEST PANEL REQUIRES PANEL/ CONNECTOR CHANGEOF-HEIGHT FINISHED END TO COVER EXPOSED PORTION 90Å The connector adds 3 1/2" to a panel run. See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. Options Order the Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector (AO259.), separately. Order Cable/Energy Barrier, Connector (A1381.4), separately. L 90Å CONNECTS 4 PANELS OF EQUAL OR UNEQUAL HEIGHTS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 90 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Finished End A1250. Description This cover finishes the exposed end of a panel. It has an enameled surface and a cable management end cover. Dimensions Available in 32", 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights to match standard panel heights. Planning Considerations Order the finished end to match the height of the panel to which it is to be attached. The finished end adds 5/8" to a panel run (this includes the top cap and the base cover). See “Planning for Dimensional Gain” in this section for more information. To support a squared-edge transaction surface in addition to finishing the exposed end of a panel, specify the finished end with transaction surface end support (T option). All other applications require the H option. This finished end cannot be used on the cable management panel. FINISHES EXPOSED END OF PANEL L H OPTION T OPTION ATTACHES TO TRANSACTION SURFACE AND PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 91 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel AO251. Description This cover finishes the exposed end of a panel that joins panels of unequal heights. The cover is 32" long but can be field cut to the appropriate length. Dimensions Available in 5", 6", 7", 8", 9", 14", 15", 18", 20", 21", 23", and 28" heights—the exposed differences in height when two Series 2 panels of unequal height are connected in a straight line. Planning Considerations Order the finished end to match the difference in height between the two panels. A change-of-height draw rod must be specified to match the height of the lower panel. FINISHES EXPOSED PORTION OF HANGER FRAME NO DIMENSIONAL GAIN FOR SPACE PLANNING ORDER PANEL/PANEL CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT FINISHED END TO MATCH DIFFERENCE IN PANEL HEIGHTS Since the finished end does not cover the end of the lower panel, it does not cause any dimensional gain for space planning. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 92 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Connector AO259. Description This cover finishes the exposed end of a connector that joins panels or cabinets of unequal heights. The cover is 46" long but can be field cut to the appropriate length. Dimensions Height is 46". Width is 1 3/4". Planning Considerations Cut the finished end height to match the difference in height between the panel or cabinet and connector. Since the finished end does not cover the end of the lower panel, it does not cause any dimensional gain for space planning. FINISHES EXPOSED END OF CONNECTOR WHEN PANELS OF UNEQUAL HEIGHTS ARE CONNECTED FINISHED END IS FIELD CUT TO MATCH DIFFERENCE IN HEIGHT NO DIMENSIONAL GAIN FOR SPACE PLANNING Attachment hardware is included. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 93 Walls Connecting and Finishing Walls L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 94 Walls Energy Distribution Energy Distribution POWER CAN BE DISTRIBUTED IN 3 DIRECTIONS VERTICALLY TO WORK SURFACE HEIGHT WITHIN CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL HORIZONTALLY IN EITHER DIRECTION WITHIN PANEL BASE Today’s electronic office environments demand high-performance electrical distribution solutions. The power system for Action Office Series 2 panels responds easily to these needs. It is a four-circuit, eight-wire system that is extremely flexible— flexible enough to be used with nearly any common wiring system found in office buildings today, even those buildings without an eight-wire building configuration. It is the eight-wire building wiring configuration, however, that allows the Series 2 power system to deliver the optimum level of performance to each workstation. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 95 Walls Energy Distribution System Overview Action Office Series 2 panels offer these energy features: • Eight-wire electrical distribution with up to four circuits, including one dedicated circuit and multiple isolated ground circuits, in the base of the panel • A vertical cable management panel that allows energy and voice/data cables to be brought to work surface height and voice/data cables to other heights along the panel frame, providing easy access to them at various heights within a workstation • A cable distribution channel, with hinged side covers for quick access to wires and cables at the panel base; the channel conceals cables and Local Area Network (LAN) components • An optional metal barrier to separate sensitive voice/data cables from electrical wires • An optional panel-top raceway for equal-height panels, to physically separate cables and power between the panel top and the panel base • The ability to provide power entry directly into the panel base from the floor or wall or through ceiling entry poles • The ability to convert nonpowered panels to powered panels in the field • Underwriters’ Laboratories (UL) listing, Canadian Standards Association (CSA) certification, and conformance with the National Electrical Code (NEC) and most local codes L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 96 Walls Energy Distribution Basic Electrical Terms A basic understanding of electrical terms is critical to the planning process. The following terms are used throughout this planning information; for additional information, consult the National Electrical Code (NEC). Amperage—unit of electrical current flowing through a circuit. Voltage—measurement of electrical pressure required to move electrical current through a circuit. Most office equipment requires 120 volts; however, many large pieces of equipment, e.g., copiers, require 220 volts. Circuit—complete path or loop of electrical current that takes power from its source to an electrical device or a piece of equipment, then returns what is left to its original source. A simple circuit requires these three wires: • Hot wire (delivers electrical current to the device) • Neutral wire (returns electrical current to the power source) • Ground wire (diverts short-circuit electricity to the earth) Ground wire—wire that protects users from shock or electrocution by diverting shortcircuit electricity into the earth. For safety reasons, every circuit utilizes a ground wire that must be in contact with all exposed-metal parts that could be energized. Branch circuit—circuit that provides power from the fuse box or breaker to electrical outlets. Designated circuit—circuit that has been reserved for a particular usage, e.g., lighting; does not require special wiring. Isolated ground circuit—circuit with an isolated ground wire that is totally separated from the general or system ground. Dedicated circuit—circuit that provides unshared power for computers or other sensitive electronic equipment; requires separate hot, neutral, and ground wiring. (For additional information, see “Key Regulations.”) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 97 Walls Energy Distribution Circuit Capacity and Configurations Typical Circuit Configurations The following diagrams depict several basic circuit configurations. Basic Electrical Circuit H – Hot wire N – Neutral G – Ground Four-Wire, Two-Circuit System This wiring configuration is commonly used with single-phase power and is usually found in homes and older commercial buildings. The neutral wire is shared between two hot wires. H1 H2 N G – – – – H N G BASIC ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT Hot wire—for a circuit Hot wire—for b circuit Neutral (shared) Ground (shared) Five-Wire, Three-Circuit System This configuration requires three-phase power to energize all three circuits and has become the standard electrical delivery to most commercial buildings, due to its efficiency over single-phase power. In this configuration, the neutral wire is shared among three hot wires. The configuration offers three designated circuits. H1 H2 H3 N G – – – – – Hot wire—for a circuit Hot wire—for b circuit Hot wire—for c circuit Neutral (shared) Ground (shared) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 98 Walls Energy Distribution Six-Wire, Three-Circuit System with Isolated Ground In this three-circuit configuration, the third circuit has an isolated (physically separated) ground wire. N G2 G1 H3 H2 H1 – – – – – – Neutral (shared) Ground (isolated) Ground (shared) Hot wire—for c circuit Hot wire—for b circuit Hot wire—for a circuit Eight-Wire, Four-Circuit System with Dedicated Circuit In this Herman Miller four-circuit electrical system, the fourth circuit has a separate neutral and isolated ground wire. This creates a dedicated circuit in that each of the three wires (N2, G2, and H4 ) is separate from any other circuit. N2 N1 G2 G1 H4 – – – – – H3 – H2 – H1 – ISOLATED CIRCUIT (GROUND) Neutral (dedicated) Neutral (shared) Ground (isolated) Ground (shared) Hot wire (dedicated)—for d circuit Hot wire (general)—for c circuit Hot wire (general)—for b circuit Hot wire (general)—for a circuit L GENERAL-PURPOSE CIRCUITS N G2 G1 H3 H2 H1 N2 N1 G2 G1 H4 H3 H2 H1 DEDICATED CIRCUIT DEDICATED CIRCUIT (4-CIRCUIT) FOR ILLUSTRATION PURPOSES ONLY. FOR ACTUAL WIRING PATTERN, SEE WIRING DIAGRAMS. Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 99 Walls Energy Distribution Multiple Isolated Ground Circuit Configurations The following configurations allow users to obtain maximum isolated ground circuit capacity from this Herman Miller four-circuit system. Two Isolated Ground Circuits N2 – N1 – G2 – G1 – H4 – H3 – H2 – H1 – Neutral (shared) Neutral (shared) Ground (isolated; shared with CI ) and d circuit Ground (shared) Hot wire (computer)—for d circuit Hot wire (computer)—for c circuit (using CI receptacle) Hot wire (computer)—for b circuit (using BI receptacle) Hot wire (general)—for a circuit 2 GENERAL-PURPOSE CIRCUITS N2 N1 G2 G1 H4 H3 H2 H1 Three Isolated Ground Circuits ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUIT (4-CIRCUIT WITH 2 ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUITS) N2 – N1 – G2 – FOR ILLUSTRATION PURPOSES ONLY. FOR ACTUAL WIRING PATTERN, SEE WIRING DIAGRAMS. G1 – H4 – H3 – H2 – H1 – Neutral (shared) Neutral (shared) Ground (isolated; shared with BI, CI ) and d circuit Ground (shared) Hot wire (computer)—for d circuit Hot wire (computer)—for c circuit (using CI receptacle) Hot wire (computer)—for b circuit (using BI receptacle) Hot wire (general)—for a circuit 2 ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUITS 1 GENERAL-PURPOSE CIRCUIT N2 N1 G2 G1 H4 H3 H2 H1 3 ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUITS ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUIT (4-CIRCUIT WITH 3 ISOLATED GROUND CIRCUITS) FOR ILLUSTRATION PURPOSES ONLY. FOR ACTUAL WIRING PATTERN, SEE WIRING DIAGRAMS. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 100 Walls Energy Distribution Before planning, it is important to understand the types of circuit configurations commonly found in the office environment—as well as those configurations available with this product line. The illustrations show the most common connections. With this Herman Miller system, each of the four circuits is rated to distribute 20 amps of current at 120 volts. However, due to code requirements, in most cases actual amperage loads will be less. (See “Key Regulations.”) Circuit capacity is also stated in terms of duplex receptacles, with a maximum of 13 receptacles allowed per circuit. For planning purposes, circuit capacity should be based on actual amperage loads, not on the number of duplex receptacles. CONNECTION TO A GROUNDED RATING: 120/208V, 3-PH WYE, 60-HZ THREE-PHASE SYSTEM 20-AMP MULTIWIRE BRANCH CIRCUIT L4 PINK L3 BLUE WHITE #2 GREEN/YELLOW GREEN WHITE #1 L2 RED L1 BLACK L1 N1 G1 L2 N1 G1 L3 N1 G1 L4 N2 G2 L2 N2 G2 L3 N2 G2 CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT "a" "b" "c" "d" "b" "c" RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOAD) CONNECTION TO A GROUNDED RATING: 120/240V, 1-PH, 60-HZ SINGLE-PHASE SYSTEM 20-AMP MULTIWIRE BRANCH CIRCUIT L4 PINK L3 BLUE WHITE #2 GREEN/YELLOW GREEN WHITE #1 L2 RED L1 BLACK L1 N1 G1 L3 N1 G1 L2 N2 G2 L4 N2 G2 CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT "a" "c" "b" "d" RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOAD) NOTES: 1. N1 AND N2 ARE 10-GA. CONDUCTORS. 2. GREEN/YELLOW CONDUCTOR CAN BE USED AS AN ISOLATED GROUND. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 101 Walls Energy Distribution CONNECTIONS TO MULTIPLE GROUNDED RATING: 120/208-V, 3-PH WYE, 60-HZ THREE-PHASE POWER SOURCES 20-AMP MULTIWIRE BRANCH CIRCUIT RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) "a" "b" "c" CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT L1 N1 G1 L2 N1 G1 L3 N1 G1 BLACK SOURCE #1 WHITE #1 GREEN RED BLUE PINK SOURCE #2 WHITE #2 GREEN/YELLOW L4 N2 G2 CIRCUIT RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) "d" "a" "b" CIRCUIT CIRCUIT L1 N1 G1 L2 N1 G1 BLACK SOURCE #1 WHITE #1 GREEN RED BLUE SOURCE #2 WHITE #2 GREEN/YELLOW PINK L3 N2 G2 L4 N2 G2 CIRCUIT CIRCUIT "c" "d" RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) "a" RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) CIRCUIT L1 N1 G1 BLACK SOURCE #1 WHITE #1 GREEN SOURCE #2 RED WHITE #2 GREEN/YELLOW BLUE PINK RECEPTACLE CONNECTIONS (LOADS) L L2 N2 G2 L3 N2 G2 L4 N2 G2 CIRCUIT CIRCUIT CIRCUIT "b" "c" "d" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 102 Walls Energy Distribution Key Regulations The National Electrical Codes (NEC) and local codes affect electrical system planning. A few of the most critical ones follow; however, this listing is by no means exhaustive. All relevant codes (including local codes) should be reviewed thoroughly before planning the installation, and all work should be completed by a qualified contractor in accordance with those codes. The building’s electrical capacity and wiring configuration (single-phase, three-phase, or special branch circuits) should also be checked in order to ensure the most effective application of this four-circuit, eight-wire electrical system. “Derating” for Continuous Loading For safety reasons, the NEC requires that a circuit be “derated” by 20 percent when used under a continuous load. In other words, the 20-amp rating for this circuit makes this, in effect, a 16-amp-rated circuit under continuous-load conditions. Continuous load is defined as a load under which maximum current is expected to continue for three hours or more. Lighting and personal computers are usually considered continuous-load equipment. Typewriters, calculators, and other desktop equipment may or may not be; check the requirements of the individual workstation carefully before assigning an amp rating. Maximum Number of Receptacles Allowed According to the NEC, the maximum number of receptacles allowed per circuit is 13. However, when the circuit is derated by 20 percent for continuous loading, the number of receptacles per circuit is effectively reduced to 10. To ensure reserve capacity for future needs, the number should be further reduced. Receptacle Ratings Receptacles are rated for a 15- or 20-amp load and can supply a maximum singledevice load of 12 or 16 amps. This four-circuit, eight-wire system is designed to supply multiple receptacle loads per circuit as specified by the NEC. Amperage Limitations on Single Devices If any single device draws more than 80 percent of the available amperage of a circuit, it must be the only device connected to that circuit. For example, if a copy machine draws 16 amps, nothing else can be connected to the circuit. Use of Dedicated Circuits ANSI/BIFMA (American National Standards Institute/Business and Institutional Furniture Manufacturers’ Association) guidelines define a dedicated circuit as one that consists of three conductors (hot, neutral, and ground) between the circuit breaker and the receptacle dedicated for use with that equipment. These conductors are not shared with other circuits and must also be fed from a dedicated building circuit. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 103 Walls Energy Distribution Voltage Limitations This four-circuit, eight-wire system accommodates only 120-volt devices. This means that, for instance, a large office copier requiring 220 volts will have to be connected to an alternative electrical distribution system within the building. Multiple Power Entries—WARNING All power sources must be disconnected prior to servicing. No single circuit may be powered by more than one source. When more than one power entry is required to power a cluster of workstations, harnesses from the first infeed must never be electrically connected to harnesses from another infeed. Use of Qualified Electrical Contractors All electrical connections to the building power source must be made by a qualified electrical contractor in accordance with all national and local codes. Electrical System Incompatibility The Series 2 energy system is not compatible with any other system, including the Action Office Series 1 three-circuit electrical system, the Series 3 electrical system, the Ethospace electrical system, or any similar energy products used on other furniture lines. The energy system for Action Office Series 2 panels is compatible mechanically and electrically with Action Office Series 1 panels and connectors that have the optional four-circuit conversion base kits. Forward and Side Reach for Receptacles In addition to local and national electrical codes, the Federal Register; Volume 56, No. 144; Friday, July 26, 1991, outlines rules and regulations for wheelchair-bound persons that apply to forward and side reach that can affect placement of receptacles. If the clear floor space allows only forward approach to an object, the maximum high forward reach allowed is 48". The minimum low forward reach is 15". If the high forward reach is over an obstruction, like a work surface, the maximum high forward reach is reduced to 44" over an obstruction of a maximum 25" wide. If the clear floor space allows parallel approach to an object, the maximum high side reach allowed is 54", and the low side reach is no less than 9" above the floor. If the side reach is over an obstruction, again like a work surface, the maximum high side reach is reduced to 46" over an obstruction of a maximum 34" high and 24" wide. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 104 Walls Energy Distribution Planning Process Overview Effective planning for this Herman Miller electrical distribution system requires four basic steps. Following these steps in sequence will ensure that the system is designed to accommodate both present and future power needs. Step One—Electrical Needs. This step involves listing all office equipment required in each workstation, along with appropriate amperages. Step Two—Electrical Access. This step determines the type of circuits (designated, dedicated, and general) and quantity of receptacles needed to power each workstation and the total for all workstations. During this step, loads are balanced; based on special equipment needs, certain circuits are designated or dedicated. Step Three—Electrical Distribution. This step calculates the total number of circuits required to meet each cluster’s electrical requirements. Step Four—Electrical Supply. This step determines the number of power entries required to supply power from the building’s electrical source to the workstation cluster. Each of these steps is discussed in detail in the information that follows. Note: Individual Electrical Planning Worksheets are available in the Action Office® Series 2 Panels Documentation Tools package (0.A7000-3). Electrical Planning Worksheet Guidelines Typical Amperage Loads • Plan circuits based on the actual amperage draw of known equipment. *CAD Station *Calculator *Coffee Pot • Accommodate unplanned needs and future expansion by being conservative in your initial circuit loading (12 to 16 amps per 20-amp circuit). *Clock *Radio *Stereo • Never exceed maximum capacities or local code limitations. *Tape Recorder *Laser Printer *Desktop Copier .07 6.00 – 10.00 10.00 – 15.00 *Electric Eraser *Fan *Freestanding Copier (120 volt) .25 1.10 15.00 – 20.00 • Know your local codes! They always take precedence. • Be aware of the NEC requirement that limits circuit capacity to 80 percent (16 amps) for circuits with continuous operating loads (more than three hours, e.g., lighting, computers, etc.). • Determine the equipment needs for a dedicated circuit and plan circuit loading and power feeds accordingly. • As far as possible, try to balance loads between circuits. Plan a circuit load that is within 50 percent of the loads on the other circuits. (Balance does not apply to the dedicated circuit.) • Do not sacrifice designation for balance. • Place receptacles for known equipment only, never exceeding maximums allowed per code (13 duplexes per circuit, or per local code restrictions, whichever is smaller). • If any single piece of equipment draws more than 80 percent of the available amperage of a receptacle, it must be the only device connected to that receptacle. For example, a copy machine draws 10 amps; therefore, nothing else can be connected to the circuit the machine is on. • Always have your electrical layout plans reviewed by a licensed electrician or electrical inspector to ensure that they meet all code requirements. 10.00 – 20.00 .25 8.50 – 15.00 .03 .03 .33 *Pencil Sharpener *Task Light (4') *Adding Machine 1.00 .67 .35 *Letter Opener *Dictaphone *Telecopier 1.90 .25 .50 *Word Processor *Postage Meter *Tape Dispenser 1.50 – 3.00 2.80 1.80 *Personal Computer *Desktop Printer *CRT 3.50 – 8.00 1.50 – 5.00 1.00 – 3.00 *Space Heater *Typewriter *Microfiche Reader 12.50 1.50 .85 *Transcriber *A.C. Adapter *100-Watt Lamp .15 .05 .80 *Some appliances, such as coffee pots, copiers, printers, and heaters, consume most of the amperage available on a circuit. It is recommended that these devices be connected directly to the building power supply, leaving flexibility for other circuit planning. Loading Capacities Maximum Load Rating Per Circuit Priority Sequence for Electrical Layout 1. Allocate as needed or desired (e.g., designated). 2. Plan for future growth and additions. Circuits Amps Receptacles L planning information L Per Distribution System 4 80 52 Future-Growth Consideration Initial Planning 3. Consider and plan for large loads separately. 4. Balance loads across shared circuits. 1 20 13 Per Circuit Circuits Amps Receptacles 1 12–16 8–10 Per Distribution System 4 48–64 32–40 Action OfficeW Series 2 Panels Documentation Tools Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 105 Walls Energy Distribution Step One—Electrical Needs The primary objective of this step is to determine the equipment and amperage requirements of each individual workstation and, then, of the total cluster. To arrive at this listing, use the “Electrical Planning Worksheet” from the Action Office Series 2 Panels Documentation Tools package. (See the sample worksheet.) As an aid in estimating the required amperage, the worksheet also includes a list of typical office machines and their amperage draw. Exact information on equipment amperage and voltage requirements can be found on the equipment itself (on the nameplate) or on the equipment specifications sheets. This information overrules any of the general guidelines on the chart. Notice that when similar workstations (ones having the same electrical requirements) are clustered, their amperage requirements can be grouped together to save time (stations 5 – 8, for example). ACCOUNTANT #1 ACCOUNTANT #2 VERTICAL CABLE MANAGEMENT PANELS PROJECT ROOM #3 COPIER FAX ACCOUNTANT #4 PRINTER ANALYST #5 ANALYST #6 ANALYST #7 ANALYST #8 FILING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 106 Walls Energy Distribution IS T N N ME Y IP D B TIO U A Q E T E ST KS LI OR W Work Area 1 Equipment Description 2 3 Amps 2.00 PC 4.00 FAN 1.1 CALCULATOR .25 CLOCK .03 3 TASK LIGHTS 2.00 4.00 PENCIL SHARPENER 1.00 CALCULATOR .25 RADIO .03 2 TASK LIGHTS FAX MACHINE CALCULATOR Totals 4 c d CI a b c d BI CI PE TY IS TH USE AT N TH CA EM RE NT ST SU ME E SY Amperage Use KE QUIP IR A M E 8-W General OF E Equipment Description b c TH Amps a .50 6.00 BI Ded./ Iso. Grd. General N GE ATIO A R T PE LE S M A NG AL SI T TO R A FO 1.35 Work Area Receptacles Ded./ Iso. Grd. d BI Ded./ Iso. Grd. General CI a b c d BI CI .25 18.10 3 TASK LIGHTS 2.00 PC 4.00 ELECTRIC ERASER b 7.28 DESKTOP COPIER 10.00 LASER PRINTER a 7.38 PC Totals Ded./ Iso. Grd. General 3 TASK LIGHTS .65 AMPS Totals Receptacles Amperage Use Totals .25 DICTAPHONE .25 MICROFICHE READER .85 Totals 7.35 Cluster Totals NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula WATTS —————— = AMPS 120Totals (VOLTS) H R IT W NT THE S E E N IO PM OG AT QUI D T T KS E E OR LAR OUP W MI GR SI RE A Totals 5-8 8 TASK LIGHTS 4 PCs 5.40 18.00 4 CALCULATORS 4 MICROFICHE READER 1.00 3.40 4 OTHER EQUIPMENT 3.00 Totals Cluster Totals E TH R FO S S ION P AM AT L KST A T R TO WO 8 30.80 70.91 NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula L WATTS —————— = AMPS 120 (VOLTS) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 107 Walls Energy Distribution Step Two—Electrical Access Allocating Receptacles The principal means of electrical access with this Herman Miller system is the receptacle. Remembering that up to 20 amps or 13 receptacles are available per circuit, use the right-hand portion of the “Electrical Planning Worksheet” to determine the number of receptacles needed to power the equipment listed. Remember to allow for continuous loads and future growth. Receptacle Locations When installed in a cutout at the base of a powered panel, a receptacle permits access to power from that side of the panel. Except on the 12"- and 18"-wide panels (which have no receptacle locations) and the 6"-wide cable management panel (which offers two receptacles at work surface height), there are two duplex receptacle locations on each side of every panel, regardless of the panel width. Those receptacles are located 2 1/2" from the panel center. All receptacles are rated at 15 or 20 amps. While most receptacles used with this system are duplex, a surge suppression simplex receptacle is also available on certain circuits. Assessing the Building’s Circuit Capability Before any circuit selection for an existing building is made, it is critical to know the building’s circuit capability. If the building can handle only two or three circuits from each power supply point, or if the building is not wired for extra neutral or isolated ground wires, then circuit selection will be limited accordingly. If, however, it is early enough in the planning process to have input concerning the building’s circuit capacity, specifying a four-circuit, eight-wire system will allow the user to take fullest advantage of the capabilities of this Herman Miller electrical system. Remember, the d, BI, and CI receptacles access the second isolated ground and second neutral and, as a result, will not work unless the building supply has those same wires. Determining the Need for Designated Circuits To facilitate the maintenance of the electrical system and equipment, some planners prefer to designate circuits for particular types of equipment. (Note how the copier in Workstation #3 has been designated for the b circuit.) Circuit designation requires no special wiring. The “Electrical Planning Worksheet” provides a space for designating equipment on the a, b, and c circuits. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 108 Walls Energy Distribution Amperage Use Work Area 1 IS NG TED “A” I HT NA UIT LIG ESIG IRC D C 2 TO E, AG R PE M A NT 3 S IT PME D TO UI TE ” E EQ GNA “B U D IS SI UIT TH DE IRC IS C TO Equipment Description a 2.00 2.00 PC 4.00 FAN 1.1 CLOCK b c PC 4.00 PENCIL SHARPENER 1.00 Totals 2 TASK LIGHTS FAX MACHINE 1.38 4.00 2 2 1.00 Work Area .25 Equipment Description .03 1.28 4.00 Amps a 2 1.35 1.35 2 .50 .50 10.00 1 6.00 6.00 .25 .25 2.00 2.00 PC 4.00 , LE ULD CLE B I O SS SH TA 1 PO NT CEP N E RE Receptacles 1 Amperage Use HE PM A Ded./ W UI Ded./ E General General Iso. Grd. R Grd. EQ AIso. 1 b a b c d BI CI c dSH BI CI E 2 1 AT TS PAR H LIG SE LES ION K ⁄«™ S IRE C AT TA QU PTA LOC RE CE TO RE UE 1 D 2 1 2 2 4.00 ELECTRIC ERASER .25 .25 DICTAPHONE .25 .25 MICROFICHE READER .85 .85 U RC CI TS UI LE) D O C N T U OU E CIR R GR DU OF OAD ED ED S -L AT UIR IMIT OUS L Q ISO E Y L NU 2 RE R CIT NTI A APA CO C 0% (8 1 1 1.35 4.00 2 2 1 Cluster Totals NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula S IT 1 Totals 7.35 2.00 1 ⁄«™ 1.35 10.00 6.75 3 TASK LIGHTS Totals BI 1 2 7.28 2.00 18.10 d 1 Totals CALCULATOR c 1 4.00 DESKTOP COPIER 10.00 LASER PRINTER b .03 2.00 2.00 .03 a .25 3 TASK LIGHTS RADIO General CI 4.00 7.38 2.00 .25 BI 1.1 .25 CALCULATOR d ED ID ED V O T PR ICA D E CI AR DE ” A “D s PC ITH UIT W IRC C Ded./ Iso. Grd. 2 .03 Totals Totals 4 General Amps 3 TASK LIGHTS .65 AMPS CALCULATOR Receptacles Ded./ Iso. Grd. WATTS —————— = AMPS 120 (VOLTS) Totals 5-8 8 TASK LIGHTS 4 PCs 5.40 5.40 8 18.00 4 CALCULATORS 10.00 8.00 1.00 1.00 3.40 3.40 4 OTHER EQUIPMENT 3.00 3.00 4 MICROFICHE READER Totals Cluster Totals 30.80 5.40 2 2 2 16 5 2 4 4 7.40 10.00 8.00 8 70.91 12.75 10.00 18.16 22.00 8.00 16 NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula L 2 8 1 WATTS —————— = AMPS 120 (VOLTS) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 109 Walls Energy Distribution Determining the Need for Dedicated Circuits Certain electronic devices—usually computers—are sensitive to deviations in their power supply. Such power problems can be caused by the operation of other equipment on a circuit that “shares” neutral or ground wires with an electronic device. These problems can be cleared up by providing a dedicated circuit for use by sensitive equipment or providing isolated circuits that are shared only by other similar equipment. To provide a dedicated circuit to a workstation—for example, to utilize the d circuit— both the systems furniture and the building itself must be wired for a dedicated circuit. An uninterruptible power system (UPS) is a system that provides an alternate power supply should the regular power supply be interrupted or disconnected. If the building has such a system, its power should be brought to the workstation through the dedicated circuit. In fact, the dedicated circuit is most fully utilized—and offers the most protection—when it is hooked up to the UPS source. This Herman Miller electrical system is designed to accommodate both dedicated and non-dedicated circuits. The “Electrical Planning Worksheet” provides a space for indicating whether equipment requires a dedicated circuit, isolated ground circuits, or general circuits. (See the columns under “Receptacles” on the sample worksheet.) Determining the Need for Isolated Ground Circuits An isolated ground runs from the receptacle back to the building electrical service entry. Because it does not come into contact with any other ground structure that could pick up additional radiated noise, it is a cleaner ground to use with sensitive computer or electronic equipment that needs a more stable, noise-free ground situation. This Herman Miller electrical system is designed to provide up to three isolated ground circuits by using the d circuit and by making either the b or c circuits, or both, isolated ground circuits. The choice depends on the balance in the office environment between general office equipment and lighting and other more highly sophisticated electronic equipment. In a highly computerized office environment, for example, three isolated ground circuits may be required so that users can take advantage of the maximum isolated ground capacity from the four-circuit system. Balancing the Load Once the total amperage requirements have been calculated and assigned to dedicated and general circuits, the next step is to balance the load among the available circuits. (When the line currents are unbalanced, the imbalance is returned through the neutral line.) Proper circuit balancing can minimize the number of power entries and allow greater flexibility for future growth. A good rule for balance is to allocate loads so that the loading of one circuit is within 50 percent of the load on each of the other circuits. Remember, the dedicated circuit is not affected, since it does not share any wires with the general circuits. Allocation Priority Sequence 1. Allocate as needed or desired (e.g., designate). 2. Plan for future growth and equipment additions. 3. Plan for single large loads independently. 4. Balance loads across shared circuits to minimize power entry points within the building. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 110 Walls Energy Distribution Marking Receptacles on the Floor Plan Once the electrical load and receptacles have been allocated, the floor plan should be labeled with baseline receptacle locations and circuit identification. Special notation should be made of any additional receptacles at other-than-baseline locations as well. (These should be marked on the floor plan while planning the electrical distribution.) A ACCOUNTANT #1 C A D D A A C C A C A A D PROJECT ROOM #3 D B C A C ACCOUNTANT #4 ANALYST #6 D C C A A D B1 A C ANALYST #8 ANALYST #7 A C C C A ANALYST #5 A C ACCOUNTANT #2 C C Legend: A = Duplex Receptacle (with circuit identification) A B1 A C D = Duplex Receptacle at different height (with circuit identification) FILING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 111 Walls Energy Distribution Step Three—Electrical Distribution Electrical power is transmitted from the building’s point of supply through the furniture system via the electrical components: the electrical harness in a powered panel or the pass-through power jumper. Determining the Number of Circuits Needed After listing all equipment and appropriate amperages, calculate the total number of amps required for each workstation cluster. To determine the number of circuits required, simply use the formula that follows. It is based on the maximum 20-amp rating for each circuit, but allows for future growth. To provide room for future electrical equipment, it is wise to plan initial circuit loads conservatively—well below the rated capacity. The example shown uses a 12-amp capacity per circuit, which was determined by derating the circuit to 16 amps (20 percent derating for continuous-load requirement) and then allowing four amps for future growth. TOTAL AMPS = Number of circuits needed (to allow for growth) 12 Always remember to consider any codes that require derating of circuit capacities. (See “Key Regulations.”) On the sample “Electrical Planning Worksheet” shown, the total amperage required to power the cluster is 40.91 amps for general use and 30 amps for dedicated use. Using the above formula, the number of circuits required is as follows: 40.91 12 = 30 12 = 4 general circuits* 5 general circuits* and 3 isolated ground circuits 3 isolated ground circuits *Due to the cluster layout and the desktop copier, which has been designated to its own circuit (see Workstation #3 on “Electrical Planning Worksheet”), the number of general circuits used will be increased to five. Receptacles Amperage Use Work Area 1 IS G D ” IN TE “A HT GNA UIT G LI ESI IRC D C 2 TO Equipment Description , 4.00 FAN 1.1 CLOCK c PENCIL SHARPENER 1.00 c d 1 1 1.38 4.00 2 2 Work Area 7.28 2.00 .25 1 Equipment Description .03 1 , LE LD LE IB OU C SS SH TA PO NT CEP N E RE Receptacles 1 Amperage Use HE PM A Ded./ W UI Ded./ General General Iso. Grd. REGrd. EQ AIso. 1 b a b c d BI CI c dSH BI CI 2 1.28 4.00 Amps a 2 1.35 1.35 2 1 2 .50 .50 ⁄«™ 10.00 1 6.00 6.00 .25 .25 1 Totals CALCULATOR 18.10 ⁄«™ 1.35 10.00 6.75 3 TASK LIGHTS 2.00 2.00 PC 4.00 2 1 .25 .25 DICTAPHONE .25 .25 .85 7.35 2.00 2 TS UI RC S CI IT ) D O CU ULE N T OU UE CIR D R R G D OF OA D D L TE RE ITS SLA QUI IM OU ISO RE TY L INU 2 RE CI NT A APA CO C 0% (8 1 1 Totals Totals TE S RA HT PA LIG SE LES ION E K S IR C AT TA QU PTA LOC RE CE TO RE UE D 2 4.00 ELECTRIC ERASER MICROFICHE READER BI 1 1.00 .25 DESKTOP COPIER 10.00 LASER PRINTER b 4.00 .03 FAX MACHINE a .03 7.38 2.00 4.00 2 TASK LIGHTS CI .25 PC Totals BI 1.1 .25 2.00 2.00 RADIO d 2 .03 Totals Totals 4 b ED ID D OV TE PR ICA E D CI AR DE ” A “D s PC ITH UIT W IRC C Ded./ Iso. Grd. General 4.00 3 TASK LIGHTS A ER P AM NT 3 S IT PME D O I T U TE ” E EQ NA “B DU IS SIG UIT H T DE IRC IS C TO a 2.00 2.00 PC CALCULATOR GE Amps 3 TASK LIGHTS .65 AMPS CALCULATOR Ded./ Iso. Grd. General .85 1 1.35 4.00 2 2 1 Cluster Totals NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula WATTS —————— = AMPS 120 (VOLTS) Totals 5-8 8 TASK LIGHTS 4 PCs 5.40 5.40 8 18.00 4 CALCULATORS 10.00 8.00 1.00 1.00 3.40 3.40 4 OTHER EQUIPMENT 3.00 3.00 4 MICROFICHE READER Totals Cluster Totals 30.80 5.40 2 2 2 2 16 5 2 4 4 7.40 10.00 8.00 8 70.91 12.75 10.00 18.16 22.00 8.00 16 NOTE: If amps are not listed, convert wattage to amperage using the formula L 40.91 AMPS FOR GENERAL USE WATTS —————— = AMPS 120 (VOLTS) 8 1 30 AMPS FOR DEDICATED USE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 112 Walls Energy Distribution Identifying Powered Panels on the Floor Plan It is important to identify panels as “powered” on the floor plan. These panels will deliver the electrical circuits from the building’s supply point to the receptacle locations. It is also at this point that cable management panels can be identified on the floor plan—at any location where energy distribution or access is desired above the baseline. Panels are identified in one of three ways: 1. Powered—electrical distribution with receptacle access 2. Pass-through—electrical distribution with no receptacle access 3. Nonpowered—no electrical distribution A BUILDING SUPPLY POINT ACCOUNTANT #1 C D D A A C A A D PROJECT ROOM #3 D B C A C C ACCOUNTANT #4 C A ANALYST #5 A C ACCOUNTANT #2 C C A BUILDING SUPPLY POINT A ANALYST #6 D C C A A NONPOWERED PANEL IS APPLIED HERE TO SEPARATE POWERED PANELS WHICH ARE ELECTRICALLY FED FROM DIFFERENT BUILDING SUPPLY POINTS B1 A C Legend: ANALYST #8 ANALYST #7 A C A D C C A = Duplex Receptacle (with circuit identification) D = Duplex Receptacle A B1 A C at different height (with circuit identification) = Power Entry = Powered Panel FILING = Pass-Through Harness = Nonpowered Panel L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 113 Walls Energy Distribution Step Four—Electrical Supply Power is connected from the building electrical supply points to Action Office Series 2 panels by means of power entry products. These are available in two types: base feed (either direct connect or through a junction box) and ceiling feed. The product chosen depends on the site of interface between the building and the Action Office system. Planning for a Second Infeed After determining the number of circuits needed, it may be necessary to plan for additional circuits. In many cases, only one power entry point is required, due to the small number of workstations in an isolated cluster. However, in the floor plan example, the number of circuits required is eight. Assuming that the building is able to deliver up to four circuits at each electrical supply point, two separate power entries are required to power the cluster. A nonpowered panel can be used to separate two different infeeds to create a power break. NONPOWERED PANEL PROVIDES BREAK BETWEEN 2 SEPARATE BUILDING POWER ENTRIES POWER FROM FLOOR TO PANEL BASE FIRST POWER ENTRY (4 CIRCUITS) L POWER FROM BUILDING WALL TO PANEL BASE POWER FROM FIRST POWER ENTRY STOPS HERE SECOND POWER ENTRY (4 ADDITIONAL CIRCUITS) POWER FROM SECOND POWER ENTRY STOPS HERE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 114 Walls Energy Distribution Usually, the most efficient way to access power is to run electricity through central spines and pull power into workstations or branches of workstations where needed. The advantage in the use of spines is the ability to run power from both sides of the spine if needed. (Not only is this usually most cost-effective, it can offer an additional advantage when planning for data and telecommunications cabling, which often shares the raceway with the electrical system. Because a spine often represents the shortest distance from entry point to workstation, it can be an important factor for certain types of cabling whose quality of transmission tends to deteriorate over long distances.) Power Entry Points on the Floor Plan The locations and types of power entry points to supply the cluster of workstations must be identified on the floor plan. If a second infeed is required to power the remaining workstations, it is important to remember that harnesses powered by the first infeed must never be electrically connected to harnesses from the second infeed. If such harnesses are electrically connected, there is a risk of fire or electrical shock. (See “Key Regulations” earlier.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 115 Walls Energy Distribution Summary of Electrical Supply These two drawings illustrate the transfer of power from the building to the Series 2 panels with either one infeed or two. Note how, in the second drawing, a nonpowered panel is used to assure that the two infeeds are never electrically connected to one another. Warning: All power sources must be disconnected prior to servicing. No single circuit may be powered by more than one source. When more than one power entry is required to power a cluster of workstations, harnesses from the first infeed must never be electrically connected to harnesses from another infeed. 6"-WIDE CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL SINGLE POWER ENTRY (4 CIRCUITS) …OR AT WORK POWER HARNESS USED SURFACE HEIGHT TO SUPPLY POWER TO CLUSTER AT BASELINE… 6"-WIDE CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL USED TO DELIVER POWER TO WORK SURFACE HEIGHT NONPOWERED PANEL PROVIDES BREAK BETWEEN 2 SEPARATE BUILDING POWER ENTRIES POWER FROM FLOOR TO PANEL BASE FIRST POWER ENTRY (4 CIRCUITS) POWER HARNESSES USED TO SUPPLY POWER TO CLUSTER (FROM FIRST POWER ENTRY) POWER FROM BUILDING WALL TO PANEL BASE PASS-THROUGH POWER JUMPER POWER FROM FIRST POWER ENTRY STOPS HERE SECOND POWER ENTRY (4 ADDITIONAL CIRCUITS) POWER HARNESSES USED TO SUPPLY POWER TO CLUSTER (FROM SECOND POWER ENTRY) POWER FROM SECOND POWER ENTRY STOPS HERE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 116 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Planning Checklist Keep these key points in mind when planning for a facility’s electrical needs with this Herman Miller power system. • Plan circuits based on the actual amperage draw, not on the maximum number of receptacles allowed. • Accommodate future needs by being conservative in the initial circuit loading (10 to 12 amps per circuit on a 20-amp breaker, or fewer on a 15-amp breaker). • Never exceed the maximum circuit capacities or local code limitations. • Know your local codes! They always take precedence. • Observe continuous-loading limitations (80 percent circuit capacity for devices with three-hour-plus continuous operation). • Determine dedicated, isolated ground, and general circuit needs; plan accordingly for loads and infeeds. • Try to balance loads between circuits. • Never exceed the maximum number of receptacles allowed (13 duplexes per circuit, or per appropriate local code restrictions—whichever is the lower number). • If a single piece of equipment draws more than 80 percent of the available amperage, make sure it is the only device connected to that circuit. • When using a cable management panel, make sure hanging components, like shelves and work tools, do not cover receptacles located above the work surface height; also be sure that individual adjustments to the work surface height— especially with the height-adjustable work surface—do not interfere with access to those receptacles. • Always have electrical layout plans and installations reviewed by a licensed electrician or electrical inspector to ensure that they meet all code requirements. • Never electrically connect harnesses from one infeed to harnesses from another infeed. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 117 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Products Planning Step Product 1. Electrical Needs 2. Electrical Access 3. Electrical Distribution 4. Electrical Supply L Comments Use “Electrical Planning Worksheet”; use typical amperage guidelines only when exact requirements for specific equipment are unavailable. Receptacles For four-circuit, eight-wire system; designed to access circuit a, b, c, or d ; 15 or 20 amps; also options for isolated ground and isolated ground with surge suppression. Be certain which circuits will be live (hooked up to the building) before receptacles are specified. Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet and 3-Outlet; Power Center; and Outlet Strip Electrical distributor, provides 3 or 6 additional 3-prong standard 15-amp receptacles at work surface height; uses one baseline receptacle; power center, alternative to electrical distributor when communication ports also required; provides up to 4 duplex receptacles and 6 communication ports. Powered Panels One-piece harness; shipped installed at panel base; distributes power horizontally along panel base; no other electrical components required for any type of connection. Cable Management Panel Frame (with Panel Faces) Provides vertical chase to bring power vertically from the baseline to work surface height; vertical septum provides separation for power and communication cables; provides 2 duplex receptacle locations above the work surface (1 on the 39"-high panel) on each side; also provides 3 communication port locations on each side. Base Power Adapter Field retrofitted to nonpowered panels to convert panels to powered ones; specified with or without side covers. (Specify without side covers only if nonpowered panels have side covers with receptacle fillers on each side.) Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper Extends power from baseline of powered panel through nonpowered panels to adjacent powered panel. Power Jumper Connects power from baseline to work surface height within cable management panel frame; plugs into receptacle outlet on right of power harness. Harness End Cap Covers unused end port or side port of electrical harness. Cable Management Troughs (AO381. and AO382.) Suspend from panel or work surface to hold multiple-outlet electrical distributor, power center, and outlet strip. Cable Management Trough (AO383.) Chase, attached with adhesive backing horizontally or vertically to panel or wall, to manage and conceal several electrical wires. Cable/Energy Barrier Provides barrier to separate data cables and electrical wires within panel or connector. Base Power Entry, Direct Connect For floor, column, or wall building supply; connects to powered panel at receptacle location; distributes up to 4 20-amp circuits. Base Power Entry, Junction Box For floor, column, or wall building supply; specified with nonpowered panels; no receptacle access; used where local codes require a hardwired solution; distributes up to 4 20-amp circuits. Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit (including TopMounted and Cable Management Panel) For ceiling building supply; attaches to panel end, spacer, or corner connector; distributes up to 4 20-amp circuits; rigid conduit provides metal separation between electrical wiring and communications cabling; topmounted power entry connects electrical supply to top-mounted voice/data cable channel or powered panel; cable management panel power entry connects electrical supply to base of powered panel. Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 118 Walls Energy Distribution Distribution of Energy Once electrical needs have been determined, energy must be brought from the building into this furniture system for distribution through either the baseline or the cable management panel. At certain locations, electrical access points can be established with products that distribute energy horizontally and vertically through the system. Power Entry Power entries distribute electrical power from the building to the panel system. These are available in two types—a base feed (either directly or through a junction box) or a ceiling feed. The type of entry chosen depends on the site of interface between the building (floor, perimeter wall or column, or ceiling) and the Herman Miller systems products. Power Entry Products Entry Point Types of Connection Floor • Direct Connect • Junction Box (hard-wired) Perimeter (wall or column) • Direct Connect • Junction Box (hard-wired) Ceiling • Ceiling Power Entry • Cable Management Panel Ceiling Power Entry • Top-Mounted Ceiling Power Entry Caution: All electrical connections to the building power source must be made by a qualified electrician in accordance with all national and local codes. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 119 Walls Energy Distribution Base Power Entry, Direct Connect, 4 Circuit A1322. Description This power entry connects a building’s electrical supply from a wall, floor, or column to the base of a powered fourcircuit Action Office Series 2 panel or a Series 1 nonpowered panel retrofitted for four-circuit power. It plugs directly into a receptacle location on the panel’s baseline electrical harness to distribute up to four 20-amp circuits. The power entry is manufactured in a right-hand direction but can be field converted to a left-hand direction. The cable is available in four lengths and can be field cut to the appropriate length. The power entry is UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Available in 6', 12', 18', and 24' lengths. Planning Considerations This power entry is used where local codes require a hard-wired power entry. POWER FROM FLOOR TO PANEL BASE The power entry length should closely match the distance between the building’s electrical supply and the receptacle location on the panel. The 12' to 24' lengths are recommended for downstream, multiple power supply from a single building entry point. (Special ground-contact terminals inside the liquid-tight conduit maintain the integrity of the ground function for these extended lengths.) When a direct-connect power entry is used, receptacles can still be mounted in all other receptacle locations on the panel, including the one opposite the base power entry. POWER FROM BUILDING WALL TO PANEL BASE 3 RECEPTACLE LOCATIONS AVAILABLE RECEPTACLE LOCATIONS ON THIS SIDE ONLY LIQUID-TIGHT FLEXIBLE CONDUIT Energy can be distributed in either direction by setting the direction of the connection during installation or reconfiguration. This power entry must be wired by a licensed electrician. CONNECTION DISTRIBUTION HARNESS L 90Å CONDUIT CONNECTOR (PROTRUDES WIDTH OF CONDUIT) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 120 Walls Energy Distribution Limitations Base power entry cannot be used on a 12"- or 18"-wide panel, since it has no receptacle locations in its base, nor on a 6"-wide cable management panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 121 Walls Energy Distribution Base Power Entry, Junction Box, 4 Circuit A1323. Description This power entry connects a building’s electrical supply from a wall, floor, or column to the base of a nonpowered Action Office Series 2 panel or a Series 1 nonpowered panel retrofitted for fourcircuit power; it distributes up to four 20amp circuits. It includes a junction box, an electrical harness, and an expanded side cover. The power entry also includes 6' of wire that can be field cut to the appropriate length for connection to the building’s power. It does not provide receptacle access. The power entry is UL listed and CSA certified. 24"- to 36"-wide power entries have a 40-cubic-inch capacity and distribute power in one direction; 42"- to 60"-wide power entries have a 60-cubic-inch capacity and distribute power in both directions. JUNCTION BOX DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY Dimensions Available in widths to match standard 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" panel sizes. FOR USE WITH 24"AND 36"-WIDE PANELS Planning Considerations This power entry is used where local codes require a hard-wired power entry. The power entry width must match the width of the panel on which it will be used. Power can be distributed only in the direction opposite the junction box in 24"- and 36"-wide panels. Since the hole in the side cover is off center, the cover determines the direction of power distribution and must be located on the correct side of the panel. Power in 42", 48", 54", and 60" panels can be distributed in both directions. L JUNCTION BOX DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY FOR USE WITH 42"-, 48"-, 54"-, AND 60"-WIDE PANELS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 122 Walls Energy Distribution Exterior wires that connect the junction box to the building’s electrical supply must be covered with conduit. A licensed electrician must supply and wire the conduit and the conduit connector. When local electrical codes require wiring connections inside the junction box, a licensed electrician must also wire the connection to the electrical harnesses. Limitations A junction box power entry cannot be used on a 12"- or 18"-wide panel, nor on a 6"-wide cable management panel. NONPOWERED PANEL (WITH POWER ENTRY INSTALLED) ELECTRICAL CONNECTION (TO BE FIELD WIRED) The power entry must be field installed. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 123 Walls Energy Distribution Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit A1331. Description This power entry connects a ceiling’s electrical supply to the base of a powered four-circuit Action Office Series 2 panel or retrofitted Series 1 panel at the end of a panel run or at a three- or four-way 90° connector. It distributes up to four 20-amp circuits and holds up to 110 Category 5 cables. The power entry has a 10 1/2' pole, which can be field cut to the appropriate length; ceiling and base trim; a rigid conduit and conduit connector; and a factory-installed electrical harness. The rigid conduit encloses electrical wires and provides metal separation for voice/ data cables. The power entry is UL listed and CSA certified. CONNECT TO BUILDING ELECTRICAL SUPPLY CEILING CEILING BEZEL Dimensions Available to fit 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" panel heights. Exterior width of ceiling bezel is 7" (nominal); depth is 6" (nominal). Exterior width of power entry is 3 7/8"; depth is 3 1/8". POWERED PANEL CEILING ENTRY EXTRUSION Interior cavity depth of both ceiling bezel and power entry is 2 3/4"; width is 1 1/2" with power and 3 1/2" without power. Planning Considerations The ceiling power entry, when attached to a three-way or four-way 90° connector, can be used on any side of the connector not already attached to a panel; the product does not prevent the future connection of a panel in that same position on the connector. POWER POLE HANGER CLIP CEILING POWER ENTRY CAN BE LOCATED ON ANY ATTACHING CONNECTOR SIDE NOT ALREADY CONNECTED TO PANEL The ceiling power entry is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is used for voice/ data cable entry only. The capacity of the power entry is 120 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (without power) or 90 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (with power). The ceiling power entry can connect to a nonpowered panel if used only for voice/ data cable entry. L 4-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 124 Walls Energy Distribution Because the internal capacity of the nonpowered version of the power entry is greater than that of the panel baseline raceway, when the cables reach the panel base, they may need to be divided and routed in different directions. POWERED: ELECTRICAL WIRING ENCLOSED IN ⁄«™" TRADE-SIZE ELECTRICAL METALLIC TUBING A 10 1/2' length of 1/2" trade-size electrical metallic tubing (knocked down) encloses the wiring up to the ceiling junction box. The internal electrical harness must be installed in conduit as required by national codes. The power entry must be properly wired by a licensed electrician, according to national and local code specification, with conduit in the ceiling terminating in a junction box. Limitations This power entry cannot be used with 32" and 39" panel heights. This product cannot be used to provide access to the energy system or to the voice/data cabling. NONPOWERED: VOICE/DATA CABLE ENTRY ONLY CEILING BEZEL VOICE/DATA CABLE ENTRY (SEPARATED FROM ELECTRICAL WIRING BY CONDUIT ENCLOSING WIRING) INTERIOR CAVITY APPROXIMATELY 2 ‹«¢" x 1 ⁄/™" INTERIOR CAVITY APPROXIMATELY 2 ‹«¢" x 3 ⁄/™" CONNECTION TO DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY CAPACITY— WITHOUT POWER: 120 4-PAIR UTP CATEGORY 5 CABLES WITH POWER: 90 4-PAIR UTP CATEGORY 5 CABLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 125 Walls Energy Distribution Ceiling Power Entry, 4 Circuit, Top Mounted NP239. Description This power entry connects a ceiling’s electrical supply to a top-mounted voice/ data cable channel or Action Office Series 2 panel base or a Series 1 panel base with the four-circuit retrofit kit. It distributes up to four 20-amp circuits. The power entry has a 10 1/2' pole, which can be field cut to the appropriate length; ceiling and end cap trim; a rigid conduit and conduit connector; and a factory-installed electrical harness. The rigid conduit encloses electrical wires and provides metal separation for voice/ data cables. The power entry is UL listed and CSA certified. Shipped knocked down. CONNECT TO BUILDING ELECTRICAL SUPPLY ALLOWS VOICE/DATA CABLES TO BE DISTRIBUTED HORIZONTALLY WITHIN OPTIONAL VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL CEILING POWERED PANEL OR NONPOWERED PANEL The power entry without power holds up to 120 4-pair Category 5 cables; the power entry with power holds up to 90 4pair Category 5 cables. POWERED PANEL OR NONPOWERED PANEL Dimensions Available to fit 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" panel heights. Exterior width is 7" (nominal); depth is 5 1/4" (nominal). Interior cavity width is 2 3/4"; depth is 1 1/2" with power and 3 1/2" without power. Planning Considerations This ceiling power entry has an opening at the same height as the adjacent panel height that allows the voice/data cables to be distributed horizontally within the optional voice/data cable channel along the top of the panel. The ceiling power entry can be used at the end of a panel run or attached to a connector within a panel run. When attached to a three-way or four-way 90° connector, this ceiling power entry can be used on any side of the connector not already attached to a panel; the product does not prevent the future connection of a panel in that same position on the connector. L POWER POLE HANGER CLIP CEILING POWER ENTRY CAN BE LOCATED ON ANY ATTACHING CONNECTOR SIDE NOT ALREADY CONNECTED TO PANEL 4-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 126 Walls Energy Distribution The ceiling power entry is available in powered and nonpowered versions. The nonpowered version is used for voice/ data cable entry only. The capacity of the power entry is 120 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (without power) or 90 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (with power). The ceiling power entry can connect to a nonpowered panel if used only for voice/ data cable entry. Because the internal capacity of the nonpowered version of the power entry is greater than that of the panel baseline raceway, when the cables reach the panel base, they may need to be divided and routed in different directions. A 10 1/2' length of 1/2" trade-size electrical metallic tubing (knocked down) encloses the wiring up to the ceiling junction box. POWERED: ELECTRICAL WIRING ENCLOSED IN ⁄«™" TRADE-SIZE ELECTRICAL METALLIC TUBING VOICE/DATA CABLE ENTRY (SEPARATED FROM ELECTRICAL WIRING BY CONDUIT ENCLOSING WIRING) Limitations This power entry cannot be used with 32" and 39" panel heights. CEILING BEZEL OPENINGS OPPOSITE PANEL TOP TO DISTRIBUTE VOICE/ DATA CABLES WITHIN VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL INTERIOR CAVITY APPROXIMATELY 2 ‹«¢" x 1 ⁄/™" The internal electrical harness must be installed in conduit as required by national codes. The power entry must be properly wired by a licensed electrician, according to national and local code specification, with conduit in the ceiling terminating in a junction box. NONPOWERED: VOICE/DATA TELECOMMUNICATION CABLE ENTRY ONLY CONNECTION TO DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY INTERIOR CAVITY APPROXIMATELY 2 ‹«¢" x 3 ⁄/™" CAPACITY— WITHOUT POWER: 120 4-PAIR UTP CATEGORY 5 CABLES WITH POWER: 90 4-PAIR UTP CATEGORY 5 CABLES This product cannot be used to provide access to the energy system or to the voice/data cabling. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 127 Walls Energy Distribution Ceiling Power Entry, Cable Management Panel A1332. Description This 6"-wide power entry connects a ceiling’s electrical supply to the base of a powered panel and distributes up to four 20-amp circuits. It has a structural frame that holds a cable management panel face on each side; an extender, which can be cut to the appropriate length; ceiling and base trim; rigid conduit; connecting hardware; and a factory-installed electrical harness. The conduit encloses electrical wires and provides metal separation for voice/data cables. The maximum height of the power entry is 10'-6". Power cannot be accessed through the frame. The power entry is UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Available in 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" heights (excluding extender). Width is 6". CONNECTS CEILING POWER SUPPLY TO PANEL BASE EXTENDER REACHES MAXIMUM 10'-6" CEILING (CUT ON SITE FOR LOWER CEILING) Interior cavity width is approximately 5 3/8"; depth is 1 5/8". Planning Considerations The ceiling power entry can be located anywhere in a panel run except at the end, because it cannot accept a finished end or a change-of-height finished end. The ceiling power entry is also available without the electrical assembly for entry of voice/data cables only. When used for only voice/data cables, it can attach at the base to a nonpowered panel. INTERIOR CAVITY APPROXIMATELY 5 ‹«•" x 1 fi«•" FOR DISTRIBUTION OF POWER ONLY— NO ACCESS POINTS; ACCESS LOCATIONS FOR VOICE/DATA CABLES—FIELD CUT L ORDER IN HEIGHT TO MATCH ADJACENT PANELS HOLDS CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FACES ON BOTH SIDES (ORDERED SEPARATELY— FOR BOTTOM PORTION ONLY) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 128 Walls Energy Distribution Order this ceiling power entry to match the height of the adjacent panels; it comes with the appropriate-length extender to reach a 10'-6" ceiling. (For lower ceilings, the extender can be cut to size on site.) Because this ceiling power entry serves as a power distribution component only, there is no electrical access, so the nonpowered cable management panel face should be specified, separately. If access is desired to the voice/data cables, ports can be custom cut in the panel face on site. The cable capacity for the nonpowered version is 48 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables; the capacity for the powered version is 36 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables. The power entry can be uncovered for easy installation of cables. DISTRIBUTES UP TO 4 20-AMP CIRCUITS (POWERED VERSION ONLY) AND VOICE/DATA CABLES To connect the power entry to a panel, order a draw rod separately. To connect the power entry to a connector, no additional parts are needed. (The connector includes the attachment hardware.) The ceiling power entry must be wired by a licensed electrician, and the ceiling junction box must be supplied by a licensed electrician. Options To connect the cable management panel ceiling power entry to an adjacent panel, order the Draw Rod (AO214.) separately. Order the Cable Management Panel Face, Side 1 (A1181.), and the Cable Management Panel Face, Side 2 (A1182.), separately, to enclose the 6"wide panel frame. Limitations This product cannot be used to provide access to the energy system; access to voice/data cabling must be field cut. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 129 Walls Energy Distribution Baseline Distribution The baseline is the primary location for carrying power horizontally from the point of power entry to places throughout the facility where electricity is needed. The distribution can be from one or more building access points. Baseline power can be distributed in three directions: left and right (through the baseline) and vertically (through the cable management panel). All baseline energy distribution is concealed behind the hinged cover assembly. Receptacles can be installed for access to power from either side of the panel. PASS-THROUGH CAPABILITY ONLY— NO ACCESS ACCESS TO POWER AT BASELINE HORIZONTAL DISTRIBUTION IN BOTH DIRECTIONS THROUGH PANEL BASE L NOTE: SAME CAPABILITIES ON OPPOSITE SIDE OF PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 130 Walls Energy Distribution Base Power Adapter, 4 Circuit A1354. Side Covers A1355. No Side Covers Description This power adapter converts a nonpowered panel to a powered panel. It has an electrical harness that distributes up to four 20-amp circuits. The power adapter is UL listed and CSA certified. The power adapter with side covers includes receptacle fillers. 6"- to 18"-wide power adapters have no receptacle locations; 24"- to 60"-wide power adapters have two receptacle locations per side. Dimensions Available in 6", 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths to match standard panel sizes. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 131 Walls Energy Distribution Planning Considerations This product is available with or without side covers, depending on whether the panel to be converted already has side covers with receptacle locations in place. (If so, the power adapter without side covers is the appropriate choice.) The 6"-wide base power adapter allows power to pass through a nonpowered cable management panel at the baseline, but it does not provide it with the capability of delivering power to the work surface. The power adapter is available with or without a metal barrier for separation of electrical and voice/data cables. (The barrier is not available on the 6"-wide base power adapter.) The power adapter does not include receptacles. WITH SIDE COVERS DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY SIDE COVERS FOR USE WITH 24"-, 30"-, 36"-, 42"-, 48"-, AND 60"WIDE PANELS WITHOUT SIDE COVERS DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY The power adapter must be field installed. Options Order the Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp (A1311.), or Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp (X1311.), separately. Limitations The base power adapter with side covers is not available for the 6"-wide cable management panel or 12"- or 18"wide panels. L FOR USE WITH 6"-, 12"-, 18"-, 24"-, 30"-, 36"-, 42"-, 48"-, AND 60"-WIDE PANELS NOTE: FOR PANELS 6", 12", AND 18" WIDE, NO RECEPTACLE LOCATIONS AND NO DISTRIBUTION ASSEMBLY Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 132 Walls Energy Distribution Panel Pass-Through Power Jumper A1342. Description This harness extends power from a powered panel through a nonpowered panel to an adjacent powered panel. It does not provide receptacle access. The power jumper is UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths to match standard panel sizes. Planning Considerations Power jumpers are not available for 6"-, 12"-, or 18"-wide panels. To distribute power through a nonpowered 6"-wide cable management panel or a 12"- or 18"-wide panel completing a panel run, the panel can be retrofit with a base power adapter. PROVIDES DISTRIBUTION OF POWER—NO ACCESS FOR USE WITH 24"-, 30"-, 36"-, 42"-, 48", AND 60"-WIDE PANELS There is no limit to the number of passthrough power jumpers that can be attached together. The power jumper must be field installed. Limitations The power jumper does not provide receptacle access. The power jumper is not available to fit the 6"-wide cable management panel frame or 12"- and 18"-wide panels. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 133 Walls Energy Distribution Harness End Cap B1358. Description This cap covers the unused end port or side port of an electrical harness. It also serves as a visual indicator for the last harness in a series of powered products. Cap is red. Package contains 10. Dimensions Height is 2". Width is 3/4". Depth is 1/2". Planning Considerations The harness end cap helps ensure against accidentally connecting harnesses from more than one power entry, especially during reconfigurations. The harness end cap can be removed later if the electrical distribution is to continue to an adjacent harness. The city of Los Angeles requires end caps on all unused harness ends. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 134 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Bridge A1370. Description This bridge connects an electrical harness with the E power option to an electrical harness with the D power option. It is UL listed and CSA certified. Package contains five. Dimensions Width is 10 3/4". Planning Considerations This bridge connects an earlier version (D) of the four-circuit energy system to a newer version (E) of the four-circuit system for uninterrupted energy distribution through the system. (Once the flexible electrical connector is removed from the old system, the electrical bridge is snapped into the power block of the old system and the end of the power harness of the new system.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 135 Walls Energy Distribution Vertical Distribution Baseline power is distributed vertically through the cable management panel to predetermined access locations just above the work surface. (The cable management panel, if desired, can also distribute voice/data cables—physically separated from power transmissions by a metal septum.) The wires (and cables) are concealed between segmented panel faces that fit over both sides of the panel frame and provide access to power from either side of the cable management panel. VERTICAL DISTRIBUTION OF BASELINE POWER THROUGH 6"-WIDE CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL ACCESS TO POWER AT WORK SURFACE HEIGHT NOTE: SAME CAPABILITIES ON OPPOSITE SIDE OF PANEL L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 136 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Access The primary means of electrical access in this Herman Miller four-circuit energy system is the receptacle; while most receptacles in the system are duplex, the isolated ground with surge suppression is a simplex receptacle—whether for circuits b or c or the dedicated circuit d. When receptacles are installed, access to power is available from that side of the panel through cutouts in either the base or the cable management panel. When receptacles are installed on both sides, power access is available from one or both sides of the panel. Receptacles can also be provided at the work surface, either mounted to its underside, fitted in a trough, or placed in a bracket on top of the surface. With the power center and the multi-outlet electrical distributor, up to six receptacles can be grouped in a single unit; and with the power center, receptacles and communication ports can be combined in the same unit. Receptacles are available at 15- or 20-ampere ratings (although not every component offers both). They are marked to signify which circuit they access, as well as to show isolated ground capability. For a detailed discussion of receptacle capacities and planning considerations, see “Circuit Capacity and Configurations,” “Key Regulations,” and “Planning Process Overview” in this “Energy Distribution” section. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 137 Walls Energy Distribution Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp A1311. Description This receptacle locks into the baseline harness of an Action Office Series 2 panel, the stretcher of an Arrio work surface, or a Liaison cabinet in a backto-back configuration. It is UL listed and CSA certified. A duplex receptacle package contains six receptacles; a simplex receptacle package contains one. Dimensions Height is 2". Overall width is 4 5/8". Depth is 1 1/2". Planning Considerations Receptacles for this four-circuit, eightwire system are designed to access circuit a, b, c, or d. Optional isolated ground and isolated ground with surge suppression versions are also available for the b, c, and d circuits; each of these has orange circuit letters as well as an orange triangle to facilitate user identification. The types of receptacles available, along with the circuits they access, are shown on the chart below: Circuit Type Description A B C D BI CI BIS CIS DIS Duplex, circuit a Duplex, circuit b Duplex, circuit c Duplex, circuit d, isolated ground Duplex, circuit b, isolated ground Duplex, circuit c, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit b, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit c, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit d, isolated ground If any of the isolated ground receptacles (BI, CI, etc.) are used, they access the same neutral and ground as the d circuit and consequently negate the dedicated function of the d circuit. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 138 Walls Energy Distribution A BI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a b receptacle, and vice versa; and a CI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a c receptacle, and vice versa. The optional surge suppression is designed to provide added protection from the hazards of power surges; this is especially critical for computers or other sophisticated equipment. The receptacle contains integrated components, which provide the protection, as well as an LED (Light-Emitting Diode) for visual indication of proper operation; if the LED fails to light, it means the surge suppression capability has been exhausted and the receptacle should be replaced. The advantage that surge-suppression receptacles offer over a centrally protected electrical system is that electrical equipment is protected not only from outside power surges but also from power surges that occur inside the building. They also protect equipment using the same circuits from affecting each other. Surge suppression is provided by three metal oxide varistors (MOVs) mounted on a small circuit board. The specifications for the surge-suppression capability are these: • Transient energy—70 joules maximum • Transient peak current—6500 amps maximum • Clamping voltage—340 volts maximum at 50 amps Note: The surge-suppression receptacle is UL listed, based on UL 1449 standard for transient voltage suppressors. All receptacles are duplex (two plugs), except for the isolated ground with surge suppression, which is simplex (one plug)—whether for circuits b or c or the dedicated circuit d. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 139 Walls Energy Distribution Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 20 Amp X1311. Description This receptacle locks into a four-circuit electrical harness to provide power to equipment with a 20-amp standard plug head. It also accepts 15-amp standard plug heads. The receptacle is UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Height is 2". Overall width is 4 5/8". Depth is 1 1/2". Planning Considerations This receptacle is designed for components that require more power than 15-amp receptacles can provide. The total connected load for this receptacle should not exceed 16 amps. (If one piece of equipment requires all available power, the receptacle’s second outlet should not be used; additional receptacles can be installed on that circuit. In many cases, equipment requiring this receptacle will use all available power.) Receptacles for this four-circuit, eightwire system are designed to access circuit a, b, c, or d. Optional isolated ground versions are also available for the b, c, and d circuits; each of these has orange circuit letters as well as an orange triangle to facilitate user identification. The types of receptacles available, along with the circuits they access, are shown on the chart below: Circuit Type Description AT BT CT DT BIT CIT Circuit a Circuit b Circuit c Circuit d, isolated ground Circuit b, isolated ground Circuit c, isolated ground L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 140 Walls Energy Distribution If any of the isolated ground receptacles (BI, CI, etc.) are used, they access the same neutral and ground as the d circuit and consequently negate the dedicated function of the d circuit. A BI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a b receptacle, and a CI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a c receptacle. All receptacles are duplex (two plugs)— whether for circuits b or c or the dedicated circuit d. Limitations When the receptacle is locked into the baseline harness of an Action Office Series 3 powered panel, the receptacle extends 5/8" from the trim cover. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 141 Walls Energy Distribution Receptacle, 4 Circuit, 15 Amp K1311. Description This receptacle locks into the electrical harness of an Action Office Series 3 powered panel, a Liaison powered cabinet, an Arrio powered work surface, or an Action Office Series 2 or 3 powered cable management panel frame to provide power to equipment with a 15-amp standard plug head. The receptacle is UL listed and CSA certified. A duplex receptacle package contains six receptacles; a simplex receptacle package contains one. Dimensions Height is 2". Overall width is 4 5/8". Depth is 7/8". Planning Considerations Receptacles for this four-circuit, eightwire system are designed to access circuit a, b, c, or d. Optional isolated ground and isolated ground with surge suppression versions are also available for the b, c, and d circuits; each of these has orange circuit letters as well as an orange triangle to facilitate user identification. The types of receptacles available, along with the circuits they access, are shown on the chart below: Circuit Type Description A B C D BI CI BIS CIS DIS Duplex, circuit a Duplex, circuit b Duplex, circuit c Duplex, circuit d, isolated ground Duplex, circuit b, isolated ground Duplex, circuit c, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit b, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit c, isolated ground Simplex, surge suppression, circuit d, isolated ground L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 142 Walls Energy Distribution If any of the isolated ground receptacles (BI, CI, etc.) are used, they access the same neutral and ground as the d circuit and consequently negate the dedicated function of the d circuit. A BI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a b receptacle, and vice versa; and a CI receptacle should never be used on the same circuit with a c receptacle, and vice versa. The optional surge suppression is designed to provide added protection from the hazards of power surges; this is especially critical for computers or other sophisticated equipment. The receptacle contains integrated components, which provide the protection, as well as an LED (Light-Emitting Diode) for visual indication of proper operation; if the LED fails to light, it means the surge suppression capability has been exhausted and the receptacle should be replaced. The advantage that surge-suppression receptacles offer over a centrally protected electrical system is that electrical equipment is protected not only from outside power surges but also from power surges that occur inside the building. They also protect equipment using the same circuits from affecting each other. Surge suppression is provided by three metal oxide varistors (MOVs) mounted on a small circuit board. The specifications for the surge-suppression capability are these: • Transient energy—70 joules maximum • Transient peak current—6500 amps maximum • Clamping voltage—340 volts maximum at 50 amps Note: The surge-suppression receptacle is UL listed, based on UL 1449 standard for transient voltage suppressors. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 143 Walls Energy Distribution All receptacles are duplex (two plugs), except for the isolated ground with surge suppression, which is simplex (one plug)—whether for circuits b or c or the dedicated circuit d. Liaison cabinets placed back to back require the A1311. four-circuit receptacle rather than the K1311. receptacle. For Action Office Series 2 panels: When specifying receptacles for the Action Office Series 2 cable management panel frame, order the four-circuit receptacle (K1311.); when specifying them for all other Series 2 panels, order the four-circuit receptacle (A1311.) or the 20-amp four-circuit receptacle (X1311.). L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 144 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Distributor, 3 Outlet G1313. Description This electrical distributor attaches to an Action Office panel-suspended cable management trough or Ethospace cable management trough or fits in a Newhouse Group cable management channel, an Arrio electrical distributor bracket, or the stretcher on an Arrio work surface. It provides additional receptacles at work surface height and has three standard, three-prong receptacles with a 15-amp circuit breaker. The electrical distributor is UL listed and CSA certified. 7 1/2" 2 3/8" 2" Dimensions Width is 7 1/2"; depth is 2 3/8". Planning Considerations Placing the multi-outlet electrical distributor at work surface height allows easy access for users; this is especially helpful to workers with reach limitations. Placing the electrical distributor below the work surface makes the receptacles slightly less accessible, but hides them from view. To use the electrical distributor above an Arrio work surface, order an Arrio electrical distributor bracket. Ethospace work surfaces, Arrio table desks, and Newhouse Group table desks have integral channels that will hold the electrical distributor; they require no additional components. To use the electrical distributor below the work surface height, use an Action Office cable management trough. 3-OUTLET ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTOR BENEATH WORK SURFACE CABLE MANAGEMENT TROUGH The distributor is available in a version with surge suppression that has an LED indicator and noise-filtration components. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 145 Walls Energy Distribution Options To hold the electrical distributor at work surface height on an Arrio table desk, order the Bracket, Multi-Outlet Electrical Distributor (XR130.), separately. For use with Action Office products, order the Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.), or the Cable Management Trough, Work Surface Suspended (AO382.), separately. Limitations Check the local electrical codes for acceptable applications; some do not permit the use of this electrical distributor. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 146 Walls Energy Distribution Electrical Distributor, Multi-Outlet NP289. Description This electrical distributor attaches to an Action Office panel-suspended cable management trough or Ethospace cable management trough or fits in a Newhouse Group cable management channel, an Arrio electrical distributor bracket, or the stretcher on an Arrio work surface. It provides additional receptacles at work surface height and has six standard, three-prong receptacles with a 15-amp circuit breaker. The electrical distributor is UL listed and CSA certified. MULTI-OUTLET ELECTRICAL DISTRIBUTOR BENEATH WORK SURFACE Dimensions Width is 12"; depth is 2 3/8". Planning Considerations The distributor is available in a version with surge suppression that has an LED indicator and noise-filtration components. Placing the multi-outlet electrical distributor at work surface height allows easy access for users; this is especially helpful to workers with reach limitations. Placing the electrical distributor below the work surface makes the receptacles slightly less accessible, but hides them from view. CABLE MANAGEMENT TROUGH Ethospace work surfaces, Arrio table desks, and Newhouse Group table desks have integral channels that will hold the electrical distributor; they require no additional components. To use the electrical distributor below the work surface height, use an Action Office cable management trough. Options For use with Action Office products, order the Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.), or the Cable Management Trough, Work Surface Suspended (AO382.), separately. Limitations This electrical distributor is not permitted under some local codes. Check the local electrical codes for acceptable applications. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 147 Walls Energy Distribution Power Center NP359. Description This power center mounts under a work surface with cable ports; it can also be field mounted under an existing Action Office work surface for high-density cable management. The power center has a hinged door for access to duplexes and cables and a 6' power cord that plugs into an Action Office or standard duplex receptacle. Electrical and voice/data cables are separate and exit the raceway from opposite sides. The voice/data locations are designed for Epitome connectors. The 21"-wide power center cannot mount under a work surface less than 24" wide; the 42"-wide power center cannot mount under a work surface less than 48" wide. POWER CENTER HINGED DOOR Dimensions Widths are 21" and 42". Height is 8". Depth is 6". Planning Considerations The power center is an alternative to a multi-outlet distributor when communication ports are required in addition to 15-amp duplex receptacles. The various sizes and configurations of power centers offer combinations of up to four 15-amp duplexes and six Epitome communication ports. Although its location beneath the work surface makes the receptacles and cable communication modules slightly less accessible, the power center is hidden from view when installed. Voice/data connections must be field wired. Faceplates for Epitome cable communication modules are not provided and must be purchased separately from the manufacturer. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 148 Walls Energy Distribution Outlet Strip AO371. Description This multi-outlet strip attaches to a panel or wall strip to provide additional outlets at the panel baseline. It has four grounded receptacles and is UL listed and CSA certified. Dimensions Width is 1 1/4"; height is 12". Planning Considerations A licensed electrician must field wire the outlet strip to meet local electrical codes. Options To attach the outlet strip to a panel or wall strip, order the Mounting Kit (AO372.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 149 Walls Energy Distribution Cable Port Outlet Strip NP358. Description This putty-colored multi-outlet strip mounts under a work surface with cable ports. It provides additional outlets and manages cables beneath the work surface. It has a 6' power cord. Dimensions Widths are 12" and 15". Depth is 2". Planning Considerations Specify the four-outlet strip for the 13 1/2"- or 19 1/2"-wide cable port in the work surface; specify the six-outlet strip for the 19 1/2"-wide cable port. The outlets pop up when the cable port lid is raised, making them accessible from the top of the work surface. A licensed electrician must field wire the outlet strip to meet local electrical codes. Options Order the optional Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended (AO381.), separately. To access the cable port outlet strip from the top of a work surface, order the Cable Port (NP360.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 150 Walls Energy Distribution Mounting Kit AO372. Description This kit attaches an outlet strip to a panel or wall strip. Planning Considerations This mounting kit attaches to the slots in the panel hanger rails or wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 151 Walls Energy Distribution Extension Cord AO373. Description This black, 9' extension cord has three grounding-type outlets. Dimensions Length of the extension cord is 9'. Width of the outlet block is 5 1/2". Planning Considerations The extension cord provides additional length when the equipment plug cannot reach the receptacle. Limitations An extension cord may not be permitted under some local codes. Check the local codes for acceptable practices. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 152 Walls Energy Distribution Faceplate with Cutouts G1310. Description This faceplate allows voice/data cables to exit from receptacle locations. Package contains twelve. Dimensions Width is 3 1/4". Height is 2". Planning Considerations This faceplate covers most of a baseline receptacle location while providing exit holes for two voice/data cables. It replaces the solid-face receptacle location cover and is used as an alternative to having cables exit at their normal location at the end of the panel or frame. Voice and data cables must be able to fit through exit holes that are 1/2" high and 3/8" wide. (Larger cables must exit through the end of the panel or frame.) Limitations The beltline faceplate can be used only with Ethospace frames. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 153 Walls Cable Management Cable Management In modern offices, with their increasing use of sophisticated, sensitive equipment, there are masses of cables to be accommodated. The primary distribution of voice and data cables usually parallels the building’s electrical system, but a separate system of chases, conduits, and raceways is used. Action Office Series 2 panels provide an attractive, easy-to-use solution for managing cables. There are four means of cable management—the panel base raceway, the vertical cable management panel, the panel-top voice/data cable channel (for equalheight panel runs only), and the external cable management troughs. Used together, they form an integrated system to meet the full range of cable management needs. OPTIONAL VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL AT TOP OF PANEL CABLE MANAGEMENT TROUGH (EXTERNAL) CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL PANEL BASE RACEWAY OPTIONAL METAL BARRIER TO SEPARATE SENSITIVE DATA TRANSMISSION CABLES FROM ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS CABLES ROUTED BENEATH CABLE/ENERGY BARRIER FLEXIBLE TRIM EDGE FOR EASY ENTRY AND EXIT OF DATA LINES OPTIONAL DATA PORT LOCATION (1 PER SIDE) L HINGED COVER Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 154 Walls Cable Management Cable Management Overview Action Office Series 2 panels offer these specific features for managing cables: • A horizontal cable distribution channel, with hinged side covers for easy access, at the panel base (channel conceals cables and Local Area Network [LAN] cables) • A vertical distribution channel, separated from the electrical system by a barrier, in the cable management panel; snap-on panel faces offer lay-in capability, conceal the cabling, and provide access without removing the work surfaces • An optional panel-top channel to distribute cables horizontally, while separating them from the panel base distribution channel • Access options at the baseline and work surface height on the cable management panel • An optional cable/energy barrier to separate cables from the electrical harness in the panel base L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 155 Walls Cable Management Cable Access and Cable Management Products (Four Circuit) Product Capacity Characteristics Panel Base Raceway • 60 4-pair Category 5 capacity (powered) • 120 4-pair Category 5 capacity (nonpowered) • 6" bend radius at corners Provides horizontal channel at base of panel to carry voice/data cables, as well as electrical harness; has cable access openings at ends Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel and Connector • Reduces cable management capacity to 18 4-pair Category 5 Provides barrier to separate data cables and electrical wires Voice/Data Cable Channel, and Connector and End Cap • 40 4-pair Category 5 capacity • 1" – 2" bend radius Provides horizontal channel at top of panel to carry voice/data cables Cable Management Panel • 50 4-pair Category 5 capacity (powered) • 59 4-pair Category 5 capacity (nonpowered) Provides vertical chase for cabling or access to power and data/ telecommunications at work surface height; septum provides separation for power and communications Ceiling Power Entry and Extender for Cable Management Panel • 23 4-pair Category 5 capacity from ceiling to top of panel (within extender) • 90 4-pair Category 5 capacity from panel top to base (when panel is powered) • 120 4-pair Category 5 capacity from panel top to base (when panel is nonpowered) Carries communication cabling vertically from ceiling to top of cable management panel; provides chase for ceiling supply Ceiling Power Entry • 90 4-pair Category 5 capacity (powered) • 120 4-pair Category 5 capacity (nonpowered) Carries cabling (as well as electrical wires) vertically from ceiling to base of powered panel Cable Management Troughs (AO381. and AO382.) • Not applicable Suspend from panel or work surface to manage, store, and conceal excess cord lengths Cable Management Trough (AO383.) • Not applicable Chase, attached with adhesive backing horizontally or vertically to panel or wall to manage and conceal cables Cable Port • 38 4-pair Category 5 capacity (12" width) • 80 4-pair Category 5 capacity (18" width) Provides hinged, covered opening on field-modified work surface for cable pass-through Panel L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 156 Walls Cable Management Cable management involves a number of issues: Supply: How will the voice/data cables get from the building to the distribution points? Cable Types: Which type of cable is being used or is needed, and what are its requirements for bending and for turning corners? Capacity: How much physical room is there for the cables themselves, and what kind of and how much data can different types of cabling carry? Distribution: How will voice/data cables be distributed—and over what distances and in what directions? Separation: How can more sensitive data cables be separated from interference from higher-voltage power? How much separation and what kind is necessary— and how can it best be achieved? Reconfiguration: How do the cabling needs change—frequency, kind, and extent? Access: How should the cables be terminated—at the equipment itself or to a modular jack? A discussion of these issues in greater detail follows. OPTIONAL PANEL-TOP CHANNEL—CARRIES COMMUNICATIONS HORIZONTALLY BETWEEN ADJACENT EQUAL-HEIGHT PANELS VERTICAL CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL— CARRIES COMMUNICATIONS VERTICALLY TO WORK SURFACE, PANEL BASE, AND OTHER CUSTOM LOCATIONS CARRIES POWER VERTICALLY TO WORK SURFACE HEIGHT (SEPARATED FROM DATA CABLES) CABLE MANAGEMENT TROUGH— CARRIES CABLES (AND WIRES) HORIZONTALLY BENEATH WORK SURFACE (EXTERNAL) PANEL BASE—CARRIES BOTH POWER AND VOICE/DATA CABLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 157 Walls Cable Management Supply A fundamental issue with cabling in the office is understanding where within the building it is possible to gain access to the data and telecommunications network. There are several different building supply methods, some conventional and in widespread use (networks through walls, columns, and ceilings), others newer and more flexible (underfloor and flat-wire methods). It is important to know which method(s) are used in the building structure, because this will affect how much of the cable distribution must be carried by the furniture system. It is this interface between building distribution and distribution by the interior furnishings that determines how much flexibility in layout is allowed. For example, an underfloor system can minimize the need for horizontal cable management via systems furniture, since cables can be brought, through the floor, directly to where they are needed in a workstation. This can be an important consideration when dealing with types of transmission in which quality is affected by distance from the building supply. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 158 Walls Cable Management Cable Types The amount of cable any furniture system can accommodate is a function of both the overall space available and the type of cable used. This is because some cables and wires bend more easily than others; consequently, corner connections frequently become the limiting factor. Action Office Series 2 panels not only provide sufficient space, but the wide arc formed at corner connections can also accommodate virtually any type of cable, up to and including fiber optics. Cables and wires can enter and exit the cable management base at each end of the side cover through flexible gaskets. Cable type is therefore critical for determining actual capacity. Most communication networks use one of the following cable types: Unshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP) Cable This cable consists of pairs of insulated wires twisted around each other and covered by a protective coating. These wires are usually combined in multiples of pairs (e.g., 4-pair, 25-pair, 100-pair). Most telephone lines are twisted-pair cables, but this type is increasingly being used to transmit data as well as voice communications. Both IBM and AT&T use twisted-pair cables in their systems. This cable is unshielded and bends freely, which means that this Herman Miller furniture system easily accommodates it. OUTER JACKET 4-PAIR TWISTED PAIR Unshielded twisted-pair cables are categorized according to the speed of transmission and, ultimately, their use. The following chart shows performance characteristics of different UTP cables: Performance Characteristics of Unshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP) Cable Cable Category* 1 or 2 3 4 5** Applications Voice and lowspeed data Voice and lowspeed data Data Data Frequency Limit Up to 4 MHz 16 MHz 20 MHz 100 MHz Construction 4-pair to 100-pair 4-pair 4-pair 4-pair Bend Radius 2" or less 2" or less 2" or less 2" or less Connector—Voice RJ11 RJ11 — — Connector—Data 8-position (RJ45) 8-position (RJ45) 8-position 8-position (RJ45) (RJ45) UNSHIELDED TWISTED-PAIR (UTP) CABLE *UTP cables in Categories 3, 4, and 5 provide enhanced performance in the ability to distribute more data at increased speeds. This is due to the use of performanceenhanced cabling and connectors. **Because Category 5 cables provide a much higher transmission speed, they’re being used more frequently—particularly by customers who have multiple computer networks or those who plan to change to higher-speed data communication equipment in the future. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 159 Walls Cable Management Shielded Twisted-Pair (STP) Cable Shielded twisted-pair cable is like the unshielded version in composition, except that the shielded twisted-pair cable has an additional light foil layer around the wire and below the outer protective vinyl coating. This foil acts as a shield to buffer the internal signal from interference. Performance Characteristics of Shielded Twisted-Pair (STP) Cable Applications Construction Bend Radius Connector Data, LAN 2-pair 3" IBM SHIELDED TWISTED-PAIR (STP) CABLE OUTER JACKET CENTER CONDUCTOR Coaxial Cable This type of cable consists of a metal core conductor covered by insulation and a metal sheath, which is covered by an insulated coating. The metal sheath serves as both a second conductor and a shield. Another variation, called twin axial, is similar to coaxial but has two insulated conductors inside a cable. This Herman Miller furniture system, with its wide corner connections, can handle most coaxial cables despite their limited ability to bend. COAXIAL CABLE BRAIDED SHIELD Fiber-Optic Cable The most advanced form of cable to date, fiber-optic cables use light rather than electrical impulses to transmit information; they have a core of glass or plastic, covered by an insulating coating. Because fiber-optic cables use light transmission, they are immune to electromagnetic interference or noise caused by power wires, making separation unnecessary. Fiber-optic cables also have the advantages of greater capacity and a smaller diameter compared to other cable types. Bend Radius by Cable Diameter Cable Diameter Bend Radius 1⁄ 8 " 1" to 2" 1" to 2" 1⁄ 4 " (single fiber) (duplex fiber) FIBER FIBER-OPTIC CABLE Action Office Series 2, because of its wide corner connections, can handle the bend radius requirements of a number of fiber-optic cables, especially those with one to four fiber strands. In addition, the cavity between the panel faces on the cable management panel and the channel at the panel base are large enough to accommodate bundling and to allow most in-line equipment and termination boxes to be placed inside the panel base or cable management panel rather than be exposed on the outside of the panel. This provides protection for these sensitive pieces of equipment, which are usually large and require space to accommodate spool/strain relief. (In-line equipment and termination boxes should be measured to assure their fit.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 160 Walls Cable Management Capacity Cable capacity in any furniture system depends on the amount of space available for cables, the type of cables used, and the number and degree of bends in the layout. For the Action Office Series 2 system, cable capacity is also dependent on whether the cabling is carried only at the baseline or whether cables are also carried vertically through the cable management panel. (Note the cable capacity charts that follow.) Horizontal Capacity While cable type is critical for determining actual capacity, corner connections frequently become the limiting factor, since some cables and wires bend more easily than others and since bundled cables have different bend radii. Likewise, frequent sharp bends can reduce the transmission quality of some cables. Since bundled cables have different bend radii, the largest radius in the range should be used. While the bends required by corner connections may ultimately determine capacity, corner connectors also offer a number of options that can affect capacity. • With a hard-surfaced or fabric-covered two-way 90° connector, cables can be routed along both the inside and the outside corners; the inside corner provides a 1" radius, while the outside corner offers a greater 4 1/2" to 6" radius, depending on the cable thickness. 4⁄«™" TO 6" BEND RADIUS 1" BEND RADIUS HARD-SURFACED OR FABRICCOVERED CONNECTOR— CABLES ALONG BOTH INSIDE AND OUTSIDE CORNERS 2-WAY CONNECTOR L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 161 Walls Cable Management • With the three-way 90° connector, cables and wires can be routed along both of the inside corners and across the back side of the connector. The 1" radius of this inside corner is identical to that of the two-way 90° connector. If a wider arc is needed, cables can be routed from the outside back to an inside corner of the connector. This provides a 4 1/2" radius for thick cables, a 6" radius for smaller cables like fiber optics. ACROSS BACK (NO BEND REQUIRED) INSIDE CORNER (1" BEND RADIUS) INSIDE CORNER TO OUTSIDE BACK (4⁄«™" TO 6" BEND RADIUS) 3-WAY CONNECTORS • With a four-way 90° connector, cables and wires can be routed along all inside corners or straight across the connector in either direction. The 1" radius of the inside corners is identical to that of the two-way and three-way connectors. If a wider arc is needed, cables can be routed between opposite corners of the connector. This provides a 4 1/2" radius for thick cables, a 6" radius for smaller cables like fiber optics. ACROSS CONNECTOR (NO BEND REQUIRED) INSIDE CORNER (1" BEND RADIUS) BETWEEN OPPOSITE CORNERS (4⁄«™" TO 6" BEND RADIUS) 4-WAY CONNECTORS L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 162 Walls Cable Management Vertical Capacity Because the cable management panel is available in two versions—powered and nonpowered—the vertical cable capacity is dependent on which is selected. The capacity from the panel top to the base is 59 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables when the panel is nonpowered, 50 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables when the panel is powered. Summary of Cable Capacities The “Cable Capacity” charts show the cable capacities of Action Office Series 2 panels for the most common types of cable found in the office. The figures reflect power in the panel base and the cable management panel frame. Note: These figures are planning guidelines only; actual cable capacity can vary due to cable insulation thickness, wire gauge, manufacturer, cable stiffness, and nesting characteristics. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 163 Walls Cable Management Horizontal Cable Capacity (4-Circuit) 1, 2, 3 Cable Type Spine Capacity 2-Way Capacity 3-Way Capacity 4-Way Capacity At Baseline (with Power Option) Unshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP)— 25-Pair Twisted-Pair 4-Pair Category 5 Shielded Twisted-Pair—IBM Type 1A Coaxial Fiber-Optic—Duplex 24 Cables 60 Cables 24 Cables 60 Cables 100 Cables 8 – 20 Cables 25 – 55 Cables 8 – 20 Cables 25 – 55 Cables 40 – 100 Cables 16 – 24 Cables 50 – 60 Cables 16 – 24 Cables 50 – 60 Cables 80 – 100 Cables 16 – 24 Cables 50 – 60 Cables 16 – 24 Cables 50 – 60 Cables 80 – 100 Cables At Optional Top Channel Unshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP)— 25-Pair Twisted-Pair 4-Pair Category 5 Shielded Twisted-Pair—IBM Type 1A Coaxial Fiber-Optic—Duplex 10 Cables 24 Cables 10 Cables 24 Cables 40 Cables 8 – 10 Cables 16 Cables 8 – 10 Cables 16 Cables 25 Cables 10 Cables 24 Cables 10 Cables 24 Cables 40 Cables 10 Cables 24 Cables 10 Cables 24 Cables 40 Cables Vertical Cable Capacity 2 Cable Type Unshielded Twisted-Pair (UTP)— 25-Pair Twisted-Pair 4-Pair Category 5 Shielded Twisted-Pair—IBM Type 1A Coaxial Fiber-Optic—Duplex Ceiling Power Entry Powered Nonpowered Cable Management Panel (Powered) Side 1 Side 2 36 Cables 90 Cables 36 Cables 90 Cables 120 Cables 10 Cables 30 Cables 10 Cables 30 Cables 50 Cables 48 Cables 120 Cables 48 Cables 120 Cables 160 Cables 7 Cables 20 Cables 7 Cables 20 Cables 35 Cables 1 When a range is given, the lower number indicates complete lay-in capacity, and the higher number requires installing cables between support posts. 2 Cable capacity can vary due to cable insulation thickness, wire gauge selected, manufacturer, cable stiffness, and nesting characteristics. 3 Top channel interior dimensions are 3/4 inches wide by 1 1/2 inches high, or 1 1/8 square inches. Fiber-Optic Cable Bend Radius Product Bend Radius 90° Corner (at Panel Base) Up to 6" 90° Corner (at Optional Panel Top Channel) 2" Vertical Bend from Panel Base to Cable Management Panel Up to 6" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 164 Walls Cable Management Effect of Bends on Cable Capacity The illustrations that follow show how capacity figures can be used to plan a cabling layout. The illustrations show the potential effect of bends on cable capacity; they also show how the sequence of those turns can affect cable capacity along the route. While the charts of cable capacity for Series 2 panels and connectors are useful for planning purposes, the systems furniture layout can have a dramatic impact on the portion of that capacity that can actually be utilized. For example, although a Series 2 panel can carry up to 60 Category 5 cables in its baseline raceway, once the cables go through a 2-way 90° connector (with a maximum capacity of 55 cables), the samedimension raceway beyond that 90° connector can be fed only the maximum of 55 cables. Just that one turn shows the effect of bends on cable capacity: Once a turn has decreased the cable capacity, the run that follows can carry only the reduced number of cables, even if it has a greater capacity to do so. The effect of decreased capacity is somewhat lessened by the fact that some cables will naturally be dropping off to supply power to equipment in the workstations. NO BENDS—NO LOSS OF CABLE CAPACITY 60 CABLES 60 CABLES 60 CABLES 4-WAY CONNECTOR (MAXIMUM OF 60 CABLES)—NO LOSS OF CABLE CAPACITY 60 CABLES 2-WAY CONNECTOR (MAXIMUM OF 55 CABLES) 55 CABLES CAPACITY REDUCED TO 55 CABLES DUE TO LOWER CAPACITY OF 2-WAY CONNECTOR NOTE: EXAMPLES REFLECT CATEGORY 5 CABLES L 55 CABLES 60 CABLES NO DECREASE IN CABLE CAPACITY WITH THIS BEND 60 CABLES 2-WAY CONNECTOR (MAXIMUM OF 55 CABLES)— DECREASE IN CAPACITY TO 55 CABLES 55 CABLES 4-WAY CONNECTOR (MAXIMUM OF 60 CABLES)— CAPACITY REDUCED DUE TO LOWER CAPACITY OF CORNER CONNECTOR PRECEDING IT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 165 Walls Cable Management Cable Distribution Voice and data communication cables can be distributed both horizontally and vertically in Action Office Series 2 panels. Cable Entry Regardless of the type of distribution system in the building (conventional, overhead, underfloor duct, relocatable, flat conductor, or raised floor), the conditions are the same for connecting the cabling source to the cable management system in Action Office Series 2 panels. In most cases, the terminus point of the building system will be either a junction box or a monument. Depending upon the dictates of local codes, owner’s preferences, and building conditions, one or more of the following methods of entry can be used: • Cables can enter the base of the panel from a floor monument through the flexible gaskets at the ends of each base cover. • Cables can enter the workstation through communication port outlets—usually in the panel base, but possibly in a cable management panel. THROUGH FLEXIBLE BASE COVER GASKETS FROM FLOOR MONUMENT OR JUNCTION BOX THROUGH COMMUNICATION PORT OUTLET FROM FLOOR MONUMENT OR JUNCTION BOX L THROUGH COMMUNICATION PORT LOCATION IN PANEL BASE FROM BUILDING WALL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 166 Walls Cable Management • Cables can enter the panel from the ceiling through a ceiling power entry to the base or the top of a panel. Entry can be directly into the end of the panel or into a spacer or a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector. • Cables can also enter the panel through a ceiling power entry for a cable management panel. Entry can be directed to the optional panel-top voice/data cable channel or to the panel base at any point within the panel run. FROM CEILING POWER ENTRY INTO PANEL BASE OR CONNECTOR (AT END OF PANEL RUN ONLY) FROM CEILING POWER ENTRY INTO CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL (WITHIN PANEL RUN ITSELF) Be sure to check local codes for any other specific requirements that may affect product selection. Overview of Distribution and Separation Cables can be carried in the panel base—in the entire cavity if the panel is nonpowered and beneath the power harness if powered. Because of the hinged cover, cables can be laid in—making the installation process faster and easier. In addition to the base, an optional voice/data cable channel at the top of the panel provides a horizontal channel for cable distribution and separation of cables from those in the panel base. Between the panel base and top, the cable management panel carries voice/data cables vertically. Two-piece segmented panel faces on the cable management panel allow easy initial lay-in installation and easy access to cables during reconfiguration without removing hanging components. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 167 Walls Cable Management Baseline Distribution The panel base cable management channel is 5" high by 3 1/4" wide and carries both electrical wiring and voice/data cables, concealed behind the base cover assembly. (Capacity varies with cable type.) This hinged assembly allows easy access to wiring and cabling areas. Where desired, an optional cable/energy barrier can be installed to separate sensitive voice/data lines from electrical interference. Besides electrical wires, this space accommodates certain Local Area Network (LAN) components and takes into account hard-to-bend and large-bend-radius cables. Corners provide up to a 6" bend radius with a two-way 90° connector. (Glide adjustment capability on the panels does not affect cable capacity.) Flexible edge trim at each end permits easy entry and exit of cables to work surfaces or equipment. ADJUSTABLE GLIDE— DOES NOT AFFECT CABLE CAPACITY UPPER CHANNEL FOR POWER LOWER CHANNEL FOR VOICE/DATA CABLING 6" BEND RADIUS HINGED BASE COVER ASSEMBLY (FLIPS UP FOR CONCEALMENT— DOWN FOR EASY ACCESS) PLAN VIEW: PANEL BASE RACEWAY AT 90Å CORNER CONNECTION MAXIMUM BEND RADIUS AT OUTSIDE OF CORNER—6" BEND RADIUS AT INNER CORNER AND CENTER OF CORNER—2" TO 4" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 168 Walls Cable Management Panel Top Channel Distribution An alternative raceway for data cables is available with the optional voice/data cable channel that can be installed at the top of all panels. This top channel provides an additional 40 4-pair UTP Category 5 cable capacity with a 1" to 2" bend radius. It also offers physical separation from energy carried in the panel base and provides convenient installation and access. (Horizontal cable distribution at the panel top is only possible, however, between adjacent panels of equal height.) Cables in the optional channel pass freely, horizontally, over all connectors; the panel top caps have cutouts that allow several cables to exit at a straight-line connection between two panels. (Vertical routing within the panel run is accomplished by using a cable management panel, ceiling power entry [or extender] for the cable management panel, or horizontal/vertical cable management trough. Vertical routing at the end of a panel run is accomplished by using a ceiling power entry.) OPTIONAL VOICE/ DATA CHANNEL VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL CONNECTOR CHANNEL (CAPACITY—MAXIMUM OF 40 4-PAIR CATEGORY 5 CABLES) WIRE ACCESS LOCATION VOICE/DATA CABLE PLAN VIEW: OPTIONAL PANEL-TOP VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL 1" TO 2" BEND RADIUS CAPACITY OF 40 4-PAIR CATEGORY 5 CABLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 169 Walls Cable Management Vertical Distribution Cable Management Panel The primary means of vertical wire and cable management for Series 2 panels is the 6"-wide cable management panel, made up of the cable management panel frame, cable management panel faces for each side, extenders, reducers, and related accessories. (The panel faces are in two segments—a top and a bottom portion—for powered versions of the cable management panel.) By locating the panel where needed on the panel run, the cable management panel provides convenient access to power at standard work surface height, and to voice/data cables above and below the work surface. It is important to plan placement of the cable management panel so that hanging components do not interfere with access to power or data. Each panel face offers three standard options: no access to power or voice/data cables, electrical access only, or access to both power and voice/data cables. The panel is two-sided, allowing the face for each side to be specified separately. In addition, panel faces that provide access to voice/data cables come in segmented, two-piece covers that allow separate access to cabling above and below the work surface. Cable distribution can also be extended to the ceiling with the cable management panel extender; or it can be carried on the cable management side of the cable management panel ceiling power entry, or within the entire interior cavity if the ceiling power entry is without the electrical assembly. CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FACE (SIDE 2) CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FACE (SIDE 1) PANEL FACES FOR POWERED CABLE MANAGEMENT PANELS SEGMENTED INTO TOP AND BOTTOM PIECES FOR EASY ACCESS TO CABLES WITHOUT REMOVING WORK SURFACE POTENTIAL INTERFERENCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE AND ACCESS TO POWER AND ENERGY KEEP IN MIND HEIGHT OF WORK SURFACE AND LOCATION OF SUPPORT ARMS WHEN PLANNING FOR PORT ACCESS HOLES OR FOR POWER AT WORK SURFACE HEIGHT POWER ACCESS ON THIS HALF ACCESS TO VOICE/DATA CABLES ON THIS HALF L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 170 Walls Cable Management The cable management panel frame has an aluminum septum dividing the chase vertically down the center, physically separating electrical wiring from the voice/data cables. Like the horizontal barrier in the cable management chase in the panel base, this vertical septum serves to separate data lines from power lines and provide access to both power and voice/data cables at convenient points along the height of the panel. Because the frame is shipped without its removable covers in place, installation is fast and easy. When the panel face is installed on each side, the panel provides access holes for duplex receptacles on the right-hand portion (side 1) and preconfigured cable interface connectors (communication ports) on the left half (side 1); the opposite side (side 2) reverses the order—access holes for electrical receptacles on the left, communication ports on the right. A planning worksheet for electrical receptacles and communication ports is available in the Action Office Series 2 Panels Documentation Tools. PANEL FACE FRAME PANEL FACE SIDE 2 ALUMINUM SEPTUM (FOR PHYSICAL SEPARATION OF POWER AND VOICE/DATA CABLES) SIDE 1 FOR POWER DISTRIBUTION FOR VOICE/DATA CABLE DISTRIBUTION L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 171 Walls Cable Management While the receptacles are standard and are available from Herman Miller, the communication ports are purchased from the particular manufacturer. Special reducers and extenders allow the most commonly used manufacturers’ equipment to be accommodated; the most critical limiting factor is generally the inside clearance (front to back) required to house the module once it is snapped into place. (See the cable management panel frame for dimensions of the actual housing and the clearances to see whether the communications port under consideration fits.) When attaching a cable management panel frame to another panel or to a connector or spacer, it is critical to position the cable management panel to allow for energy distribution pass-through in the base: • When connecting the cable management panel to another panel, position the energy side of the cable management panel on the right (when facing side 1). • When connecting the cable management panel to a spacer, position the energy side of the panel next to the connector (when facing side 1). • When connecting the cable management panel to a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector, position the energy side of the panel away from the connector (when facing side 1). CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME 2-WAY 90Å CONNECTOR ENERGY DISTRIBUTION SIDE AWAY FROM CONNECTOR VOICE/DATA DISTRIBUTION SIDE NEXT TO CONNECTOR Ceiling Power Entries If vertical cable distribution is desired at the end of a panel run or at a three- or fourway panel connection, a ceiling power entry can be used (four circuit or four circuit top mounted). In each one, the ceiling power entry can carry cabling vertically within its entire interior, or it can carry cabling in the side opposite the internal electrical harness; the electrical wires are enclosed by rigid conduit to provide metal separation between the electrical harness and the voice/data cables. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 172 Walls Cable Management Separation Many cables used in the workplace have a sheath to protect them from outside interference and require no additional buffering when placed near electrical wiring. Where it is important to separate electrical wiring and sensitive communications cables in the base of the panel, however, an optional metal barrier can be added to powered panels and to corner connectors. The barrier consists of a plate that divides the raceway into two separate channels, separating data lines from power lines. Note: Actual separation may not be necessary when shielded cables are used. Separation can also be achieved by using an optional horizontal channel in the top of the panels, which provides a completely separate location for cables. (The limiting factor, however, is the need for the panels to be of equal height.) PHYSICAL SEPARATION FOR CABLES USING OPTIONAL PANEL-TOP VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL VERTICAL SEPARATION OF POWER AND VOICE/DATA CABLES WITHIN CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL SEPARATION OF POWER AND VOICE/DATA CABLES WITHIN BASE WITH OPTIONAL CABLE/ENERGY BARRIER L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 173 Walls Cable Management Cable Access The Action Office Series 2 system provides a number of options for access to voice and data networks. Flexible interconnect modules (communication ports)—made by a number of different manufacturers—can be installed in the base cover option that includes a pre-punched communication port location at the lower left on each side. They can also be installed in a communication port location in the cable management panel. The Series 2 system provides the capability of moving the cable management panel or relocating the flexible module within the cable management panel to provide a different access point for electronic equipment. The cavity of the cable management panel was designed to accommodate most interconnect devices; however, since manufacturers’ specifications are subject to change, exact dimensions of the communication port being considered should be checked. Reducers and extenders are available with the Series 2 system to accommodate interconnect devices whose dimensions or clearances are somewhat smaller or deeper than the port locations in the panel or panel base. Where equipment is less likely to be moved or changed, the cables from the equipment can be routed directly; they can go from the equipment through the gap at the rear of the work surface into the base of the panel (through the flexible end of the panel base cover). The ability to provide access at a number of heights on the cable management panel is an important consideration in meeting safety requirements and the access needs of workers with disabilities. INSTALLATION LOCATIONS FOR COMMUNICATION PORTS ANY COMMUNICATION PORT LOCATION IN CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL ANY UNUSED RECEPTACLE LOCATION BASE OPTION WITH PRE-PUNCHED COMMUNICATION PORT LOCATION NOTE: NOMINAL 3" X 1 ‡«•" SIZE OF COMMUNICATION PORT LOCATION AND RECEPTACLE LOCATION HOLDS ANY STANDARD COMMUNICATION FACEPLATE USING 3.281" O.C. MOUNTING HOLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 174 Walls Cable Management Reconfiguration The Action Office Series 2 system provides easy access to voice/data cables with the two-part removable faceplates on the cable management panel and the hinged covers on the panel base. This easy access makes repairs and changes to communication networks quicker and less disruptive to workstation occupants. In addition, the capacity of these distribution components provides greater freedom for routing and storing cables, since cables do not have to be threaded through small openings. The removable faceplates and the capability for custom-cutting openings in them also offer greater flexibility for using communication connectors or jacks. These connectors can be located virtually anywhere on a cable management panel, as long as the openings are at least 1 1/2" apart; likewise, the panel frame itself can be moved to a different location if needs should change, since it is as independent and modular as any other panel. The openings can also be adapted to accommodate connectors from practically any supplier. Thus, changes in suppliers cause few problems. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 175 Walls Cable Management Cable Management Trough, Panel Suspended AO381. Description This trough attaches to a panel to hold a 3-outlet or multi-outlet electrical distributor and to manage cables. It can be field modified for use with any size panel. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 48", and 60" widths. Height is 6". Planning Considerations Select the trough width to be equal to or greater than the panel width. The trough can be field cut for use with any panel size. The cable management trough can be placed anywhere on the panel for easier access by people with reach limitations. L HOLDS CABLES/WIRES BENEATH WORK SURFACE FOR A NEAT, ORGANIZED APPEARANCE WIRE TUCKS INTO PANEL-TO-PANEL CONNECTION Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 176 Walls Cable Management Cable Management Trough, Work Surface Suspended AO382. Description This trough attaches under an Action Office suspended work surface or Arrio two-legged corner table desk to manage cables. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in 30" and 40" widths. Height is 4". Planning Considerations The trough can be field cut for use with any size work surface. On Arrio work surfaces with the smaller stretcher for local cables, the trough can be attached toward the rear of the work surface, parallel to its back edge; on a two-legged corner work surface, it can be attached diagonally. CORDS/CABLES STORE HERE Limitations The trough provides distribution of power, but no access to it. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 177 Walls Cable Management Cable Management Trough, Horizontal/Vertical AO383. Description This trough is backed with pressuresensitive tape and attaches horizontally or vertically to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel or wall to manage cables. Package contains two 10"-, three 22"-, and eight 46"-long troughs. Dimensions Available in 10", 22", and 46" lengths. Width is 1 7/8". Planning Considerations This cable management trough can be placed at any point on a panel or wall to manage cables; while positioning the trough to follow a hanger rail or component edge makes cables less visible, the trough is not dependent on mechanical attachment for placement. L PLACING TROUGH IN HANGER RAIL MAKES CABLES LESS VISIBLE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 178 Walls Cable Management Voice/Data Cable Channel NP227., NP228., NP229., NP230., NP231., NP232., NP233., NP271. Description This non-ferrous, top-mounted channel provides shielding of voice/data cables from electrical cables on an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel. It holds up to 40 4-pair Category 5 cables. The channel cannot be used for energy distribution. Dimensions Widths are 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60". TOP PART OF CABLE CHANNEL 2-WAY CHANNEL CONNECTOR Height is 2 3/4". Depth is 2 1/8". Planning Considerations Specify the cable channel width to match that of the panel to which it will be attached. Since there is no 6"-wide cable channel, when cable management panels are used, the voice/data cable channel must be specified in a width that spans the tops of both the cable management panel and an adjacent panel. VOICE/DATA CABLE CHANNEL CABLE ACCESS LOCATION VOICE/DATA CABLE Cable distribution within the cable channel is horizontal only and does not allow for vertical distribution to or from the cable management panel. Panel-top cable distribution requires all panels, panel frames, and connectors to be of equal height. The portion of the cable channel that extends above the panel is a nominal 1 7/8". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 179 Walls Cable Management Voice/Data Cable Channel Connector NP234., NP235., NP236., NP237., NP251. Description This connector joins two voice/data cable channels and provides a continuous cableway between equalheight Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels. Package contains four. Dimensions For use with 2-way 90° connector: Width is nominal 3 1/2". 3-WAY CHANNEL CONNECTOR Depth is nominal 3 1/2". For use with spacer: Width is nominal 5". Depth is nominal 2". CABLE ACCESS LOCATION For use with 3-way 90° connector: Width is nominal 5". Depth is nominal 3 1/2". For use with 4-way 90° connector: Width is nominal 5". VOICE/DATA CABLE Depth is nominal 5". For use with draw rod: Width is nominal 1 1/2". Depth is nominal 2". Planning Considerations Specify the voice/data cable connector to match the type of connector (two-way, three-way, or four-way) with which it will be used. The portion of the cable channel connector that extends above the panel is a nominal 1 7/8". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 180 Walls Cable Management Voice/Data Cable Channel End Cap NP238. Description This end cap finishes the exposed end of a voice/data cable channel. Package contains four. Dimensions Width is 2 1/8". Height is 1 7/8". Depth is 1 1/4", including insert clip. Planning Considerations This cable channel end cap is to be used at the end of a panel run. The end cap has a very thin profile that aligns with the edge of the panel rather than with the panel finished end. L CHANNEL END CAP Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 181 Walls Cable Management Cable Port NP360. Description This cable port is for field-modified Action Office work surfaces. It provides a hinged access cover for cable passthrough. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Available in 12" and 18" nominal widths. Actual widths are 13 1/2" and 19 1/2", respectively. Depth is 4 1/2". Height is 1 1/8". Planning Considerations In addition to providing an opening for cable pass-through, the cable port can also, with the installation of a cable port outlet strip, provide receptacle access. For the 13 1/2"-wide cable port, order the four-outlet cable port outlet strip; for the 19 1/2"-wide cable port, order either a four- or a six-outlet cable port outlet strip. The hole for the cable port must be fieldcut. Options Order the Cable Port Outlet Strip (NP358.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 182 Walls Cable Management Cable/Energy Barrier, Panel A1380. Description This cable/energy barrier provides a continuous, grounded metal barrier within a powered panel to separate voice/data cables from the baseline electrical harness. Package contains six. Dimensions Available in 12", 18", 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Height is 2 1/2". Planning Considerations Select the barrier to match the width of the panel to which it will be fitted. The barrier must be field installed. The field-installed barrier is not required if the powered panel is specified with the cable/energy barrier option or if the cables are already shielded. UPPER CHANNEL FOR POWER CABLE/ENERGY BARRIER OPTION LOWER CHANNEL FOR VOICE/DATA CABLING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 183 Walls Cable Management Cable/Energy Barrier, Connector A1381. Description This cable/energy barrier provides a continuous, grounded metal barrier at the base of a connector to separate voice/data cables from the baseline electrical harness. Package contains six. Dimensions Available to fit the spacer and the two-, three-, and four-way 90° connectors. Planning Considerations Select the barrier to match the type of connector to which it will be fitted. Adjacent panels with cable/energy barriers require a cable/energy barrier for the connector as well. The cable/energy barrier is not required if cables are already shielded. The barrier must be field installed. UPPER CHANNEL FOR POWER CABLE/ENERGY BARRIER OPTION LOWER CHANNEL FOR VOICE/DATA CABLING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 184 Walls Cable Management Cable Management Panel Extender A1333. Description This 6"-wide panel extender attaches to a cable management panel frame to carry voice/data cables from a building’s ceiling to the panel frame. It has ceiling trim and connecting hardware. Dimensions Available in heights to fit 39", 47", 53", 62", 67", and 85" cable management panel frames. CEILING BEZEL Width is 6". Interior cavity width is approximately 5 3/8"; depth is 1 5/8". Planning Considerations The extender attaches to an existing cable management panel frame. SUPPORT BRACKET FOR ATTACHMENT TO CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME CEILING EXTENSION INTERIOR DIMENSIONS 5 ‹/•" x 1 fi/•" To order the correct size, select the height of the cable management panel to which it is to be attached. The extender specified for that panel height will reach a 10'-6" ceiling. (For lower ceilings, the extender can be cut to size on site.) While the extender serves as a cable distribution component only, it does not interfere with the normal access to power and voice/data cables in the cable management panel frame to which it is attached. The cable capacity of the extender is 50 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (powered) and 59 4-pair UTP Category 5 cables (nonpowered). ATTACHES TO TOP OF EXISTING CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME, EXTENDS TO 10'-6" CEILING Limitations This extender can be used to distribute voice/data cables only; it cannot be used to distribute electrical power through the cable management panel below it. MAXIMUM CAPACITY OF CABLE MANAGEMENT PANEL FRAME AND EXTENDER— POWERED: 50 4-PAIR CATEGORY 5 CABLES NONPOWERED: 59 4-PAIR CATEGORY 5 CABLES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 185 Walls Cable Management Communication Port Faceplate G1189. Description This faceplate fits into the communication port cutout of an Action Office Series 2 or 3 or Ethospace cable management side cover, Action Office Series 2 or 3 cable management panel face, Liaison communications port trim, or Arrio voice/data port housing. Package contains six. The reducer faceplate reduces the size of the cutout to fit specific cable communication modules; finish is black. The extender faceplate allows installation of specific cable communication modules without interfering with cable distribution capacity; attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Extender: • Height is 4 1/2". • Width is 2 3/4". • Opening is 2.920" high and 1.770" wide, with 3.281" between screw holes. REDUCER: EXTENDS ⁄/•" (.125") FROM PANEL FACE EXTENDER: EXTENDS ‡/•" (.875") BEYOND PANEL FACE NO EXTENDER REQUIRED— MODULE EXTENDS THROUGH ALUMINUM SEPTUM INTO OPPOSITE CAVITY Reducer: • Height is 3 5/8". • Width is 2 1/4". • Opening is 2.700" high and 1.370" wide. Planning Considerations The faceplate extender provides up to 7/8" (.875") of additional depth for a cable communication module. PANEL FACE NO EXTENDER REQUIRED— EACH MODULE FITS WITHIN CAVITY TIMMERMAN CLIP (ATTACHED TO BACK OF PANEL FACE) The faceplate reducer extends a nominal 1/8" from the panel face, allowing smaller cable communication modules to fit within a larger opening. SCREW (SUPPLIED WITH EXTENDER) Preconfigured cable communication modules are purchased directly from the manufacturer. The faceplate is shipped separately and field installed. L EXTENDER REQUIRED— NEITHER MODULE FITS COMPLETELY WITHIN CAVITY PANEL FACE ALLOWS UP TO ‡/•" ADDITIONAL ROOM FOR MODULE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 186 Walls Cable Management Faceplates can be used on an Action Office Series 2 or 3 panel or an Ethospace frame with the “J” or “G” option (for communication port locations). Using a faceplate on a Liaison cabinet requires a communications port trim. Using a faceplate on an Arrio work surface requires a voice/data port housing. Options Order the following components separately: • For use with Liaison cabinets: Communications Port Trim (B1390.) • For use with Arrio work surfaces: Voice/Data Port Housing (XR410.) Limitations The faceplate cannot be used with the Ethospace Cable Access Tile (E1432.08) or the Cable Access Tile Package (E1432.16). L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 187 Work Surfaces Introduction Work Surfaces Introduction A variety of work surfaces to support paperwork, computer equipment, display, and conferences includes wall-attached work surfaces and peninsulas, transaction surfaces, and freestanding tables. Arrio freestanding work surfaces also blend with Action Office Series 2 work surfaces, providing freestanding work surfaces used independently or table desks used parallel or perpendicular to wall-attached work surfaces. Action Office Series 2 panels accept three styles of wall-attached work surfaces: squared-edge, radiused-edge, and Flex-Edge™ work surfaces. All Series 2 rectangular and corner work surfaces are available with manual adjustability in 1" increments. The squared-edge work surfaces have the widest range of types and sizes to accommodate the widest range of user needs. These work surfaces have a 1 1/4"thick squared edge and a 7/8" gap at the rear of the work surface that allows plugs and cables to drop behind the work surface. The radiused-edge work surfaces (available in fewer shapes and sizes) include general-purpose rectangular and corner work surfaces. Radiused-edge work surfaces are 1" thick and have a rounded vinyl edging on the front and sides and a 3/8" gap at the back of the work surfaces. Two Flex-Edge corner work surfaces accommodate computer use by providing a resilient front edge and cutouts for monitor lifts and input platforms. Both squared-edge and radiused-edge work surfaces can be attached to Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panels. Also, the squared-edge work surfaces with grommets (designed originally for Series 3 panels) can be attached to Series 2 panels if their undersides are field-modified to reposition the attachment hardware. Likewise, the squared-edge work surfaces without grommets, designed for Series 2 panels, can be attached to Action Office Series 3 panels. (They also require some field installation modification to reposition the attachment hardware on the underside of the work surfaces.) Transaction surfaces provide a counter or display surface. Action Office freestanding tables include a squared-edge and a radiused-edge freestanding table, a radiused-edge printer support table, and a mobile table with a radiused edge. The Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide covers the planning considerations for using Arrio work surfaces with Series 2 work surfaces. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 189 Work Surfaces Introduction Ergonomic Considerations for Work Surfaces The variety of sizes, styles, and accessories makes Herman Miller systems work surfaces very responsive to workers’ ergonomic needs. This system has rectangular, corner, and peninsula work surfaces, so the user can form a work arena with a wide expanse that supports concentration as well as interaction with others. The various lengths and depths allow the work area to be tailored to the work process and to the worker. The 24"-deep work surface, in particular, allows companies to meet ADA guidelines for maximum forward reach for workers in wheelchairs. For workers with reach impairments, the 24"-deep work surface is more accommodating than the 30"-deep one. In addition, wider work surfaces provide greater expanses of work area without obstruction. All Herman Miller hanging work surfaces are vertically adjustable, making it easier for workers to change work positions easily and frequently during the day or to accommodate multi-shift operations or shared workstations. This vertical adjustability creates work environments that accommodate the preferences of workers of all heights as well as the needs of workers with disabilities. Specialized work surfaces that handle monitors and keyboards can be integrated right into the work area, with an expanse of work surface to each side for reference documentation. The flexible front edge option allows a choice of comfortable work surface edges, especially where workers rest their hands or arms on the work surface edge for long periods of time. In addition, the choice of hanging work surfaces instead of freestanding work surfaces allows unobstructed leg movement from one end of the work area to another. This is not only a convenience for all workers, but also an important accommodation for workers with limited mobility. Note: This planning guide includes comments and suggestions about how certain products may enable customers to comply with the letter and spirit of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) of 1990. While these are generally useful as guidelines, they are not all-inclusive of ADA solutions. Accommodating a worker with disabilities may require additional adaptations and applications based on the individual’s particular needs. It is recommended that, in each case, the designer work with the individual to ensure complete accommodation of those needs within the specific work process. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 190 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACE CORNER WORK SURFACE PENINSULA WORK SURFACE (SQUARED-EDGE STYLE ONLY) WORK SURFACE WITH CUTOUT Work Surface Types Hanging work surfaces provide general-purpose surfaces for a variety of tasks. The panels or walls on which they hang provide the load-bearing capability. Rectangular and corner work surfaces are the most commonly used work surfaces for general-purpose office work. They are often used adjacent to one another in an expansive, effective work arena. They are available in squared-edge and radiusededge styles. Peninsula work surfaces, which can be placed perpendicular to panels, walls, or other work surfaces, form work surface extensions that can be used from both sides. They provide primary work space as well as a conference area. They are available only in the squared-edge style. The work surface with cutout has a cutout at either the left or the right to give users easier access to the work surface corner or to an adjacent Liaison work cabinet. Several other Herman Miller systems work surfaces have specialized cutouts to hold input platforms or monitor lifts. Note: Even though squared-edge and radiused-edge work surfaces serve the same functions and can fit on the same panels, using both types of work surfaces in the same office is not recommended. Their appearance differs significantly. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 191 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Means of Adjustment Hanging work surfaces eliminate the need for furniture legs (allowing uninhibited leg movement) and can be adjusted vertically at 1" increments on the panel to allow work to be done while seated or standing. They accept a full complement of storage components—from pencil drawers to file drawers—hung from their underside. (Actual clearances between supports should always be checked for each product before planning for hanging or freestanding storage beneath the work surface.) HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT IN 1" INCREMENTS HANGING WORK SURFACE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 192 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Retrofitting It is possible to retrofit existing squared-edge work surfaces with grommets, designed for Action Office Series 3 panels, to hang on Series 2 panels. This retrofitting is done by repositioning the holes and moving the mounting brackets back on the underside of the work surfaces. Redrilling will position the work surface at the same distance from the panel as the work surfaces without grommets. Redrilling is not required, however: • if there are no corner work surfaces involved • if there are no L-shaped configurations of rectangular work surfaces (a 90-degree turn) • if there is no concern about the distance between the work surface and the panel in a straight panel/work surface run This illustration shows the current and redrilled hole locations for a squared-edge work surface with grommets (designed for use with Series 3 panels) to be hung in position on an Action Office Series 2 panel. New holes must be drilled on the underside of the work surface, positioned closer to the rear of the work surface. All holes must be redrilled to be a nominal 7/16" behind the existing holes. On the corner work surface, all holes must move back 7/16", but the hole at the back corner must also drop back toward the corner of the work surface by the appropriate distance. Refer to the Action Office Series 3 Planning Guide for information about the squarededge work surfaces with grommets. ‡«•" ‡«•" ‡«¡§" ‡«¡§" FOR CORNER WORK SURFACES, REDRILL HOLES FOR CORNER BRACKET AS SHOWN FOR RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES, REDRILL ALL HOLES FOR SUPPORT ‡«¡§" CLOSER TO REAR EDGE OF WORK SURFACE Legend: = Existing holes ‡«¡§" L = New location, 7/16" from existing hole location Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 193 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Work Surfaces OPTIONAL PENCIL DRAWER L-SHAPED SUPPORT ‡«•" GAP FOR CORDS AND PLUGS 8 ‡«•"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 11 ‹«¢"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 16 ‹«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 22 fi«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE All squared-edge work surfaces for Action Office Series 2 panels hang from L-shaped supports on compatibly sized panels, combinations of panels, or wall strips. Overall height of the work surfaces (with supports) is 8 7/8" on 24"-deep hanging work surfaces, 11 3/4" on 30"-deep work surfaces. Squared-edge work surfaces are available as rectangular or corner work surfaces or as peninsulas. Peninsulas are available with a round end or a rectangular end. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 194 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Features • Squared-edge hanging work surfaces are 1 1/4" thick. • Squared-edge work surfaces have straight edges, finished either in the same wood as the top or in a vinyl that is the same color as the laminate top. (A frostedlaminate top has a solid-color edge.) • Squared-edge hanging work surfaces are available in 18", 21 1/2", 24", 27 1/2", 30", 33 1/2", 36", 39 1/2", 42", 45 1/2", 48", 51 1/2", 54", 57 1/2", 60", 63 1/2", 66", 69 1/2", 72", 75 1/2", 78", 81 1/2", 84", 87 1/2", 90", 93 1/2", and 96" widths. • Squared-edge hanging work surfaces designed for Series 2 panels have a 7/8" gap at the rear of the work surface that allows larger cables and plugs to drop behind the work surface. Because of their straight edge, squared-edge work surfaces are very versatile. For example, squared-edge work surfaces fit tightly when used next to one another and can be used at right angles to one another in a corner. A peninsula work surface can hang off the front edge of a squared-edge rectangular work surface running perpendicular to the peninsula. Squared-edge work surfaces can also accept a full complement of hanging storage components beneath the surface. Actual clearances between supports should always be checked for each product in planning for hanging or freestanding storage beneath the work surface. CABLE FITS IN ‡«•" GAP BETWEEN WORK SURFACE AND PANEL NO GAP BETWEEN ADJACENT WORK SURFACES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 195 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Rectangular Work Surface A2310. Description This work surface hangs from a panel or wall strips and has predrilled holes for drawers and suspended pedestals. It is available in two depths and 27 widths. The work surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Attachment hardware is included. The 27 1/2"-, 33 1/2"-, 39 1/2"-, 45 1/2"-, 51 1/2"-, 57 1/2"-, 63 1/2"-, 69 1/2"-, and 75 1/2"-wide work surfaces hang from panels connected by a spacer or the flat side of a three-way 90° connector; the extended length fills the space made by the connector and provides a continuous work surface. The 66"-, 69 1/2"-, 72"-, and 75 1/2"-wide surfaces include one additional center bracket; 78"-, 84"-, 90", and 96"-wide surfaces include two additional center brackets. ‡«•" GAP FOR CORDS 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«¢" ‡«•" GAP FOR CORDS 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«¢" 8 ‡«•" 4 ‹«¢" 11 fi«•" 11 ‹«¢" 5 ‹«•" 17 ⁄«¢" Dimensions Available in 24" and 30" depths and18", 21 1/2", 24", 27 1/2", 30", 33 1/2", 36", 39 1/2", 42", 45 1/2", 48", 51 1/2", 54", 57 1/2", 60", 63 1/2", 66", 69 1/2", 72", 75 1/2", 78", 81 1/2", 84", 87 1/2", 90", 93 1/2", and 96" widths. Overall height, with supports, is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations Rectangular work surfaces can be used alone, at right angles to one another to form a corner, or as extensions to corner surfaces. STRAIGHT FRONT EDGE ALLOWS 2 SURFACES AT RIGHT ANGLES TO ABUT ONE ANOTHER The work surface has a 7/8" gap at the back of the surface to feed plugs, cables, and wires between the work surface and an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel. If the work surface attachment hardware is repositioned, the work surface can also hang on a Series 3 panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 196 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces All rectangular work surfaces include standard support arms; larger sizes have additional supports, which should be located at the panel connection closest to the center or equidistant from one another. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept support arms. Each work surface includes a ganging plate to properly align adjacent surfaces. To provide additional support at the front corner for particularly heavy equipment, order a work surface bracket (usable only if the width of the perpendicular panel matches the work surface depth). GANGING PLATE TO ALIGN ADJACENT SURFACES (INCLUDED) 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 24 " REQUIRES PANEL TO MATCH WORK SURFACE DEPTH L OPTIONAL WORK SURFACE BRACKET FOR ADDITIONAL SUPPORT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 197 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Using freestanding files or pedestals under a squared-edge rectangular work surface requires attention to the following clearance dimensions between support arms. (The clearance is generally 3" less than the work surface width.) For work surfaces 66" to 96" wide, the clearance is the distance between any additional support arms or from the center support arm to each end support arm. (That clearance varies, depending on the widths of the panels supporting the work surface, but the clearance is approximately 3" less per span.) Surface Width Clearance (Width Between Support Arms) 18" 21 1/2" 24" 27 1/2" 30" 33 1/2" 36" 39 1/2" 42" 45 1/2" 48" 51 1/2" 54" 57 1/2" 60" 63 1/2" 66" 69 1/2" 72" 75 1/2" 78" 81 1/2" 84" 87 1/2" 90" 93 1/2" 96" 15" 15" 21" 21" 27" 27" 33" 33" 39" 39" 45" 48 1/2" 51" 51" 57" 60 1/2" 27"* 27"* 34 1/4"* 34 1/4"* 34 1/4"* 34 1/4"* 39 1/4"* 39 1/4"* 42"* 42"* 45"* ADDITIONAL CENTER SUPPORT ARM FOR WORK SURFACES 66", 69 ⁄«™", 72", AND 75 ⁄«™" WIDE (2 ADDITIONAL SUPPORTS FOR WORK SURFACES 78" AND WIDER) OPTIONAL WORK SURFACE BRACKETS RECOMMENDED FOR FRONT-EDGE SUPPORT OF WORK SURFACES 72" AND WIDER OR FOR SUPPORT OF HEAVY EQUIPMENT CLEARANCE—DISTANCE BETWEEN SUPPORT ARMS (3" LESS THAN WORK SURFACE WIDTH) CLEARANCE CLEARANCE DISTANCE BETWEEN CENTER SUPPORT ARM AND EACH OUTER BRACKET (APPROXIMATELY 3" LESS PER SPAN) SUPPORT(S) CAN BE LOCATED AT INTERMEDIATE PANEL CONNECTION(S) CLOSEST TO CENTER OR EQUIDISTANT FROM ONE ANOTHER *Clearance varies due to the combination of panels used. To determine clearances, use the distance from the inner edge of each outer support arm to the inside of the mid-run work surface support, which should be positioned at the panel connection closest to the center of the work surface. For work surfaces with more than one mid-run support, the additional clearance in the center is the inside distance between the two mid-run work surface supports. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 198 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Holes are predrilled on the left and right sides for attaching suspended storage; holes can also be field drilled to hang drawers in any position. Optional keyboard support products can be mounted under most squared-edge rectangular work surfaces. • All adjustable keyboard trays and keyboard holders will fit under all work surface widths except 24". • Extended-length-arm keyboard support products specified with the shorter 17 3/4" track can fit under 24"and 30"-deep work surfaces (although the keyboard support product will not be completely hidden under the 24"deep work surface when stored). ADDITIONAL SUPPORT ARM(S) ON WORK SURFACES 66" AND WIDER FILING WIDTH CLEARANCE LIMITED TO WIDTH OF CLEARANCE ON EACH SIDE OF ADDITIONAL SUPPORT ARM(S) The holes to mount keyboard support products must be drilled on site. Options Order the optional Work Surface Bracket (A2390.) separately. Order optional storage products separately: • F-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAF12.) • F-Front Pedestal, Support (FAF13.) • H-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAH12.) • H-Front Pedestal, Support (FAH13.) • J-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAJ12.) • J-Front Pedestal, Support (FAJ13.) • B-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.B.) • B-Front Pedestal, Support (NP361.) • C-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.C) • E-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.E) • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock (AO481.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 199 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Work surfaces 24" wide cannot accept adjustable and fully adjustable keyboard support products. While extended-length-arm keyboard support products specified with the shorter 17 3/4"-long track can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, they are not hidden completely when stored. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 200 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Rectangular Work Surface with Cutout A2311. Left Cutout A2312. Right Cutout Description This 36"-deep work surface hangs from an Action Office Series 2 panel or wall strips. It is supported by a return panel or work surface end support panel. The work surface has a cutout for easier access to the work surface corner. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate top and edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in 60" and 72" widths. Depth is 36" at one end and 29 1/2" at the other end. Planning Considerations The sculpted cutout allows the user to take advantage of the 36" work surface depth for computer or other uses while allowing access to all areas of the work surface or to the interior of an adjacent perpendicular Liaison cabinet. Choose the left- or right-handed cutout to fit the preferences of the user or the position of the work cabinet. The left cutout places a work cabinet or another work surface to the user’s left; the right cutout places a cabinet or another work surface to the user’s right. (With either cutout position, the user can pull up to the cutout area and work to the left or right, or both.) When the work surface hangs perpendicular to a work cabinet, extending the expanse of work surface into the cabinet requires an adjoining work surface shelf at the same height. A 30"-wide cabinet with work surface shelf will allow the work surface to be extended for its full depth; any other width cabinet will produce a work surface extension wider than the work surface with cutout, forming an L shape where the surfaces meet. L CUTOUT ALLOWS GREATER ACCESS ACROSS DEEP WORK SURFACE AND TO ADJACENT WORK CABINET CORNER 36" 36" 29 1/2" DEEP AT END ADJACENT TO CABINET EXTENDS FULL WIDTH OF CABINET WHEN USED WITH 30"-WIDE CABINET FORMS “L”-SHAPED EXTENSION WHEN WIDTH OF WORK SURFACE SHELF AND DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE WITH CUTOUT DON'T MATCH Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 201 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces The 36"-deep end of the work surface is always opposite a work cabinet and must be supported by a return panel or work surface support panel, ordered separately. The narrower end is supported by a work surface support, which comes with the work surface. Additional support for the front corner of the 36"-deep end can be provided with an optional work surface bracket, ordered separately. Because this work surface is normally used with Liaison cabinets, which provide workstation storage, this work surface does not accept work surfaceattached storage. Options For support, order the Work Surface Support Panel, End (A2380.), in the 30" width, or the Work Surface Bracket (A2390.) separately. Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) To extend the work surface into a cabinet, order the Liaison Cabinet Work Surface Shelf (B4920.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 202 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Limitations This work surface cannot be used perpendicular to work cabinets equipped with two lateral file drawers or to 30"wide work surfaces with attaching drawer or pedestal storage. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 203 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Rectangular Work Surface with Cable Port NP356. Description This work surface hangs from an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel or wall strips. It has a black, 18" hinged cable port centered at the rear of the work surface for cable pass-through. The surface has predrilled holes for a power center. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. The 72"-wide surface includes one additional center bracket. Dimensions Widths are 30", 48", 60", and 72". Depths are 24" and 30". Overall height, with supports, is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations Rectangular work surfaces can be used alone, at right angles to one another to form a corner, or as extensions to corner surfaces. In addition to the cable port that is centered toward the rear of the work surface, the work surface also has a 7/8" gap along the back of the surface to feed plugs, cables, and wires between the work surface and an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel. If the predrilled holes for the work surface attachment hardware is repositioned, the work surface can also hang on a Series 3 panel. All rectangular work surfaces include standard support arms; the additional support on the 72"-wide work surface is to be located at the panel connection closest to the center. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept support arms. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 204 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Each work surface includes a ganging plate to properly align adjacent surfaces. To provide additional support at the front corner for particularly heavy equipment, order a work surface bracket (usable only if the width of the perpendicular panel matches the work surface depth). Using freestanding files or pedestals under a squared-edge rectangular work surface requires attention to the following clearance dimensions between support arms. (The clearance is generally 3" less than the work surface width.) For the 72"-wide work surface, the clearance is the distance between any additional support arms or from the center support arm to each end support arm. (That clearance varies, depending on the widths of the panels supporting the work surface, but the clearance is approximately 3" less per span.) Surface Width Clearance (Width Between Support Arms) 30" 48" 60" 72" 27" 45" 57" * *Clearance varies due to the combination of panels used. To determine clearances, use the distance from the inner edge of each outer support arm to the inside of the mid-run work surface support, which should be positioned at the panel connection closest to the center of the work surface. Holes are predrilled on the left and right sides for attaching suspended storage; holes can also be field drilled to hang drawers in any position. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 205 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Optional keyboard support products can be mounted under most squared-edge rectangular work surfaces. • All adjustable keyboard trays and keyboard holders will fit under all widths except 24". • Extended-length-arm keyboard support products, when specified with the shorter 17 3/4" track, can fit under 24"- and 30"-deep work surfaces (although the keyboard support product will not store completely under the 24"-deep work surface). The holes to mount keyboard support products must be drilled on site. Options For high-density cable management on the underside of the work surface, order the optional Power Center (NP359.) separately. For electrical access on the underside of the cable port, order the Cable Port Outlet Strip (NP358.6) separately. Order the optional Work Surface Bracket (A2390.) separately. Limitations While extended-length-arm keyboard support products specified with the shorter 17 3/4"-long track can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, they do not store completely. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 206 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Corner Work Surface A2332. Description This 90° corner work surface hangs from panels or wall strips. It has a cable access hole. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in a 24" depth and 36", 42", and 48" widths, or a 30" depth and 42" and 48" widths. Overall height with supports is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations The corner work surface can be extended on either side with squarededge rectangular work surfaces of the same depth. The corner work surface comes with one wire access hole in the center and a 7/8" gap between the panels and the rear edges of the work surface, allowing plugs, cables, and wires to feed from the equipment to ports and receptacles below work surface height. (When the attachment hardware is repositioned, this corner work surface can be hung on Series 3 panels; because the gap between the panel and the rear of the work surface becomes smaller, however, it can no longer be used to feed plugs, cables, and wires.) HOLE FOR WIRE ACCESS STANDARD WORK SURFACE SUPPORT CANTILEVERED FROM PANELS (OR WALL STRIPS) ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP Corner work surfaces include support arms and a corner work surface bracket to provide support. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept the support arms. The corner support bracket can be attached to either panel, situated next to the perpendicular panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 207 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces The following corner work surfaces are predrilled to accommodate a pencil drawer: • 24"-deep, 42"-wide surface • 24"-deep, 48"-wide surface • 30"-deep, 48"-wide surface 1 ⁄«¢" ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP 8 ‡/• " Optional keyboard support products and pencil drawers can be mounted under most squared-edge corner work surfaces. (See “Limitations” for exceptions.) 24"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE Options Order optional storage products separately: • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • Pencil Drawer, A-Style (AO480.) Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) 1 ⁄«¢" ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP 11 ‹«¢" 30"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE CORNER SUPPORT BRACKET ATTACHES TO EITHER PANEL Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Work surface-attached drawers and drawer pedestals cannot be attached beneath corner work surfaces. EXTEND WITH RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES Pencil drawers and keyboard support products cannot be attached to 24" x 36" and 30" x 42" work surfaces. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 208 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces When the fully adjustable keyboard tray is used with a 36"-wide corner work surface, vertical tray height adjustment is limited unless the keyboard tray is specified with the extended arm or the extended arm with the short track. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 209 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Corner Work Surface, Curved NP600. Description This 90° corner work surface hangs from panels or wall strips. It has a laminate top and vinyl edge and a cable access hole. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in a 24" depth and 36", 42", and 48" widths, or a 30" depth and 42" and 48" widths. Overall height with supports is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations The curved squared-edge corner work surface can be extended on either side with squared-edge rectangular work surfaces of the same depth. HOLE FOR WIRE ACCESS The corner work surface comes with one wire access hole in the center and a 7/8" gap between the panels and the rear edges of the work surface, allowing plugs, cables, and wires to feed from the equipment to ports and receptacles below work surface height. (When the attachment hardware is repositioned, this corner work surface can be hung on Series 3 panels; because the gap between the panel and the rear of the work surface becomes smaller, however, it can no longer be used to feed plugs, cables, and wires.) Corner work surfaces include support arms and a corner work surface bracket to provide support. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept the support arms. STANDARD WORK SURFACE SUPPORT CANTILEVERED FROM PANELS (OR WALL STRIPS) ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP The corner support bracket can be attached to either panel, situated next to the perpendicular panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 210 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Options Order the CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.), separately. Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) 1 ⁄«¢" ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP Limitations Because of the curved front edge, work surface-attached storage products and machine support products cannot be attached beneath this corner work surface. 8 ‡/• " 24"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«¢" ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP 11 ‹«¢" 30"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE CORNER SUPPORT BRACKET ATTACHES TO EITHER PANEL EXTEND WITH RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 211 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Corner Work Surface with Input Platform Cutout A2336. Description This 24"-deep work surface hangs from panels or wall strips and abuts 24"-deep squared-edge work surfaces. It has a laminate top and vinyl edge, two cable access holes, and a cutout for a useradjustable input platform. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in 24" depth and 48" and 60" widths. Planning Considerations This corner work surface accepts an optional Flex-Edge input platform (ordered separately) that provides independent height adjustment for the keyboard and the work surface itself. The angled front allows the user to extend the work area on one or both sides of the computer. MECHANISM FOR TILT/HEIGHT ADJUSTABILITY CUTOUT FOR FLEX-EDGE INPUT PLATFORM The mechanism that provides the tilt and height adjustments for the input platform is included with this corner work surface. Options Order the Flex-Edge Input Platform (G7730.) separately. Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) CAN BE EXTENDED ON BOTH SIDES BY 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACES Limitations Storage products and keyboard support products cannot be attached under this work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 212 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Flex-Edge Input Platform G7730. Description This adjustable platform attaches to a corner work surface with an input platform cutout. The platform has a laminate top. A flexible waterfall front edge supports the user’s arms during input and writing tasks, and flexible edges at each side provide protection from pinching between the platform and the adjacent work surface when adjusting the height. A curbed edge keeps items from rolling off the back and side edges. The height is adjusted with a release lever on the underside of the platform. The counterbalance mechanism permits the user to raise or lower the platform from 4" below the rear work surface to 11" above it. The platform also tilts 9° forward and 15° backward. Attachment hardware is included. HOLES FOR WIRE ACCESS Dimensions Width is 37 3/8". Depth is 21". INPUT PLATFORM Height is 1 5/8". Planning Considerations This input platform is used with a corner work surface with input platform cutout. This input platform can be raised, lowered, and tilted independently of the corner table desk, providing 15" of height adjustment and 24° of tilt adjustment. These adjustments allow for both sit-down and stand-up working positions and a wide range of hand and body work positions. The input platform is large enough to accommodate a keyboard plus a mouse, track ball, or digitizer pad. 11" 15Å 4" 9Å MECHANISM OFFERS TILT ADJUSTABILITY MECHANISM OFFERS HEIGHT ADJUSTABILITY Cables and wires are routed off the input platform through pockets in the platform edge. Limitations Storage products, keyboard support products, and accessories cannot be attached to the platform. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 213 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Corner Work Surface with Cable Port NP357. Description This 48"-wide 90° corner work surface hangs from an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel or wall strips. It has two cable management access holes and a black, 18" hinged cable port centered on the left side of the work surface for cable pass-through. The surface has predrilled holes for a power center. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Depth is 24" or 30". HOLES FOR WIRE ACCESS Width is 48". Overall height with supports is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. CANTILEVERED FROM PANELS (OR WALL STRIPS) CABLE PORT Planning Considerations The corner work surface can be extended on either side with squarededge rectangular work surfaces of the same depth. In addition to the cable port on the left side, the corner work surface comes with one wire access hole in the center and a 7/8" gap between the panels and the rear edges of the work surface, allowing plugs, cables, and wires to feed from the equipment to ports and receptacles below work surface height. (When the attachment hardware is repositioned, this corner work surface can be hung on Series 3 panels; because the gap between the panel and the rear of the work surface becomes smaller, however, it can no longer be used to feed plugs, cables, and wires.) ‡«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP Corner work surfaces include support arms and a corner work surface bracket to provide support. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept support arms. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 214 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces The corner support bracket can be attached to either panel, situated next to the perpendicular panel. The following corner work surfaces are predrilled to accommodate a pencil drawer: • 24"-deep, 48"-wide surface • 30"-deep, 48"-wide surface Optional keyboard support products and pencil drawers can be mounted under most squared-edge corner work surfaces. (See “Limitations” for exceptions.) Options For high-density cable management on the underside of the work surface, order the optional Power Center (NP359.) separately. For electrical access on the underside of the cable port, order the Cable Port Outlet Strip (NP358.6) separately. Order optional storage products separately: • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • Pencil Drawer, A-Style (AO480.) Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 215 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Work surface-attached drawers and drawer pedestals cannot be attached beneath corner work surfaces. Pencil drawers and keyboard support products cannot mount under the 24" x 36" and 30" x 42" work surfaces. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 216 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Round-End Peninsula A2350. Description This peninsula hangs from a panel, wall strips, or another work surface and is supported by 27 1/2"-high legs. It has predrilled holes for a pencil drawer and includes attachment hardware. Shipped knocked down. The peninsula has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. The 30"-deep peninsula fits an 18"- to 30"-wide panel; the 36"-deep peninsula fits a 24"- to 36"-wide panel. Dimensions Available in 30" and 36" depths and 48", 60", and 72" widths. Height is a nominal 29" to match standard sit-down height of any adjoining work surface. ATTACHED TO WALL FOR SUPPORT ATTACHED TO PANEL FOR SUPPORT Leg depth is 17"; it is inset 15" from end of peninsula. Planning Considerations The peninsula, positioned perpendicular to a panel or wall or another work surface, can function as a work space or conference surface. The 30"-deep peninsula can attach to an 18"-, 24"-, or 30"-wide panel. The 36"deep peninsula can attach to a 24"-, 30"-, or 36"-wide panel. The brackets can accommodate a maximum 6" inset on each end; see the accompanying illustrations. (The same dimensions apply when attaching a peninsula to wall strips.) The peninsula can also attach at any point perpendicular to adjoining hanging work surfaces. The peninsula fits flush when attached perpendicular to squared-edge hanging work surfaces, so there is no 7/8" gap or grommet for cords and plugs. Glides provide an additional 1 1/2" of leveling and alignment with adjacent work surfaces. L 30"-DEEP PENINSULA ON 30"-WIDE PANEL OR 36"-DEEP PENINSULA ON 36"-WIDE PANEL UP TO 6" INSET ON EACH END 24" 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE 30" MAXIMUM 6" INSET ON ONE END 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 217 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces The underside of the work surface has attachment hardware to accept the support brackets. The hardware does not interfere with a mid-run work surface support panel. When placing a peninsula perpendicular to another work surface, allow enough clearance to place a work chair between the support leg and the return work surface. A minimum of 27" is recommended if the chair is to fit under the peninsula, or less than 27" if the chair is to be angled under the peninsula and the perpendicular work surface. When a round-end peninsula is specified instead of a rectangular peninsula, some clearance is lost due to the inset support leg on the rounded end. Although pencil drawers, drawer pedestals, and keyboard support products can be suspended under the peninsula, this reduces the amount of clearance (kneespace), inhibiting the peninsula’s use as a conference area. Options Order optional storage products separately: • F-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAF12.) • F-Front Pedestal, Support (FAF13.) • H-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAH12.) • H-Front Pedestal, Support (FAH13.) • J-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAJ12.) • J-Front Pedestal, Support (FAJ13.) • B-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.B) • B-Front Pedestal, Support (NP361.) • C-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.C) • E-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.E) • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock (AO481.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) L ATTACHED TO CANTILEVERED WORK SURFACE FOR SUPPORT ATTACHMENT DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH MID-RUN WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL CAN BE ATTACHED AT ANY POINT ALONG WORK SURFACE FRONT EDGE LESS PENINSULA CLEARANCE NEEDED IF WORK CHAIR STRADDLES PENINSULA AND ADJACENT WORK SURFACE 27" NEED MINIMUM 27" CLEARANCE TO ACCOMMODATE WORK CHAIR PULLED UP TO PENINSULA SUPPORT LEG INSET REDUCES CLEARANCE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 218 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) Limitations Because of the fixed height of the attached support leg, the peninsula work surface matches the height of adjoining work surfaces only at the standard sitdown height (approximately 29" from the floor). Work surface support panels cannot be used with the panel-attached peninsula. Peninsula work surfaces cannot be used as stabilizing returns. Improper use can cause product failure and personal injury. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 219 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Rectangular Peninsula A2352. Description This peninsula hangs from a panel, wall strips, or another work surface and is supported by 27 1/2"-high legs. It has predrilled holes for a pencil drawer and includes attachment hardware. Shipped knocked down. The peninsula has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. The 30"-deep peninsula fits an 18"- to 30"-wide panel; the 36"-deep peninsula fits a 24"- to 36"-wide panel. Dimensions Available in 30" and 36" depths and 48", 60", and 72" widths. Height is a nominal 29" to match standard sit-down height of any adjoining work surface. Planning Considerations The peninsula, positioned perpendicular to a panel or wall or another work surface, can function as a work space or conference surface. The 30"-deep peninsula can attach to an 18"-, 24"-, or 30"-wide panel. The 36"deep peninsula can attach to a 24-", 30-", or 36"-wide panel. The brackets can accommodate a maximum 6" inset on each end. (The same dimensions apply when attaching a peninsula to wall strips.) The peninsula can also attach at any point perpendicular to adjoining hanging work surfaces. The peninsula fits flush when attached perpendicular to squared-edge hanging work surfaces, so there is no 7/8" gap or grommet for cords and plugs. 30"-DEEP PENINSULA ON 30"-WIDE PANEL OR 36"-DEEP PENINSULA ON 36"-WIDE PANEL UP TO 6" INSET ON EACH END L 24" 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE Glides provide an additional 1 1/2" of leveling and alignment with adjacent work surfaces. The underside of the work surface has attachment hardware to accept the support brackets. The hardware does not interfere with a mid-run work surface support panel. ATTACHED TO WALL FOR SUPPORT ATTACHED TO PANEL FOR SUPPORT 30" MAXIMUM 6" INSET ON ONE END 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 220 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces When placing a peninsula perpendicular to another work surface, allow enough clearance to place a work chair between the support leg and the return work surface. A minimum of 27" is recommended if the chair is to fit under the peninsula, or less than 27" if the chair is to be angled under the peninsula and the perpendicular work surface. Although pencil drawers, drawer pedestals, and keyboard support products can be suspended under the peninsula, this reduces significantly the amount of clearance (kneespace), inhibiting the peninsula’s use as a conference area. Options Order optional storage products separately: • F-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAF12.) • F-Front Pedestal, Support (FAF13.) • H-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAH12.) • H-Front Pedestal, Support (FAH13.) • J-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAJ12.) • J-Front Pedestal, Support (FAJ13.) • B-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.B) • B-Front Pedestal, Support (NP361.) • C-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.C) • E-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.E) • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock (AO481.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) L ATTACHMENT DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH MID-RUN WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL ATTACHED TO CANTILEVERED WORK SURFACE FOR SUPPORT CAN BE ATTACHED AT ANY POINT ALONG WORK SURFACE FRONT EDGE LESS PENINSULA CLEARANCE NEEDED IF WORK CHAIR STRADDLES PENINSULA AND ADJACENT WORK SURFACE 27" NEED MINIMUM 27" CLEARANCE TO ACCOMMODATE WORK CHAIR PULLED UP TO PENINSULA Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 221 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) Limitations Because of the fixed height of the attached support leg, the peninsula work surface matches the height of adjoining work surfaces only at the standard sitdown height (approximately 29" from the floor). Work surface support panels cannot be used with the panel-attached peninsula. Peninsula work surfaces cannot be used as stabilizing returns. Improper use can cause product failure and personal injury. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 222 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Pass-Through Cover A2399. Description This cover provides a continuous surface for two back-to-back squarededge work surfaces hung on an open panel frame. It is 48" wide but can be field cut to fit a narrower opening. Dimensions Width is 48". Depth is 4 3/8". Height is 1 1/2", including positioning prongs. Planning Considerations Using a pass-through cover creates a continuous surface for face-to-face conversations between adjacent offices or for sharing resources or equipment between offices. This cover requires field cutting to fit narrower openings. L FIELD CUT TO WIDTH NEEDED FILLS SPACE BETWEEN WORK SURFACES ON OPEN PANEL FRAME Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 223 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Work Surfaces L-SHAPED SUPPORT OPTIONAL PENCIL DRAWER SEPARATE, ROUNDED VINYL EDGING ALONG FRONT AND SIDES 8 ‡«•"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 11 ‹«¢"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 16 ‹«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 22 fi«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE Radiused-edge work surfaces have a separate, rounded vinyl edging along the front and side edges. All radiused-edge work surfaces for Action Office Series 1 and Series 2 panels hang from L-shaped supports on compatibly sized panels, combinations of panels, or wall strips. Overall height of the work surfaces (with supports) is 8 7/8" on 24"-deep hanging work surfaces, 11 3/4" on 30"-deep work surfaces. Radiused-edge work surfaces are available in rectangular and corner shapes. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 224 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Features • Radiused-edge hanging work surfaces are 1" thick. • Radiused-edge work surfaces have rounded edges, finished in a separate strip of vinyl that can be chosen to blend or contrast with the finish of the work surface top. • Radiused-edge hanging work surfaces are available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", 52", 60", 64", 72", and 76" widths. • Radiused-edge work surfaces can accept a full complement of hanging storage components beneath the surface. Because of their rounded edge and rounded corners, radiused-edge work surfaces are somewhat less versatile than squared-edge ones. Radiused-edge work surfaces do not fit together as tightly as squared-edge work surfaces when positioned at right angles to one another in a corner; the radiused edges and corners create small gaps where the work surfaces meet. Because of their position in relation to the panel, these work surfaces do not allow cables to drop behind the work surfaces. (To feed large plugs and cables through the gap at the rear of a radiused work surface, it is necessary to slide the work surface forward slightly from its support, feed the plug and cord through, and then slip the work surface back in place. Panels constructed of material with more “give”—like acoustical panels—are able to accommodate thicker cables more easily.) In addition, peninsula work surfaces cannot hang off the front edge of a radiused-edge rectangular work surface. Actual clearances between supports should always be checked for each product in planning for hanging or freestanding storage beneath the work surface. WORK SURFACE MUST BE SLID FORWARD TEMPORARILY TO ALLOW LARGE PLUGS TO DROP BEHIND WORK SURFACE SMALL GAP WHERE ADJACENT WORK SURFACES MEET L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 225 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Rectangular Work Surface AO417. Description This work surface hangs from a panel or wall strips and has predrilled holes for drawers and suspended pedestals. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate or veneer top and vinyl edge. The 52"-, 64"-, or 76"-wide work surface hangs from panels connected by a spacer or the flat side of a three-way 90° connector; the extended length fills the space made by the connector and provides a continuous work surface. The 72"- and 76"-wide surfaces include one additional center bracket. Dimensions Available in 24" and 30" depths and 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", 52", 60", 64", 72", and 76" widths; also available in 18" depth and 48" width. ‹«•" GAP FOR CORDS 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«¢" ‹«•" GAP FOR CORDS 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«¢" 8 ‡«•" 4 ‹«¢" 11 fi«•" 11 ‹«¢" 5 ‹«•" 17 ⁄«¢" Overall height, with supports, is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations Rectangular work surfaces can be used alone, at right angles to one another to form a corner, or as extensions to corner surfaces. Because of the rounded edges and corners, these work surfaces leave a slight gap where adjacent work surfaces meet. When installed on Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panels, radiused-edge work surfaces have approximately a 3/8" gap between the back of the work surface and the panel. SLIGHT GAP OCCURS AT ROUNDED FRONT EDGES WHEN 2 SURFACES ARE USED AT RIGHT ANGLES TO ONE ANOTHER Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept a support arm. The additional support on the 72"- and the 76"-wide work surfaces is to be located at the panel connection closest to the center. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 226 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces To provide additional support at the front corner for particularly heavy equipment, order a work surface bracket (usable only when the width of the perpendicular panel matches the work surface depth). To place freestanding files or pedestals under a radiused-edge rectangular work surface, use the following clearance dimensions between support arms. (For work surfaces 72" and 76" wide, the clearance is the distance from the center support arm to each end support arm. That clearance varies, depending on the widths of the panels supporting the work surface.) Surface Width Clearance (Width Between Support Arms) 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 52" 60" 64" 72" 76" 21" 27" 33" 39" 45" 49" 57" 61" * * *Clearance varies due to the combination of panels used. To determine clearances, use the distance from the inner edge of each outer support arm to the inside of the mid-run work surface support, which should be positioned at the panel connection closest to the center of the work surface. Holes are predrilled on the left and right sides for attaching suspended storage (except the 18"-deep work surface); holes can also be field drilled to hang drawers in any position. ADDITIONAL CENTER SUPPORT ARM FOR WORK SURFACES 72" AND 76" WIDE OPTIONAL WORK SURFACE BRACKETS RECOMMENDED FOR FRONT-EDGE SUPPORT OF WORK SURFACES 72" AND WIDER OR FOR SUPPORT OF HEAVY EQUIPMENT CLEARANCE—DISTANCE BETWEEN SUPPORT ARMS (3" LESS THAN WORK SURFACE WIDTH) CLEARANCE CLEARANCE DISTANCE BETWEEN CENTER SUPPORT ARM AND EACH OUTER BRACKET (APPROXIMATELY 3" LESS PER SPAN) ADDITIONAL SUPPORT ARM ON WORK SURFACES 72" AND 76" WIDE FILING WIDTH CLEARANCE LIMITED TO WIDTH OF CLEARANCE ON EACH SIDE OF ADDITIONAL SUPPORT ARM L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 227 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Optional keyboard support products can be attached under most radiused-edge rectangular work surfaces. • All adjustable keyboard trays and keyboard holders will fit under all work surface widths except 24". • Extended-length-arm keyboard support products specified with the shorter 17 3/4" track can fit under 24"and 30"-deep work surfaces (although the keyboard support product will not be completely hidden under the 24"deep work surface when stored). The holes to mount keyboard support products must be drilled on site. Options Order the optional Work Surface Bracket (A2390.) separately. Order optional storage products separately: • F-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAF12.) • F-Front Pedestal, Support (FAF13.) • H-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAH12.) • H-Front Pedestal, Support (FAH13.) • J-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAJ12.) • J-Front Pedestal, Support (FAJ13.) • B-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.B) • B-Front Pedestal, Support (NP361.) • C-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.C) • E-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.E) • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock (AO481.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 228 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Storage products cannot be attached under the 18"-deep work surface. Keyboard support products cannot be attached under 24"-wide work surfaces or the 18"-deep work surface. While extended-length-arm keyboard support products specified with the shorter 17 3/4"-long track can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, they are not hidden completely when stored. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 229 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Corner Work Surface AO421. Description This 90° corner work surface hangs from Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels or wall strips. It has a cable access hole. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface has a laminate or veneer top and vinyl edge. Dimensions Available in a 24" depth and 36", 42", and 48" widths, or a 30" depth and 42" and 48" widths. Overall height with supports is 8 7/8" on the 24"-deep work surface and 11 3/4" on the 30"-deep work surface. Planning Considerations The corner work surface can be extended on either side with radiusededge rectangular work surfaces of the same depth. HOLE FOR WIRE ACCESS CANTILEVERED FROM PANELS (OR WALL STRIPS) The corner work surface comes with one wire access hole in the center. When installed on Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panels, radiused-edge work surfaces have approximately a 3/8" gap between the back of the work surface and the panel. Corner work surfaces included support arms and a corner work surface bracket to provide support. Attachment hardware comes installed on the underside of the work surface, ready to accept the support arms. STANDARD WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ‹«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP The corner support bracket can be attached to either panel, situated next to the perpendicular panel. The following corner work surfaces are predrilled to accommodate a pencil drawer: • 24"-deep, 42"-wide surface • 24"-deep, 48"-wide surface • 30"-deep, 48"-wide surface L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 230 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Optional keyboard support products and pencil drawers can be mounted under most radiused-edge corner work surfaces. (See “Limitations” for exceptions.) Options Order optional pencil drawers separately: • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • Pencil Drawer, A-Style (AO480.) Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) • CPU Holder, Adjustable (G7810.) • CPU Holder (NP280.) 1" ‹«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP 8 ‡«•" 24"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE 1" ‹«•" GAP FOR CORD DROP 11 ‹«¢" 30"-DEEP CORNER WORK SURFACE Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) CORNER SUPPORT BRACKET ATTACHES TO EITHER PANEL Limitations Work surface-attached drawers and drawer pedestals cannot be attached under corner work surfaces. Pencil drawers and the fully adjustable keyboard tray with standard-length arm cannot be attached under the 24"-deep, 36"-wide work surface. L EXTEND WITH RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 231 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Corner Work Surface with Input Platform Cutout AO427. Description This 24"-deep work surface hangs from panels or wall strips and is used with adjacent 24"-deep radiused-edge work surfaces. It has a laminate top and vinyl edge, two cable access holes, and a cutout for a user-adjustable input platform. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in 24" depth and 48" and 60" widths. Planning Considerations This corner work surface accepts an optional Flex-Edge input platform that provides independent height adjustment for the keyboard and the work surface itself. The angled front allows the user to extend the work area on one or both sides of the computer. MECHANISM FOR TILT/HEIGHT ADJUSTABILITY CUTOUT FOR FLEX-EDGE INPUT PLATFORM The mechanism that provides the tilt and height adjustments for the input platform is included with this corner work surface. Options Order the Flex-Edge Input Platform (G7730.) separately. Order optional armature tools separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Storage products and keyboard support products cannot be attached under this work surface. L CAN BE EXTENDED ON BOTH SIDES BY 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 232 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Round-End Peninsula AO452. Description This peninsula hangs from a panel, wall strips, or another work surface and is supported by 27 1/2"-high legs. It has predrilled holes for a pencil drawer and includes attachment hardware. Shipped knocked down. The peninsula has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. The 24"- or 30"-deep peninsula fits an 18"- to 30"-wide panel; the 36"-deep peninsula fits a 24"- to 36"-wide panel. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", and 36" depths. Available in 48", 60", and 72" widths. Height is a nominal 29" to match standard sit-down height of any adjoining work surface. ATTACHED TO WALL FOR SUPPORT ATTACHED TO PANEL FOR SUPPORT Leg width is 17"; it is inset 15" from end of peninsula. Planning Considerations The peninsula, positioned perpendicular to a panel or wall or another work surface, can function as a work space or conference surface. The 24"- or 30"-deep peninsula can attach to an 18"-, 24"-, or 30"-wide panel. The 36"-deep peninsula can attach to a 24"-, 30"-, or 36"-wide panel. The brackets can accommodate a maximum 6" inset on each end. (The same dimensions apply when attaching a peninsula to wall strips.) The peninsula can also attach at any point perpendicular to adjoining hanging work surfaces. The peninsula fits flush when attached perpendicular to squared-edge hanging work surfaces, so there is no 3/8" gap or grommet for cords and plugs. (There is a slight gap, however, if placed perpendicular to the front of a radiused-edge work surface.) L DEPTH OF PENINSULA MATCHES WIDTH OF PANEL UP TO 6" INSET ON EACH END 24" 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE 30" MAXIMUM 6" INSET ON ONE END 36" SUPPORT BRACKETS ATTACH HERE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 233 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Glides provide an additional 1 1/2" of leveling and alignment with adjacent work surfaces. The underside of the work surface has attachment hardware to accept the support brackets. The hardware does not interfere with a mid-run work surface support panel. When placing a peninsula perpendicular to another work surface, allow enough clearance to place a work chair between the support leg and the return work surface. A minimum of 27" is recommended if the chair is to fit under the peninsula, or less than 27" if the chair is to be angled under the peninsula and the perpendicular work surface. With the round-end peninsula, some clearance is lost due to the inset support leg on the rounded end. Although pencil drawers, drawer pedestals, and machine support products can be suspended under the peninsula, this reduces the amount of clearance (kneespace), inhibiting the peninsula’s use as a conference area. Options Order optional storage products separately: • F-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAF12.) • F-Front Pedestal, Support (FAF13.) • H-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAH12.) • H-Front Pedestal, Support (FAH13.) • J-Front Pedestal, Suspended (FAJ12.) • J-Front Pedestal, Support (FAJ13.) • B-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.B) • B-Front Pedestal, Support (NP361.) • C-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.C) • E-Front Pedestal, Suspended (G5112.E) • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock (AO481.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) L ATTACHED TO CANTILEVERED WORK SURFACE FOR SUPPORT ATTACHMENT DOES NOT INTERFERE WITH MID-RUN WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL CAN BE ATTACHED AT ANY POINT ALONG WORK SURFACE FRONT EDGE (FITS FLUSH IF PERPENDICULAR TO SQUARED-EDGE WORK SURFACE; SLIGHT GAP IF PERPENDICULAR TO RADIUSED-EDGE WORK SURFACE) LESS PENINSULA CLEARANCE NEEDED IF WORK CHAIR STRADDLES PENINSULA AND ADJACENT WORK SURFACE 27" CREATES SLIGHT GAP DUE TO RADIUSED EDGE NEED MINIMUM 27" CLEARANCE TO ACCOMMODATE WORK CHAIR PULLED UP TO PENINSULA SUPPORT LEG INSET REDUCES CLEARANCE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 234 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Order optional machine support products separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Standard Tray (G7720.T) • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel, with Clamp Tray (G7720.C) • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.) • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.) • A-Style Keyboard Drawer (AO479.) Limitations Because of the fixed height of the attached support leg, the peninsula work surface matches the height of adjoining work surfaces only at the standard sitdown height (approximately 29" from the floor). Work surface support panels cannot be used with the panel-attached peninsula. Peninsula work surfaces cannot be used as stabilizing returns. Improper use can cause product failure and personal injury. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 235 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Flex-Edge™ Work Surfaces COMPATIBLE WITH SQUARED-EDGE AND RADIUSED-EDGE WORK SURFACES RESILIENT (FLEX-EDGE) EDGING ON FRONT EDGE 8 ‡«•"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 11 ‹«¢"-HEIGHT WITH SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE 16 ‹«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 24"-DEEP WORK SURFACE; 22 fi«•"-DEEP SUPPORT FOR 30"-DEEP WORK SURFACE Flex-Edge work surfaces include various types of corner work surfaces, each with an integrally molded, soft, resilient front-edge surface. The resilient edge reduces pressure on the user’s wrists and carpal tunnel area during task-intensive work. It deflects slightly when forearm pressure is applied, providing support for proper keying positions. The Flex-Edge front is found on a corner work surface, a corner work surface with a cutout for a monitor lift, and a work surface support attachment. These Flex-Edge work surfaces—and the monitor lifts that go with them—support users’ ergonomic needs associated with heavy computer use. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 236 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Flex-Edge Corner Work Surface A2430. No Cutout A2440. Monitor Lift Cutout Description This work surface hangs from panels or wall strips and abuts squared-edge work surfaces. It has a laminate top and a flexible waterfall front edge to support the user’s arms during input and writing tasks. The work surface has flexible side edges and a curbed edge to keep items from rolling off the back. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface with monitor lift cutout has an additional curbed edge to keep items from rolling into the cutout. Dimensions Available in a 24" depth and 48" and 60" widths, or in a 30" depth and 48" width. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 237 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Planning Considerations The concave-shaped input surface allows the user to pull in closer to the center of the work surface. Using this work surface between two rectangular work surfaces creates a wide expanse for reference documents. The flexible front edge makes this an appropriate choice for users who spend most of their time at the computer. The 24"-deep edges are designed to abut 24"-deep work surfaces, and the 30"-deep edges are designed to abut 30"-deep work surfaces. When used with a monitor lift, the work surface allows independent height adjustment of the monitor. Options Order the Monitor Lift (G7752., G7753., G7756., or G7757.) separately for the corner work surface with the monitor lift cutout. USED ONLY NEXT TO SQUARED-EDGE WORK SURFACE FLEX-EDGE CORNER WORK SURFACE RESILIENT FRONT EDGE PROTRUDES OPTIONAL MONITOR LIFT CUTOUT Limitations Storage products, machine support products, and work surface accessories cannot be attached to this work surface. ABUTS SQUARED-EDGE WORK SURFACE EXTENDED ON SIDES WITH RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 238 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Flex-Edge Corner Work Surface AO440. No Cutout AO442. Monitor Lift Cutout Description This work surface hangs from panels or wall strips and abuts radiused-edge work surfaces. It has a laminate top and a flexible waterfall front edge to support the user’s arms during input and writing tasks. The work surface has flexible side edges and a curbed edge to keep items from rolling off the back. Attachment hardware is included. The work surface with monitor lift cutout has an additional curbed edge to keep items from rolling into the cutout. Dimensions Available in a 24" depth and 48" and 60" widths, or in a 30" depth and 48" width. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 239 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces USED ONLY NEXT TO RADIUSED-EDGE WORK SURFACE Planning Considerations The concave-shaped input surface allows the user to pull in closer to the center of the work surface. Using this work surface between two rectangular work surfaces creates a wide expanse for reference documents. The flexible front edge makes this an appropriate choice for users who spend most of their time at the computer. The 24"-deep edges are designed to abut 24"-deep work surfaces, and the 30"-deep edges are designed to abut 30"-deep work surfaces. When used with a monitor lift, the work surface allows independent height adjustment of the monitor. Options Order the Monitor Lift (G7752., G7753., G7756., or G7757.) separately for the corner work surface with the monitor lift cutout. FLEX-EDGE CORNER WORK SURFACE RESILIENT FRONT EDGE PROTRUDES OPTIONAL MONITOR LIFT CUTOUT Limitations Storage products, machine support products, and work surface accessories cannot be attached to this work surface. ABUTS RADIUSED-EDGE WORK SURFACE EXTENDED ON SIDES WITH RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 240 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Monitor Lift G7752. Single Arm, No Slide G7753. Single Arm, Slide G7756. Double Arm, No Slide G7757. Double Arm, Slide Description This monitor lift attaches to a Flex-Edge corner work surface with monitor lift cutout. The counterbalance mechanism permits the user to raise or lower equipment from 4" below the work surface to 12" above it. The assembly is black and includes a lift, equipment platform, and mounting pan. Attachment hardware is included. The single-arm monitor lift permits the user to raise or lower up to 50 pounds of equipment. The double-arm monitor lift permits the user to raise or lower up to 100 pounds of equipment. Any equipment placed on the lift must fall within the specified weight range and cannot exceed the size of the monitor lift cutout. The monitor lift with slide provides 2" of forward adjustment and 3" of backward adjustment. SINGLE ARM Dimensions Width is 16". Depth is 20" (22" with slide attachment). Planning Considerations Equipment placed on the lift must fall within the specified weight range and not exceed the size of the monitor lift cutout. The maximum load of 100 pounds for the monitor lift accommodates most computer monitors. The double-arm lift should be specified whenever it is likely the current smaller equipment load will exceed 50 pounds in the future. DOUBLE ARM For up to 2" of forward adjustment and 3" of backward adjustment, specify the monitor lift with slide. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 241 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Supports and Hardware Each Action Office Series 2 work surface includes the necessary hanging or attaching hardware (including extra support arms for work surfaces 72" and wider). In addition, there is a work surface bracket to increase support at the front of a work surface. End work surface support panels and support pedestals can be placed beneath work surfaces to provide support to them, enabling a longer uninterrupted run. Because end support panels and support pedestals can eliminate some panels used as returns, they open up the work area while providing support to both the work surface and the panel run. (See “Determining Proper Support” for specific support considerations for work surface support panels and pedestals.) ATTACHING HARDWARE SUPPORT PANELS OR PEDESTALS WORK SURFACE BRACKET L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 242 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Work Surface Bracket A2390. Description This bracket attaches to the front corner of a hanging work surface to provide additional support. It can be used only when the return panel width matches the work surface depth. This bracket cannot be used with a Flex-Edge work surface. Package contains four. Dimensions Height is 2 3/4". DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE MUST MATCH WIDTH OF RETURN PANEL Depth is 2 1/2". W Planning Considerations This bracket is designed to provide additional support when a work surface will carry a particularly heavy load or a load that is unevenly spread across the surface. (The bracket does not, however, change the overall load limit of the work surface.) D To use this bracket, the work surface depth must match the width of the return panel. Select the right-position bracket for the right side of the work surface and the left-position bracket for the left side of the work surface (when facing the work surface). ILLUSTRATION SHOWS LEFT-HAND POSITION PROVIDES ADDITIONAL SUPPORT AT FRONT CORNER OF HANGING RECTANGULAR WORK SURFACE Brackets are always recommended— regardless of load—when hanging work surfaces on 80"- or 85"-high panels. See the “Determining Proper Support” section for more information. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 243 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Work Surface Support Panel, End A2380. Description This panel attaches to both a squarededge work surface and a panel at the end of a panel run to provide support and to eliminate the need for a return panel and panel connector. It has 1" adjustable glides. The panel attaches under a work surface at the left or right end of a panel. Attachment hardware is included. The panel has a laminate or veneer surface. Dimensions Available in 24" and 30" depths. REPLACES RETURN PANEL AND CORNER CONNECTOR AT END OF PANEL RUN Height is 27 1/8". ATTACHES TO SQUARED-EDGE WORK SURFACE Planning Considerations This end work surface support panel is used only with squared-edge work surfaces. The support panel depth must correspond to the work surface depth: a 24"-deep panel to support a 24"-deep work surface or a 30"-deep panel to support a 30"-deep work surface. A 30"deep support panel is required for the 36"-deep end of a Liaison work surface with cutout. ATTACHES TO BOTH WORK SURFACE AND PANEL GLIDE COMPENSATES FOR SLIGHTLY UNEVEN FLOORS Work surface support panels 24" deep can be used in the middle of a run to support 30"-deep work surfaces if the work surfaces are ganged. The support panel is nonhanded prior to installation. Once installed, it becomes right- or left-handed, but it can be changed back by switching the bracket and plugs around to the open side. WRONG! MUST USE SUPPORT PANEL IN DEPTH TO MATCH DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE (EXCEPT WITH 36"-DEEP LIAISON WORK SURFACE) WORK SURFACES MUST BE GANGED WORK SURFACE BRACKET CAN BE USED AS MID-RUN STABILIZER—BUT DOES NOT ALLOW ACCESS TO CABLE MANAGEMENT BASE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 244 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Limitations The work surface end support panel provides support for a squared-edge work surface at only the 29" height. A work surface support panel can be used at only one end of a panel run. (The other end requires a return panel.) Maximum panel height is 67" (Series 2) or 62" (Series 1) for a panel run using a work surface support panel as a return 62" OR 67" on one end. (The exception is 80"- or 85"-high panels, Series 1 or Series 2, respectively, which are acceptable if they hold no hanging components other than work surfaces.) MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 62" OR 67" 80" AND 85" FOR PANELS IN PANEL RUN Suspended lateral files cannot be used on the same panel run as the work surface support panel. A run supported by a work surface support panel on one end has a maximum length of 8' with acoustical panels, 10' with hard-surfaced, fabriccovered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels. An end work surface support panel can be used as a mid-run stabilizer to increase the length of run between return panels. See “Length of Wall Run and Frequency of Support” under “Determining Proper Support” in the “Walls” section. MAXIMUM LOAD PER PANEL (FLIPPER DOOR UNIT, TACKBOARD, AND WORK SURFACE) ANY PANEL TYPE 80" AND 85"-HIGH PANELS ACCEPTABLE IF THERE ARE NO LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS OTHER THAN WORK SURFACES 16' RETURN PANEL RETURN PANEL GANGED MAXIMUM RUN OF 16'—RETURN PANELS REQUIRED AT EACH END; NO COMPONENTS OTHER THAN WORK SURFACES (GANGED) ALLOWED WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL (USED IN MIDDLE OF RUN) WRONG! WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL CANNOT BE USED ALONG SAME PANEL RUN AS PANEL-HUNG LATERAL FILES L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 245 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Work Surface Support Panel AO432. Description This panel attaches to both a radiusededge rectangular work surface and an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel to provide support and to eliminate the need for a return panel and panel connector. It attaches under a work surface at the left or right end of a panel and provides support at a panel run end. The panel has a laminate surface and 1" adjustable glides. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in 24" and 30" depths. Height is 27 3/8". Planning Considerations This work surface support panel is used only with radiused-edge work surfaces. The support panel depth must correspond to the work surface depth: a 24"-deep panel to support a 24"-deep work surface or a 30"-deep panel to support a 30"-deep work surface. Although this work surface support panel is used with radiused-edge work surfaces, which cannot be ganged to adjacent work surfaces for support, it can be used as a mid-run stabilizer if attachment holes are drilled in the field. REPLACES RETURN PANEL, CORNER CONNECTOR, AND SUPPORT ARM AT END OF PANEL RUN ATTACHES TO RADIUSED-EDGE WORK SURFACE ATTACHES TO BOTH WORK SURFACE AND PANEL GLIDE COMPENSATES FOR SLIGHTLY UNEVEN FLOORS WRONG! MUST USE SUPPORT PANEL IN DEPTH TO MATCH DEPTH OF WORK SURFACE The support panel is nonhanded prior to installation. Once installed, it becomes right- or left-handed, but it can be changed back by switching the bracket and plugs around to the open side. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 246 Work Surfaces Wall-Attached Work Surfaces Limitations The work surface support panel provides support for a radiused-edge work surface at only the 29" height. A work surface support panel can be used at only one end of a panel run. (The other end requires a return panel.) Maximum panel height is 67" (Series 2) or 62" (Series 1) for a panel run using a work surface support panel as a return on one end. (The exception is 80"- or 85"-high panels, Series 1 or Series 2, respectively, which are acceptable if they hold no hanging components other than work surfaces.) Suspended lateral files cannot be used on the same panel run as the work surface support panel. A run supported by a work surface support panel on one end has a maximum length of 8' with acoustical panels or 10' with hard-surfaced, fabriccovered, and tackable acoustical-barrier panels. See “Length of Wall Run and Frequency of Support” under “Determining Proper Support” in the “Walls” section. L 80" AND 85" 62" OR 67" MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF 62" OR 67" FOR PANELS IN PANEL RUN MAXIMUM LOAD PER PANEL (FLIPPER DOOR UNIT, TACKBOARD, AND WORK SURFACE) 80"- AND 85"-HIGH PANELS ACCEPTABLE IF THERE ARE NO LOAD-BEARING COMPONENTS OTHER THAN WORK SURFACES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 247 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Transaction surfaces, which attach to the tops of panels, add aesthetic and functional value in areas with frequent interaction or display. All Action Office squared-edge transaction surfaces specifically designed for use with Series 2 panels are 14 3/8" deep and 1" thick. When placed on top of a panel, these transaction surfaces have a 6 1/4" overhang on each side of the panel. Like the work surfaces, these transaction surfaces have a squared edge that is the same color as the top surface. Squared-edge transaction surfaces for Action Office Series 2 panels are available in three shapes: • Double round end • Round/rectangular end • Rectangular end Radiused-edge transaction surfaces are 14" deep and 1 1/8" thick. When placed on top of a Series 2 panel, these transaction surfaces have a nominal 6 3/8" overhang on each side of the panel. Like the work surfaces, these transaction surfaces have a radiused edge of vinyl that can blend or contrast with the finish of the transaction surface top. Radiused-edge transaction surfaces, developed originally for use with Action Office Series 1 panels, are available only with rectangular ends. All transaction surfaces use standard supports (ordered separately), located where the transaction surface is to attach to the panel. Transaction surfaces also accept optional task lights that can be attached to the underside of the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. 6 ⁄«¢" OVERHANG AT EACH SIDE 14 ‹«•" TRANSACTION SURFACE TASK LIGHT SQUARED-EDGE TRANSACTION SURFACE L 6 ‹«•" OVERHANG AT EACH SIDE 14" TRANSACTION SURFACE TASK LIGHT RADIUSED-EDGE TRANSACTION SURFACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 248 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surfaces The “Squared-Edge Transaction Surface/Support Panel Relationships” chart is a quick reference to the transaction surface width required to fit on top of various-sized supporting panels or panel runs; the chart is organized by transaction surface type and applies only to squared-edge transaction surfaces. The chart assumes that all adjacent panels are of equal or lower height so that finished ends on adjacent higher panels do not interfere with the squared-edge transaction surface. However, a squared-edge transaction surface can fit next to an adjacent, higher panel if the adjacent panel on the opposite end of the transaction surface is of equal or lower height. ADJACENT TALLER PANELS INTERFERE WITH ANY EXTENDING SQUARED-EDGE TRANSACTION SURFACE ENDS To determine the appropriate width of each shape of squared-edge transaction surface, add to the width of the panel or panel run all dimensions gained from an extending edge of the transaction surface (4") and dimension-adding panel hardware used to finish an end of a panel or panel run (approximately 3"). Straight-line panel connectors add no dimension. For example, this drawing for the double-round-end, squared-edge transaction surface illustrates the following: 48" + 8" + 6" = 62" Panel width Two extending squared-edge transaction surface edges Panel hardware (other than straight-line panel connectors) on two ends (approximate width) Squared-edge transaction surface width required L 4" 3" 62" 48" PANEL 4" 3" DOUBLE-ROUND-END TRANSACTION SURFACE DIMENSION-GAINING PANEL HARDWARE ADDS 3" AT EACH END Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 249 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surface/Support Panel Relationships Transaction Surface Type Transaction Surface Width Width of Supporting Panel or Run Double Round End 62" 74" 86" 48" 60" 72" Round/Rectangular End 31" 37" 43" 49" 55" 67" 79" 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 60" 72" Rectangular End 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 60" 72" 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 60" 72" Radiused-Edge Transaction Surfaces Radiused-edge transaction surfaces have no extending edges; nor do the change-ofheight finished ends protrude beyond the panel edge. Therefore, their size can be matched to the width of the supporting panel or panel run, and they can be used adjacent to higher panels without interference. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 250 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surface, Double Round End A2810. Description This 14"-deep surface attaches to the top of an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel to provide a counter or display surface. Round ends extend 4" past the panel. The surface is predrilled for a transaction surface task light. Attachment hardware is included. The surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in 62", 74", and 86" widths. Depth is 14 3/8". 62" 4" 3" Height is 1". 4" 3" 48" PANEL DIMENSION-GAINING PANEL HARDWARE ADDS 3" AT EACH END Planning Considerations Select the transaction surface width according to the panel or panel run width: Transaction Surface Width Panel or Panel Run Width 62" 74" 86" 48" 60" 72" Each round end extends 4" beyond the end of the supporting panel. Dimensiongaining panel hardware accounts for approximately another 3" on each end. The chart above and the illustrations, which show the width of the panel(s) required to accommodate each size transaction surface, account for the round-end extensions and the dimension-gaining hardware. Squared-edge transaction surfaces have a 6 1/4" overhang on each side of the panel. An optional task light, ordered separately, can be attached to either side under the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. L 74" 4" 4" 3" 3" 48" PANEL 12" PANEL STRAIGHT-LINE PANEL CONNECTOR ADDS NO DIMENSION 86" 4" 4" 3" 3" 24" PANEL 48" PANEL STRAIGHT-LINE PANEL CONNECTOR ADDS NO DIMENSION Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 251 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). Options Order support hardware separately: • Finished End with Transaction Surface End Support (A1250.T) • Transaction Surface Support, Center (AO460.) • Transaction Surface Support, Mid-End (AO463.) DOUBLE ROUND ENDS INTERFERE WHEN ADJACENT PANELS ARE HIGHER Order the optional Task Light, Transaction Surface (G6220.), separately. Limitations Higher panels cannot be used adjacent to round-end transaction surfaces, because the extended round ends interfere with the adjacent panels. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 252 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surface, Round/Rectangular End A2820. Description This 14"-deep surface attaches to the top of an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel to provide a counter or display surface. The round end extends 4" past the panel; the rectangular end is flush with the panel. The surface is predrilled for a transaction surface task light. Attachment hardware is included. The surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in 31", 37", 43", 49", 55", 67", and 79" widths. 31" 4" 4" 3" 3" 30" PANEL 24" PANEL Depth is 14 3/8". 37" Height is 1". Planning Considerations Select the transaction surface width according to the panel or panel run width: Transaction Surface Width Panel or Panel Run Width 31" 37" 43" 49" 55" 67" 79" 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 60" 72" The round end of the surface extends 4" beyond the end of the supporting panel. Dimension-gaining panel hardware accounts for approximately another 3". The chart above and the illustrations, which show the width of the panel(s) required to accommodate each size transaction surface, account for the round-end extension and the dimensiongaining hardware on the round end. DIMENSION-GAINING PANEL HARDWARE ADDS 3" AT OVERHANGING EDGE 4" 3" 43" 24" PANEL 4" 3" 12" PANEL STRAIGHT-LINE PANEL CONNECTOR ADDS NO DIMENSION 49" 30" PANEL 12" PANEL Squared-edge transaction surfaces have a 6 1/4" overhang on each side of the panel. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 253 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces An optional task light, ordered separately, can be attached to either side under the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. 55" 4" 3" Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). When installing the rectangular end of the transaction surface next to a higher adjacent panel, a separate change-ofheight support bracket must be ordered. DIMENSION-GAINING HARDWARE ADDS 3" AT OVERHANGING EDGE Limitations The extended round end of this transaction surface cannot be used adjacent to a higher panel. If the rectangular end can be tightly abutted to the finished end of the higher panel, however, the transaction surface can be accommodated by allowing for a longer extension on the round end. 67" 4" Options Order support hardware separately: • Finished End with Transaction Surface End Support (A1250.T) • Transaction Surface Support, Center (AO460.) • Transaction Surface Support, Mid-End (AO463.) • Transaction Surface Support, Change of Height (AO464.) Order the optional Task Light, Transaction Surface (G6220.), separately. 48" PANEL 3" 48" PANEL 79" 4" 3" 30" PANEL WORKS WITH HIGHER PANEL AS LONG AS HIGHER PANEL IS ADJACENT TO RECTANGULAR END L 12" PANEL 42" PANEL ADJACENT HIGHER PANEL INTERFERES WITH ROUND END CANNOT BE USED WITH ADJACENT HIGHER PANEL ON EXTENDED ROUND END Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 254 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surface, Rectangular End A2830. Description This 14"-deep surface attaches to the top of an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel to provide a counter or display surface. Ends are flush with the panel. The surface is predrilled for a transaction surface task light. Attachment hardware is included. The surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", 60", and 72" widths. Depth is 14 3/8". Height is 1". Planning Considerations Select the transaction surface width to match the width of the panel or panel run. 24" 30" 24" PANEL 30" PANEL Transaction surface rectangular ends are flush with the ends of the support panels or panel runs and therefore can be placed on top of panels or panel runs the same width as the transaction surface. (See illustrations.) Squared-edge transaction surfaces have a 6 1/4" overhang on each side of the panel. An optional task light, ordered separately, can be attached to either side under the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. The exception is the 24"-wide transaction surface, which cannot accept any task light. NO ADDED DIMENSION FROM PANEL HARDWARE 36" 42" 36" PANEL 42" PANEL Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 255 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces When installing this transaction surface next to a higher panel, a separate change-of-height support bracket must be ordered for the end that is adjacent to the higher panel. 48" 48" PANEL Options Order support hardware separately: • Finished End with Transaction Surface End Support (A1250.T) • Transaction Surface Support, Center (AO460.) • Transaction Surface Support, Mid-End (AO463.) • Transaction Surface Support, Change of Height (AO464.) Order the optional Task Light, Transaction Surface (G6220.), separately. NO ADDED DIMENSION FROM PANEL HARDWARE 60" 30" PANEL Limitations This transaction cannot be used between two higher panels. A higher panel can be used adjacent to one end of the transaction surface, as long as the adjacent panel on the opposite end of the transaction surface is of equal or lower height. A transaction surface task light cannot be mounted under a 24"-wide transaction surface. 30" PANEL 72" 24" PANEL 24" PANEL 24" PANEL FINISHED ENDS OF ADJACENT HIGHER PANELS INTERFERE WITH RECTANGULAR END TRANSACTION SURFACE NO INTERFERENCE WHEN RECTANGULAR END TRANSACTION SURFACE IS USED ADJACENT TO HIGHER PANEL ON 1 END L CANNOT BE USED WITH ADJACENT HIGHER PANELS ON BOTH ENDS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 256 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Squared-Edge Transaction Surface, Right Angle NP281. Description This 14"-deep surface attaches to the top of two 24"-wide Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels joined with a two-way 90° connector. It provides a right-angle counter or display surface. Attachment hardware is included. The surface has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", 60", and 72" widths. Depth is 14 3/8". Height is 1". Planning Considerations Select the transaction surface width to match the width of the panel or panel run on each side of a 90° corner. (Both sides of the transaction surface must be the same width.) ADJACENT PANEL ON OPPOSITE END MUST BE OF EQUAL OR LOWER HEIGHT Transaction surface rectangular ends are flush with the ends of the support panels or panel runs and therefore can be placed on top of panels or panel runs the same width as that of the transaction surface. (See illustrations.) Squared-edge transaction surfaces have a 6 1/4" overhang on each side of the panel. An optional task light, ordered separately, can be attached under either side of the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. The exception is the 24"-wide transaction surface, which cannot accept any task light. HIGHER ADJACENT PANEL ON 1 END ONLY REQUIRES CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT SUPPORT BRACKET ON END ADJACENT TO HIGHER PANEL Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 257 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces When installing this transaction surface next to a higher panel, a separate change-of-height support bracket must be ordered for the end that is adjacent to the higher panel. Options Order support hardware separately: • Finished End with Transaction Surface End Support (A1250.T) • Transaction Surface Support, Center (AO460.) • Transaction Surface Support, Mid-End (AO463.) • Transaction Surface Support, Change of Height (AO464.) Order the optional Task Light, Transaction Surface (G6220.), separately. Limitations This transaction surface panel cannot be used between two higher panels. A higher panel can be used adjacent to one end of the transaction surface, as long as the adjacent panel on the opposite end of the transaction surface is of equal or lower height. A transaction surface task light cannot be mounted under a 24"-wide transaction surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 258 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Radiused-Edge Transaction Surface AO450. Description This 14"-deep surface attaches to the top of an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel to provide a counter or display surface. Ends are flush with the panel. Attachment hardware is included. The surface has a laminate or veneer top and vinyl edge. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", 60", and 72" widths. Depth is 14". Height is 1 1/8". Planning Considerations Select the transaction surface width to match the width of the panel or panel run. Transaction surface ends are flush with the ends of the support panels or panel runs and therefore can be placed on top of panels or panel runs the same width as the transaction surface and be used adjacent to higher panels on one or both sides without interference. (See illustrations.) Radiused-edge transaction surfaces have a nominal 6 3/8" overhang on each side of the panel. An optional task light, ordered separately, can be attached to either side under the transaction surface at any point except at a panel center support. The exception is the 24"-wide transaction surface, which cannot accept any task light. 24" 30" 24" PANEL 30" PANEL NO ADDED DIMENSION FROM PANEL HARDWARE 36" 42" 36" PANEL 42" PANEL Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 259 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces When installing the transaction surface next to a higher panel, a separate change-of-height support bracket must be ordered for each end that is adjacent to a higher panel. 48" 48" PANEL Options Order support hardware separately: • Finished End with Transaction Surface End Support (A1250.T) • Transaction Surface Support, Center (AO460.) • Transaction Surface Support, Mid-End (AO463.) • Transaction Surface Support, Change of Height (AO464.) Order the optional Task Light, Transaction Surface (G6220.), separately. NO ADDED DIMENSION FROM PANEL HARDWARE 60" 30" PANEL 30" PANEL Limitations A transaction surface task light cannot be mounted under 24"-wide transaction surface. 72" 24" PANEL 24" PANEL 24" PANEL NO INTERFERENCE WHEN RADIUSED-EDGE TRANSACTION SURFACE IS USED ADJACENT TO HIGHER PANEL ON ONE OR BOTH ENDS L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 260 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Supports for Transaction Surfaces 2 ADJACENT TRANSACTION SURFACES SUPPORT USED AT JUNCTURE OF 2 TRANSACTION SURFACES AND 2 PANELS SUPPORT USED AT JUNCTURE OF TRANSACTION SURFACE AND ADJACENT HIGHER PANEL The support hardware required for a transaction surface (radiused-edge or squarededge) is ordered separately from the product. There are at least two pairs of supports required for each transaction surface—one pair for each end. Some common transaction surface/panel combinations and uses of support hardware are shown here: • • • • a support used at the end of both the panel and the transaction surface a support used at the end of a transaction surface at a 90° corner in the panel run a support used at the juncture of two adjacent transaction surfaces and two panels a support used at the juncture of a transaction surface and a higher adjacent panel Because the support brackets for the transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with other typical hanging components. For example, it is possible to place a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 261 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Transaction Surface Support AO460. Center AO461. End AO463. Mid-End Description This bracket supports transaction surfaces. The center bracket supports two transaction surfaces placed above Action Office Series 1 or 2 panels in a straight-line arrangement. The end bracket supports the end of a transaction surface placed above the last Series 1 panel in a run; it must be used with a hingeable finished end and cannot be used with a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector; spacer; or Series 2 panel. The mid-end bracket supports the end of a transaction surface placed above a two-, three-, or four-way 90° connector or draw rod; it can be used with Series 1 or 2 panels. SINGLE TRANSACTION SURFACE 2 ADJACENT TRANSACTION SURFACES Dimensions Center bracket is 10 1/8" wide and 1 3/4" high. End bracket is 10 1/8" wide and 2 1/2" high. Mid-end bracket is 10 1/8" wide and 1 3/4" high. CENTER BRACKET SUPPORT—USE AT JUNCTURE OF 2 TRANSACTION SURFACES AND 2 PANELS CENTER BRACKET SUPPORT—USE AT JUNCTURE OF 2 PANELS Planning Considerations The center bracket is used at the juncture of two transaction surfaces and two panels in a straight line or a single transaction surface spanning the juncture of two panels. The end bracket is used only with an Action Office Series 1 panel and always at the end of a panel run. The mid-end bracket supports the open ends of a transaction surface that is above a 90° connector and is neither adjacent to another transaction surface nor over an end cap (i.e., never at the end of a panel or a straight-line panel run). L END SUPPORT BRACKET—USE AT END OF SERIES 1 PANEL RUN AND TRANSACTION SURFACE (CANNOT BE USED WITH 2-, 3-, OR 4-WAY CONNECTOR OR SPACER OR SERIES 2 PANEL) MID-END BRACKET SUPPORT—USE AT END OF TRANSACTION SURFACE AT 90Å CORNER Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 262 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). Options When the end transaction surface support is used, order the Finished End, Hingeable (AO258.), separately. Limitations A center bracket precludes the attachment of a transaction surface task light at that point; the task light must be attached elsewhere along the underside of the transaction surface. L TRANSACTION SURFACE LIGHT ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF TRANSACTION SURFACE AT ANY POINT WITHIN PANEL WIDTH...EXCEPT AT CENTER SUPPORT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 263 Work Surfaces Transaction Surfaces Transaction Surface Support, Change of Height AO464. Description This bracket supports the end of a transaction surface placed next to a higher Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel. Dimensions Change-of-height bracket is 10 1/8" wide and 1 3/4" high. Planning Considerations The change-of-height bracket can be used on one or both sides of a transaction surface, depending on how many sides are adjacent to higher panels. The exposed edge of each higher panel requires a change-ofheight finished end. Because the support brackets for transaction surfaces are relatively short, they do not interfere with hanging components (for example, a tackboard in the space between the transaction surface and the work surface). Options For each change-of-height support bracket, order a Finished End, Change of Height, Panel/Panel (AO251.), separately. L CHANGE-OF-HEIGHT BRACKET SUPPORT— USE AT JUNCTURE OF TRANSACTION SURFACE AND ADJACENT HIGHER PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 264 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces SQUARED-EDGE TABLE RADIUSED-EDGE PRINTER SUPPORT TABLE RADIUSED-EDGE TABLE RADIUSED-EDGE MOBILE TABLE Action Office freestanding tables provide ancillary work surfaces to accommodate general-purpose tasks, isolated surfaces for using electronic equipment, and surfaces for locating mobile equipment conveniently. They include a squared-edge and radiused-edge rectangular work table, a radiused-edge printer support table, and a radiused-edge mobile table. For additional freestanding work surfaces, see the Arrio freestanding systems furniture planning information. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 265 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Squared-Edge Table A4110. 25 1/2" High A4111. 29" High Description This table has a modesty panel and adjustable glides. It is predrilled for a pencil drawer. Shipped knocked down. The table has a laminate top and vinyl edge or a veneer top and edge. Dimensions The 25 1/2"-high version is available in these sizes: • 24" deep by 36" wide • 24" deep by 48" wide • 30" deep by 48" wide The 29"-high version is available in these sizes: • 24" deep by 36" wide • 24" deep by 48" wide • 24" deep by 60" wide • 24" deep by 72" wide • 30" deep by 48" wide • 30" deep by 60" wide • 30" deep by 72" wide Planning Considerations The table has adjustable glides that provide 1/2" of height adjustment. Because the spanner bar connecting the table legs is inset from the back of the table, all tables have a limited drawer depth clearance: 14 1/2" on the 24"deep table and 17 3/4" on the 30"-deep table. Because of the table legs, all tables have a limited width clearance: 30 3/4" on the 36"-wide table, 42 3/4" on the 48"-wide table, 54 3/4" on the 60"-wide table, and 66 3/4" on the 72"-wide table. 30" 24" 14 ⁄«™" DRAWER DEPTH CLEARANCE (24"-DEEP FREESTANDING TABLE) 17 ‹«¢" DRAWER DEPTH CLEARANCE (30"-DEEP FREESTANDING TABLE) The limited depth and width clearance on narrower tables restricts the storage and machine support options that can be attached to the underside of this table. (See “Limitations.”) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 266 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Options Order optional drawers (for 30"-deep tables only) separately: • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock, 5 1/2" High (AO481.) • Drawer with Lock, 11 1/2" High (AO482.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) Order optional machine support products for the 30"-deep table separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.)—with shorttrack option • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel (G7720.)—with short-track option • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.)—with standard-length arm or extended-length arm with shorttrack option • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached (G7740.) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. and G7742.)—with shorttrack option Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Except for some optional pencil drawers, individual box drawers, and the twodrawer storage unit, suspended storage pedestals cannot be attached under a 30"-deep table. No storage components can be attached under a 24"-deep table. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 267 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Table AO710. 25 1/2" High AO712. 29" High Description This table has a modesty panel, two cable access holes, and adjustable glides. It is predrilled for drawers. Shipped knocked down. The table has a laminate or veneer top and vinyl edge. Dimensions The 25 1/2"-high version is available in these sizes: • 24" deep by 36" wide • 24" deep by 48" wide • 24" deep by 60" wide • 30" deep by 48" wide • 30" deep by 60" wide The 29"-high version is available in these sizes: • 24" deep by 36" wide • 24" deep by 48" wide • 24" deep by 60" wide • 24" deep by 72" wide • 30" deep by 48" wide • 30" deep by 60" wide • 30" deep by 72" wide Planning Considerations The table has adjustable glides that provide 1/2" of height adjustment. Because the spanner bar connecting the table legs is inset from the back of the table, all tables have a limited drawer depth clearance: 14 1/2" on the 24"deep table and 17 3/4" on the 30"-deep table. Because of the table legs, all tables have a limited width clearance: 30 3/4" on the 36"-wide table, 42 3/4" on the 48"-wide table, 54 3/4" on the 60"-wide table, and 66 3/4" on the 72"-wide table. 30" 24" 14 ⁄«™" DRAWER DEPTH CLEARANCE (24"-DEEP FREESTANDING TABLE) 17 ‹«¢" DRAWER DEPTH CLEARANCE (30"-DEEP FREESTANDING TABLE) The limited depth clearance and limited width clearance on narrower tables restrict the storage and keyboard support options that can be attached to the underside of this table. (See “Limitations.”) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 268 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Options Order optional drawers (for 30"-deep tables only) separately: • Pencil Drawer (G5010.) • Pencil Drawer, Metal (G5012.) • A-Style Pencil Drawer (AO480.) • Drawer with Lock, 5 1/2" High (AO481.) • Drawer with Lock, 11 1/2" High (AO482.) • A-Style Storage Unit with Lock (AO483.) Order optional machine support products for the 30"-deep table separately: • Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable (G7719.)—with shorttrack option • Keyboard Platform, Extended DualSwivel (G7720.)—with short-track option • Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable (G7715.)—with standard-length arm or extended-length arm with shorttrack option • Keyboard Tray, Adjustable (G7716.) • Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached (G7740.) • Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached (G7741. or G7742.)—with short-track option Order optional work surface accessories separately: • Armature (G7510.) • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitations Except for some optional pencil drawers, individual box drawers, and the twodrawer storage unit, suspended storage pedestals cannot be attached under the 30"-deep table. No storage components can be attached under a 24"-deep table. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 269 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Printer Support Table AO713. Description This 24"-deep, 30"-wide mobile table holds a printer. It has a laminate top and vinyl edge, a paper feed slot, a cable access hole, two paper feed/collection drawers, and black casters. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Height is 29". Depth is 24". Width is 30 1/2". Planning Considerations The slot to feed printer paper will accommodate paper of any standard dimension. The slot measures 11" wide by 3" deep. The paper collection drawer extends 7 1/8" beyond the edge of the table. In planning for either the placement or the storage of this table, allow for the additional clearance. SLOT FOR FEEDING STANDARD-SIZE PRINTER PAPER FOR PAPER COLLECTION The table’s 29" height makes it compatible with hanging work surfaces at standard sit-down height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 270 Work Surfaces Freestanding Work Surfaces Radiused-Edge Mobile Table AO714. Description This 20"-deep, 20"-wide table has black casters. Shipped knocked down. The table has a laminate or veneer top and vinyl edge. Dimensions Height is 25 1/2". Depth is 20". Width is 20". Planning Considerations The table’s 25 1/2" height makes it compatible with hanging work surfaces at machine height. The height is also ergonomically sound for working with computers, typewriters, and other electronic office equipment. A mobile table can help accommodate workers with reach and turning limitations. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 271 Storage Introduction Storage Introduction The Action Office Series 2 system offers a variety of storage components—wallattached, work surface-attached, and freestanding—to meet user needs for long-term, intermediate, and active storage. Most of the storage products come in modular dimensions compatible with Action Office Series 2 panels. In addition, Liaison work cabinets can be used with the Series 2 system to provide not only storage, but also structural support and energy distribution and access. (See the separate Liaison cabinet system planning information for details about planning with Liaison work cabinets.) Wall-attached storage is available in three styles: The A-style components have rounded corners on the front facings; the B-style components have rolled front edges on the front facings; and the E-style storage has straight edges. All three styles can be ordered for Action Office panels as well as Ethospace frames; however, they are not interchangeable. Work surface-attached and freestanding products are also available in a variety of styles: A- and G-Series work surface-attached pedestals, with a choice of three different fronts for each series; and freestanding pedestals and lateral files with a choice of three fronts on the A-Series and two fronts on the G-Series. This wide range of styles, fronts, and drawer pull options for storage components is shared by Herman Miller Action Office and Ethospace systems, as well as a number of its furniture lines. Thus, users can achieve a facility-wide compatibility, yet retain the freedom to select the Herman Miller product line that meets the needs of a particular area or group of users. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 273 Storage Introduction Ergonomic Considerations for Wall-Attached and Work Surface-Attached Storage Herman Miller components meet workers’ needs for storage that is easy to reach and conveniently placed for efficient work flow. Because the slots on the panels are in 1" increments, wall-hung storage can be placed at exactly the height needed for easy reach. In addition, Herman Miller offers storage with open fronts for complete accessibility or enclosed storage with easily opened fronts and easy-to-grasp hardware, especially helpful for workers with limited hand dexterity. Storage can also be moved from one panel to another to accommodate changes in work flow or work habits. Suspended storage can be placed to the left or right of a work area to accommodate worker preferences or needs, as can freestanding storage. Where access is required for a wheelchair, suspended storage can be eliminated altogether to decrease the obstacles to moving around in the workstation. Note: This planning guide includes comments and suggestions about how certain products may enable customers to comply with the letter and spirit of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) of 1990. While these are generally useful as guidelines, they are not all-inclusive of ADA solutions. Accommodating a worker with disabilities may require additional adaptations and applications based on the individual’s particular needs. It is recommended that, in each case, the designer work with the individual to ensure complete accommodation of those needs within the specific work process. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 274 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Wall-Attached Storage ROUNDED CORNERS A-STYLE WALL-ATTACHED STORAGE ROLLED EDGES B-STYLE WALL-ATTACHED STORAGE STRAIGHT EDGES E-STYLE WALL-ATTACHED STORAGE Wall-attached storage components include enclosed flipper door units, lateral files, and open and display shelves. Additional storage items include a coat bar and shelf, a coat hook, and a number of work organizers and dividers. Most wall-attached storage components are available in 24", 30", 36", and 48" widths; 60"-wide A- and B-style shelves and flipper door units—as well as 42"-wide B- and E-style storage components—are also available. The widths of the storage components are compatible with corresponding-width panels or combinations of adjacent panels whose total width matches that of the storage component. For example, a 48"-wide component can be attached to either a 48"-wide panel or two adjacent 24"-wide panels. All components attach to the front of the panels and are adjustable vertically in 1" increments. For limitations on the number of components that can be attached to a wall run, see “Determining Proper Support.” L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 275 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Storage Component Styles Wall-attached storage components are available in three styles: A-style, B-style, and E-style. The three styles can be ordered for both Action Office and Ethospace systems; however, they are not interchangeable. While the E-style components were originally designed specifically for the Ethospace system, a special attachment bracket allows E-style storage units originally purchased to hang on Ethospace frames (and shipped after February 28, 1994) to mount on Action Office panels. Likewise, a similar bracket allows A- and B-style components for Action Office panels (shipped after February 28,1994) to be mounted on Ethospace frames. Keying and Lock Options Wall-attached components can be keyed alike with other lockable components; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 276 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Filing Capacity Provided by Wall-Attached Lateral Files This chart shows total filing inches for wall-attached lateral files. Side-to-side dimensions apply to letter- and A4-size documents. Inside height clearance is 11 1/4". 24" WIDE 30" WIDE 36" WIDE 42" WIDE 48" WIDE SIDE-TO-SIDE FILING LETTER AND A4-SIZE DOCUMENTS 39" 33" 27" 21" 45" 12 ⁄«¢" FRONT-TO BACK FILING LETTER-SIZE DOCUMENTS 6" 8" 5" 12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY = 20 ⁄«¢" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 30 ⁄«™" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 36 ‹«¢" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) FRONT-TO-BACK FILING A4-SIZE DOCUMENTS (IN 24CM FOLDERS) LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 7" 5" LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 11" TOTAL CAPACITY = 41 ‹«¢" (3 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 2 ‹«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY = 19 ⁄«¢" A4-SIZE CAPACITY = 12 ⁄«¢" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 7" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 29 ⁄«™" A4-SIZE CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 5" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 35 ⁄«™" A4-SIZE CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 11" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 39 ⁄«™" A4-SIZE CAPACITY = 36 ‹«¢" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 2 ‹«¢" (3 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) FRONT-TO-BACK FILING LEGAL-SIZE FILING LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 4 ‹«¢" LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 10 ‹«¢" LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER LETTER-SIZE FOR REMAINDER 5" 12 ⁄«™" 12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY = 17" LEGAL-SIZE CAPACITY = 12 ⁄«™" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 4 ‹«¢" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) L TOTAL CAPACITY = 23" LEGAL-SIZE CAPACITY = 12 ⁄«¢" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 10 ‹«¢" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" (1 CONVERTER REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 29 ⁄«™" LEGAL-SIZE CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 5" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) TOTAL CAPACITY = 37" LEGAL-SIZE CAPACITY = 24 ⁄«™" LETTER-SIZE CAPACITY = 12 ⁄«™" (2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED) Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 277 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Storage A-style storage components, originally designed for the Action Office Series 1 system, have rounded corners on the front facings of doors and drawers. They can be ordered for Action Office and Ethospace systems. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 278 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Suspended Lateral File AO510. Laminate Front AO511. Veneer Front Description This lockable file hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips to hold letter-, legal-, or A4-size hanging files. Attachment hardware is included. The file has a laminate or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", and 48" widths. Height is 12 1/2". Depth is 15 1/2". Planning Considerations To convert from side-to-side filing to multiple rows of front-to-back hanging files requires a separate converter for suspended lateral files. HUNG FROM PANEL OR FRAME CAN BE USED SINGLY… The drawer opens to 29 3/4" in the fully extended position. …OR STACKED When mounting one lateral file above another, a 2" clearance between the files is required. The A-style suspended lateral file requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or wall strips. Options Order the File Converter, Suspended Lateral File (G5925.), separately. HUNG ON WALL STRIPS 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 LATERAL FILE ABOVE ANOTHER Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this lateral file to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 279 Storage Wall-Attached Storage File Converter, Suspended Lateral File G5925. Description This bracket converts an A-, B-, or Estyle suspended lateral file drawer to hold front-to-back hanging files. Finish is black umber. Package contains four. Dimensions Depth is 12 3/8". Height is 1 7/8". Planning Considerations One size fits all Action Office and Ethospace suspended lateral file drawers (A, B, and E styles in all sizes). ALLOWS FRONT-TO-BACK FILING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 280 Storage Wall-Attached Storage File Drawer Organizer B4961. Description This two-sectioned organizer fits into any file drawer arranged for letter-size filing. The removable top section stores computer disks and other small items. The bottom section stores larger items or can be divided into three compartments; it includes two vertical dividers. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Width is 6". Height of outer tray is 9"; height of inner tray is 3", or 3 5/8" with the handle. Overall height of two pieces nested is 9 5/8". Outside depth of outer tray is 12 3/4"; inside depth is 11 3/8". Outside depth of inner tray is 13"; inside depth is 11 1/16". Planning Considerations The inner and outer trays can be used separately or together; with its handle, the inner tray serves as a tote for small desk items. Files can be hung front to back from the sides of the tray. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 281 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Flipper Door Unit AO560. Fabric Description This storage unit hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips and combines a flipper door and a shelf to enclose binders, files, and other items. It has a fabric front. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16"; actual depths are 12 1/2" and 15 1/2". Height is 15 1/2". Planning Considerations When mounting one flipper door unit above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. To provide completely enclosed storage when a flipper door unit hangs on an open panel frame or on a glazed panel, a flipper door back panel is required. For most other applications, however, the panel surface behind the flipper door unit provides adequate enclosure. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER If reach and access concerns are most important, order a shelf instead of this covered unit. Where a flipper door has already been installed, it is possible to remove the flipper door top and front closure and use it elsewhere. A separate add-on shelf can provide additional shelf space for a 24"- or 48"wide flipper door unit, in the 16" depth only. The 60"-wide flipper door unit requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower flipper door units can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the flipper door unit. L UNIT INCLUDES DOOR AND SHELF WITH END PANELS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 282 Storage Wall-Attached Storage The A-style flipper door unit requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) • Add-On Shelf (AO521.)—for 16"-deep flipper door unit only • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this flipper door unit to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 283 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Flipper Door AO550. Fabric Description This flipper door attaches to a 15 1/2"high shelf to provide top and front closure. It has a fabric front and includes attachment hardware. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16"; actual depths are 12 1/2" and 15 1/2". Nominal height is 15 1/2"; actual height is 15 3/8". Planning Considerations The flipper door requires attachment to a separate A-style, 15 1/2"-high shelf. When mounting one shelf with flipper door above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. To provide completely enclosed storage when a flipper door unit hangs on an open panel frame or on a glazed panel, a flipper door back panel is required. For most other applications, however, the panel surface behind the flipper door unit provides adequate enclosure. Options Order the optional Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) separately. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER DOOR FLIPS DOWN FOR COVERED STORAGE— STORES ON TOP Limitations The 15 1/2" depth is not available in the 36" width. MOUNTS ATOP 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 284 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Flipper Door Security Kit AO571. Description This kit attaches to a shelf to enclose the locking mechanism on an A-style flipper door for added security. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Height is 3 1/4". Width is 2 1/4". Depth is 1". Planning Considerations This kit does not interfere with mounting a task light beneath the flipper door unit or affect the 2" clearance required when one flipper door unit is mounted above another. No additional key is required; the existing flipper door lock goes into the security kit. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 285 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Flipper Door Back Panel A3390. Description This panel attaches to the back of an Aor B-style flipper door unit or a flipper door with shelf to enclose the back. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Available in nominal 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths to fit most flipper door units. Actual height is 13 7/8". Planning Considerations The back panel provides visual enclosure when flipper door units or shelves with flipper doors are hung on open panel frames and glazed panels. The back panel can be used with a 15 1/2"-high, A- or B-style shelf with an A- or B-style flipper door attached or with an A- or B-style flipper door unit. BACK PANEL CONCEALS STORED MATERIALS WHEN FLIPPER DOOR UNIT HANGS ON GLAZED PANEL OR OPEN PANEL FRAME Limitations There is no corresponding-size back panel for the 60"-wide shelf, flipper door, and flipper door unit. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 286 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Shelf AO520. 15 1/2" High AO523. 7 1/2" High Description This shelf hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The 7 1/2"-high shelf is for storage or display; the 15 1/2"-high shelf stores binders and books. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16". Actual depths of the shelves are 12" and 14 7/8". Actual depths of shelf end panels are 12 1/2" and 15 1/2". The effective usable storage depth of the shelf is 1/2" to 1" greater, since the shelf stops short of the panel or frame, wall, or back panel. Available in 15 1/2" and 7 1/2" heights. Planning Considerations For visible filing of EDP-size paper or for extra depth, order the 16"-deep, 15 1/2"high unit. For enclosed storage (on the 15 1/2"high shelf only), use the A-style flipper door for top and front enclosure and the A-style flipper door back panel for back enclosure on open panel frames and glazed panels. ADD FLIPPER DOOR AND BACK PANEL FOR ENCLOSED STORAGE (15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF ONLY) 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF DEPTH OF SHELF ONLY—12" FOR 13"-DEEP SHELF OR 14 ‡«•" FOR 16"-DEEP SHELF EFFECTIVE USABLE STORAGE DEPTH ⁄«™" TO 1" ADDITIONAL; SHELF STOPS SHORT AT BACK A separate add-on shelf can provide additional shelf space for a 24"- or 48"wide shelf (15 1/2"-high, 16"-deep version only). The 60"-wide shelf requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower shelves can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. The A-style shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 287 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • A-Style Flipper Door (AO550.) • Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) • Add-On Shelf (AO521.)—for 16"-deep shelf only • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) 7⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF STORAGE DEPTH 12" Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Limitations There is no 36" width in the 16"-deep shelf. The 16"-deep shelf is not available in a 7 1/2" height. L CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 288 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Add-On Shelf AO521. Description This shelf fits into a 15 1/2"-deep A-style shelf or 16"-deep B-style shelf to add a second shelf. Dimensions Available in 24" and 48" widths. Height is 1". Depth is 14 7/8". Planning Considerations Use the add-on shelf with the 24"- or 48"-wide, 16"-deep shelf. The add-on shelf provides the same storage depth as the unit’s original shelf. Limitations The add-on shelf is not available to fit 30"-, 36"-, 42"-, or 60"-wide shelves. The add-on shelf cannot be used with any 7 1/2"-high shelves or 15 1/2"-high, 13"-deep shelves. L FOR ADDITIONAL SHELF STORAGE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 289 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Storage/Display Shelf AO522. Description This 13"-deep shelf hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips in a flat position for storage or in a slanted position for display. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 48", and 60" widths. Height is 7 1/2". Depth of shelf end panel is 12 1/2". Nominal depth of shelf is 13"; actual depth is 12 1/2". Planning Considerations The shelf position can be switched between storage and display on site. Task light attachment for a shelf used in the slanted position requires a separate display shelf adapter. The 60"-wide shelf requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower shelves can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. SHELF IN SLANTED POSITION SHELF IN HORIZONTAL POSITION Dividing the interior for a shelf in the flat position requires a separate shelf divider. The A-style shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Options Order the optional Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.), or the Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 290 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) • Display Shelf Adapter, Task Light (G6191.) Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Limitations The shelf can be divided only when the shelf is in the flat position. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 291 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Storage B-style storage components, originally designed for the Action Office Series 2 system, have rolled edges on the front facings of doors and drawers. They can be ordered for Action Office and Ethospace systems. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 292 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Suspended Lateral File A3121. Laminate Front A3122. Veneer Front Description This 16"-deep lockable file hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips to hold letter-, legal-, or A4-size hanging files. Attachment hardware is included. The file has a laminate or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. Height is 13 1/2". Depth is 15 7/8". Planning Considerations To convert from side-to-side filing to multiple rows of front-to-back hanging files requires a separate converter for suspended lateral files. HUNG FROM PANEL OR FRAME The drawer opens to 30 1/8" in the fully extended position. When mounting one lateral file above another, a 2" clearance between the files is required. The B-style suspended lateral file requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or wall strips. Options Order the File Converter, Suspended Lateral File (G5925.), separately. CAN BE USED SINGLY… …OR STACKED HUNG ON WALL STRIPS 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 LATERAL FILE ABOVE ANOTHER Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this lateral file to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 293 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Flipper Door Unit A3350. Veneer Door A3352. Fabric Door A3353. Painted Door Description This storage unit hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips and combines a flipper door and a 13"- or 16"-deep shelf to enclose binders, files, and other items. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The flipper door unit has a painted, fabric-covered, or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16"; actual depths are 12 3/4" and 15 3/4". Nominal height is 15 1/2"; actual height is 15 3/8". Planning Considerations When mounting one flipper door unit above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER To provide completely enclosed storage when a flipper door unit hangs on an open panel frame or on a glazed panel, a flipper door back panel (ordered separately) is required. For most other applications, however, the panel surface behind the flipper door unit provides adequate enclosure. If reach and access concerns are most important, order a shelf instead of this covered unit. Where a flipper door unit has already been installed, it is possible to remove the flipper door top and front closure and use it elsewhere. A separate add-on shelf can provide additional shelf space for a 24"- or 48"wide flipper door unit, in the 16" depth only. L UNIT INCLUDES DOOR AND SHELF WITH END PANELS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 294 Storage Wall-Attached Storage The 60"-wide flipper door unit requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower flipper door units can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the flipper door unit. The B-style flipper door unit requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) • Add-On Shelf (AO521.)—for 16"-deep flipper door unit only • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this flipper door unit to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 295 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Flipper Door A3310. Veneer Door A3312. Fabric Door A3313. Painted Door Description This flipper door attaches to a 15 1/2"high, 13"- or 16"-deep shelf to provide top and front closure. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The flipper door has a painted, fabriccovered, or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16"; actual depths are 12 3/4" and 15 3/4". Nominal height is 15 1/2"; actual height is 15 3/8". Planning Considerations The flipper door requires attachment to a separate B-style, 15 1/2"-high shelf. When mounting one shelf with flipper door above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. To provide completely enclosed storage when a flipper door hangs on an open panel frame or on a glazed panel, a flipper door back panel (ordered separately) is required. For most other applications, however, the panel surface behind the flipper door unit provides adequate enclosure. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER DOOR FLIPS DOWN FOR COVERED STORAGE— STORES ON TOP Options Order the optional Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) separately. MOUNTS ATOP 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 296 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Shelf A3210. 15 1/2" High A3221. 7 1/2" High Description This shelf hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The 7 1/2"-high shelf is for storage or display; the 15 1/2"-high shelf stores binders and books. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13" and 16"; actual depths of shelves are 12" and 14 7/8". Actual depths of shelf end panels are 12 3/4" and 15 3/4". The effective usable storage depth of the shelf is 1/2" to 1" greater than the shelf dimension, since the shelf stops short of the panel or frame, wall, or back panel. Available in 15 1/2" and 7 1/2" heights. Planning Considerations For visible filing of EDP-size paper or for extra depth, order the 16"-deep, 15 1/2"high unit. For enclosed storage (on the 15 1/2"high shelf only), use the B-style flipper door for top and front enclosure and the B-style flipper door back panel for back enclosure on open panel frames and glazed panels. ADD FLIPPER DOOR AND BACK PANEL FOR ENCLOSED STORAGE (15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF ONLY) 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF DEPTH OF SHELF ONLY—12" FOR 13"-DEEP SHELF OR 14 ‡«•" FOR 16"-DEEP SHELF EFFECTIVE USABLE STORAGE DEPTH ⁄«™" TO 1" ADDITIONAL; SHELF STOPS SHORT AT BACK A separate add-on shelf can provide additional shelf space for a 24"- or 48"wide shelf (15 1/2"-high, 16"-deep version only). The 60"-wide shelf requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower shelves can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… L …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 297 Storage Wall-Attached Storage The B-style shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • B-Style Flipper Door (A3310., A3312., or A3313.) • Flipper Door Back Panel (A3390.) • Add-On Shelf (AO521.)—for 16"-deep shelf only • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) 7 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF STORAGE DEPTH 12" Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Limitations The 16"-deep shelf is not available in a 7 1/2" height. L CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 298 Storage Wall-Attached Storage B-Style Storage/Display Shelf A3220. Description This 13"-deep shelf hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips in a flat position for storage or a slanted position for display. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. Height is 7 1/2". Actual depth of the shelf end panel is 12 3/4". Nominal depth of the shelf is 13"; actual depth is 12 1/2". Planning Considerations The shelf position can be switched between storage and display on site. Task light attachment for a shelf used in the slanted position requires a separate display shelf adapter. The 60"-wide shelf requires a 60"-wide task light. Narrower shelves can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. SHELF IN SLANTED POSITION SHELF IN HORIZONTAL POSITION Dividing the interior for a shelf in the flat position requires a separate shelf divider. The B-style shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Options Order the optional Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.), or the Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 299 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) • Display Shelf Adapter, Task Light (G6191.) Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. Limitations The shelf can be subdivided only when the shelf is in the flat position. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 300 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Storage E-style storage components, originally designed for the Ethospace system, have straight edges on the front facings of doors and drawers. They can be ordered for Action Office and Ethospace systems. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 301 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Suspended Lateral File A3021. Fabric Front A3022. Veneer Front Description This 16"-deep lockable file hangs from a frame, a panel, or wall strips to hold letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. Attachment hardware is included. The file has a fabric-covered or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", and 48" widths. Height is 13 1/2". HUNG FROM PANEL OR FRAME Depth is 15 7/8". Planning Considerations To convert from side-to-side filing to multiple rows of front-to-back hanging files requires a separate converter for suspended lateral files. The drawer opens to 30 1/8" in the fully extended position. When mounting one lateral file above another, a 2" clearance between the files is required. The E-style suspended lateral file requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. CAN BE USED SINGLY… …OR STACKED HUNG ON WALL STRIPS 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 LATERAL FILE ABOVE ANOTHER Options Order the File Converter, Suspended Lateral File (G5925.), separately. Order the Attachment Bracket, E-Style Components (A3930.), separately to convert this lateral file to hang on an Action Office panel or wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 302 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Flipper Door Unit A3050. Veneer Door A9001. Fabric Door Description This lockable storage unit hangs from a frame, a panel, or wall strips and combines a flipper door and a 14"- or 16 1/2"-deep shelf to enclose binders, files, and other items. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The flipper door unit has a fabriccovered or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. Available in nominal depths of 14" and 16 1/2"; actual depths are 14 1/8" and 16 5/8". Height is 15 1/2". Planning Considerations When mounting one flipper door unit above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER If reach and access concerns are most important, order a shelf instead of this covered unit. Where a flipper door unit has already been installed, it is possible to remove the flipper door top and front closure and use it elsewhere. Flipper door units can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the flipper door unit. E-style flipper door units include a component brace with each unit, which accommodates all loads that fall within approved guidelines—even heavy component loading. The E-style flipper door unit requires an attachment bracket, ordered separately, to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. L UNIT INCLUDES DOOR AND SHELF WITH END PANELS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 303 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) Order the Attachment Bracket, E-Style Components (A3930.), separately to convert this flipper door unit to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 304 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Flipper Door A3010. Veneer Door A9002. Fabric Door Description This lockable door attaches to a 15 1/2"high, 14"- or 16 1/2"-deep shelf to provide top and front closure. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The flipper door has a fabric-covered or veneer front. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. 2" 2" CLEARANCE REQUIRED WHEN MOUNTING 1 FLIPPER DOOR ABOVE ANOTHER Available in nominal depths of 14" and 16 1/2"; actual depths are 14 1/8" and 16 5/8". Height is 15 1/2". Planning Considerations The flipper door requires attachment to a separate E-style, 15 1/2"-high shelf. DOOR FLIPS DOWN FOR COVERED STORAGE— STORES ON TOP When mounting one shelf with flipper door above another, a 2" clearance is required between them to allow the doors to open. Because there is no separate back panel available for the E-style shelf, it is possible to provide only front and top enclosure. L MOUNTS ATOP 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 305 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Shelf A3030. 15 1/2" High A3040. 7 1/2" High Description This shelf hangs from a frame, panel, or wall strips. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The 7 1/2"-high shelf is for storage or display; the 15 1/2"-high shelf stores binders and books. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", and 48" widths. Available in nominal depths of 13 1/2" and 16"; actual depths of shelves are 12" and 14 7/8". Actual depths of shelf end panels are 13 1/4" and 15 1/4". The effective usable storage depth of the shelf is 1/2" to 1" greater, since the shelf stops short of the panel or wall. Available in 15 1/2" and 7 1/2" heights. Planning Considerations For visible filing of EDP-size paper or for extra depth, order the 16"-deep, 15 1/2"high unit. For enclosed storage (on the 15 1/2"high shelf only), use the E-style flipper door for top and front enclosure. When hung on a frame with a tile or when converted to hang on a solid panel, the wall surface behind the flipper door provides adequate enclosure. Because there is no separate back panel for the E-style shelf, it is not recommended for use on glazed or open frame panels when converted. ADD FLIPPER DOOR FRONT AND TOP CLOSURE (15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF ONLY) 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF DEPTH OF SHELF ONLY—12" FOR 13"-DEEP SHELF OR 14 ‡«•" FOR 16"-DEEP SHELF EFFECTIVE USABLE STORAGE DEPTH ⁄«™" TO 1" ADDITIONAL; SHELF STOPS SHORT AT BACK This shelf can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. E-style shelves include a component brace with each unit, which accommodates all loads that fall within approved guidelines—even heavy component loading. L CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 306 Storage Wall-Attached Storage The E-style shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. Options Order these optional storage accessories separately: • E-Style Flipper Door (A9002. or A3010.) • Shelf Divider, Angled (G7330.) • Shelf Divider, Rectangular (NP374.) • Shelf Organizer (AO530.) • Paper Organizer (AO533.) Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) 7 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF STORAGE DEPTH 12" Order the Attachment Bracket, E-Style Components (A3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. Limitations Because there is no separate back panel available to close off the back of this shelf, this shelf is not suitable for mounting on an open panel frame or a glazed panel when converted. CAN BE HUNG ON PANELS OR FRAMES… …OR ON WALLS WITH WALL STRIPS The 16"-deep shelf is not available in a 7 1/2" height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 307 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Display Shelf A3045. Description This 13"-deep slanted shelf hangs from a frame, a panel, or wall strips to provide display space. The underside of the shelf accepts a task light. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", and 48" widths. Height is 7 1/2". Depth of shelf end panel is 13 1/4". Nominal depth of shelf is 13"; actual depth is 13 1/4". Planning Considerations This shelf can be used in a slanted display position only. The shelf can accept a task light the same width as or shorter than the shelf. No adapter is required to attach the task light to the underside of the display shelf. The E-style display shelf requires a separate attachment bracket to hang on an Action Office panel or wall strips. SHELF SITS IN SLANTED POSITION ONLY Options Order optional lighting components separately: • Task Light, Basic (G6130.) • Task Light, Standard (G6150.) • Task Light, Energy Efficient (G6120.) • Lumisoft Task Light (G6140.) • Pavo Portable Task Light (G6420.) Order the optional Attachment Bracket, E-Style Components (A3930.), separately to convert this shelf to hang on an Action Office panel or Action Office wall strips. Limitations This display shelf cannot be converted to a flat position for storage. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 308 Storage Wall-Attached Storage E-Style Attachment Bracket A3930. Description These brackets convert Ethospace Estyle suspended lateral files, flipper door units, or shelves to hang on Action Office panels or wall strips. The brackets mount on the ends of Ethospace components. Each component requires two brackets for mounting. Package contains six pair. Dimensions Available in 4 3/4", 9 7/8", and 10 1/2" heights. Planning Considerations Each component requires two brackets for mounting. REQUIRES 2 BRACKETS FOR MOUNTING Select the bracket according to the component to be attached. Limitation This bracket can be used only on E-style storage products shipped after February 1994. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 309 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Storage Accessories A number of accessories—most of them able to be used with A-, B-, or E-style storage—add more organizing capabilities to Action Office Series 2 storage components or provide added support for heavily loaded storage components. Other accessories allow for coat and personal-item storage on Series 2 panels. Component Brace A3910. Description This bracket mounts under A- or B-style lateral files, flipper door units, or shelves hung from a tackable acoustical-barrier panel to support heavy component loading and reduce deflection of a panel run. Package contains six. Dimensions Width is 1 3/4". Height is 1 1/2". Depth is 7/8". Planning Considerations For applications requiring the component brace, see “Need for Additional Support” in the “Determining Proper Support” section. Because each E-style storage component includes a component brace, which accommodates all loads that meet approved guidelines, a separate component brace is not needed for Estyle storage components. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 310 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Shelf Divider, Angled G7330. Description This divider attaches to an Action Office or Ethospace shelf to vertically divide books and binders. Package contains eight. Dimensions Depth is 9 1/2". Width of shelf clip is 3". Height is 5 5/8". Planning Considerations The divider can be placed at any point along the width of a shelf and moved as needed. At 9 1/2" deep, the divider does not extend the full depth of the shelf. L CAN BE ATTACHED TO SHELF AT ANY POINT ALONG FRONT EDGE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 311 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Shelf Divider, Rectangular NP374. Description This divider attaches to an Action Office or Ethospace shelf to vertically divide books and binders. Package contains eight. Dimensions Depth is 11". Width of shelf clip is 3 1/8". Height is 5 1/2". Planning Considerations The divider can be placed at any point along the width of a shelf—and moved as needed. At 11" deep, the divider does not extend the full depth of the shelf. L CAN BE ATTACHED TO SHELF AT ANY POINT ALONG FRONT EDGE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 312 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Shelf Organizer AO530. Description This freestanding organizer sits on a shelf or in a flipper door unit. It has three adjustable shelves and three label holders for each shelf. Dimensions Width is 22 1/2". Height is 12 1/8". Depth is 12". Planning Considerations The shelf organizer unit can be placed at any point along the width of a shelf or flipper door unit to provide vertical division of the space. Shelves within the organizer can be spaced at vertical increments of 1 3/4". CAN BE PLACED ANYWHERE ON SHELF ORGANIZER SHELVES CAN BE SPACED AT 1 ‹«¢" VERTICAL INCREMENTS Options Order the Shelf Organizer Shelf (AO531.) and the Shelf Organizer Divider (AO532.) separately. DIVIDES HORIZONTAL EXPANSE OF SHELF SPACE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 313 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Shelf Organizer Shelf AO531. Description This adjustable shelf is placed in a shelf organizer. Package contains six. Dimensions Width is 22 1/4". Height is 1/2". Depth is 11". Planning Considerations These shelves can be used in addition to the three that are included with the shelf organizer. The shelves can be spaced at vertical increments of 1 3/4" within the organizer. ADDITIONAL SHELVES AS NEEDED FOR SHELF ORGANIZER Options Order the Shelf Organizer Divider (AO532.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 314 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Shelf Organizer Divider AO532. Description This divider snaps onto a shelf organizer shelf to vertically divide the shelf. Package contains six. Dimensions Available in 2 1/4" and 6" heights. Depth is 11". Width is 2 3/4". Planning Considerations The divider can be placed at any point along the width of a shelf in the shelf organizer and moved as needed. Because the clip that attaches the divider to the shelf is sized to fit over a shelf organizer shelf, these dividers cannot be attached directly to the thicker A-, B-, or E-style shelf. L DIVIDES HORIZONTAL EXPANSE OF SHELF SPACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 315 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Paper Organizer AO533. Description This freestanding organizer sits on a work surface or shelf for vertical or horizontal storage. Finish is dark tone. Package contains eight trays and twelve connectors. Dimensions Width is 12 7/8". Height is 2". Depth is 10 3/8". Planning Considerations To stabilize paper organizers stacked horizontally or vertically requires paper organizer connectors. Each connection between organizers requires one connector at each side of the organizers. CAN BE USED VERTICALLY OR HORIZONTALLY ON SHELVES OR WORK SURFACES Options For additional or replacement connectors, order the optional Paper Organizer Connector (AO534.) separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 316 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Paper Organizer Connector AO534. Description This connector joins two paper organizer trays for additional stacking. Finish is dark tone. Package contains 24. Dimensions Width is 10 1/4". Height is 2". Planning Considerations The connectors—used in pairs for each connection—are used on each side of the trays to keep the organizers stabilized and in place when stacked vertically or horizontally. ALLOWS FOR STACKING OF MULTIPLE PAPER ORGANIZERS L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 317 Storage Wall-Attached Storage A-Style Coat Bar and Shelf AO524. Description This 17 1/2"-deep, 48"-wide unit hangs from a panel, a frame, or wall strips. It has a shelf for storage and a coat bar beneath the shelf. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Width is 48". Height is 15 1/2". Depth is 17 1/2". Planning Considerations This coat bar and shelf requires an attachment bracket, ordered separately, to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. FOR STORAGE OF PERSONAL ITEMS AND COATS Options Order the Attachment Bracket, B-Style Components (E3930.), separately to convert this coat bar and shelf to hang on an Ethospace frame or Ethospace wall strips. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 318 Storage Wall-Attached Storage Coat Hook AO535. Description This hook fits over the top of an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel for hanging coats, hats, and umbrellas. Finish is medium tone. Package contains six. Dimensions Width is 1". Height is 3 1/4". FITS OVER TOP OF PANEL Depth is 4"; actual extension from face of panel is 1 3/8". Planning Considerations The coat hook can be attached at any point along the width of the panel top. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 319 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Work SurfaceAttached Storage A variety of storage products can be hung from the undersides of Action Office work surfaces. Storage ranges from a single small drawer for pencils and other items to pedestals of multiple drawers in a number of configurations; there are also a number of organizers that fit inside the drawers to further subdivide them. Work surface-attached drawer pedestals are available in A-Series and G-Series products. While the most distinctive difference between the two series is in their drawer fronts, A-Series pedestals offer a configuration with a 3"-high pencil drawer, in addition to box and file drawers. There are several additional, miscellaneous storage components that can be attached beneath Series 2 work surfaces and peninsulas: three pencil drawers (two styles in plastic) to hold and organize pencils and other small items, two sizes of single plastic drawers, and a storage unit containing those drawers. These storage products can be fitted with a stationery divider or a divider package to subdivide the drawers and organize their contents. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 320 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Planning Considerations for Work Surface-Attached Storage All drawers and suspended drawer pedestals are screwed to the underside of the work surface using predrilled holes; except where supports prohibit, drawers and drawer units can be positioned at the center, the left, or the right of a work surface. To determine the horizontal clearance available for attaching drawers to work surfaces, subtract 3" from the width of each panel with attached supports; this accounts for the room required for cantilevered supports. For example, 3" is required to accommodate the supports on a 36"-wide panel, leaving 33" of clearance for drawers. For a 72"-wide work surface suspended on two 36"-wide panels, 3" is deducted from between each pair of support arms, leaving 66" of clearance (33" on each side of the support arms). TO DETERMINE CLEARANCE FOR ATTACHING DRAWERS OR DRAWER PEDESTALS— EXTRA SUPPORTS ON 60"- AND 72"-WIDE WORK SURFACES SUBTRACT 3" FROM PANEL WIDTH SUBTRACT 3" FROM PANEL WIDTH BETWEEN EACH PAIR OF WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS (6" TOTAL) Filing Capacity Provided by Work Surface-Attached Pedestals The chart shows the total filing inches for pedestal file drawers in A- and G-Series work surface-attached storage pedestals. The inside height clearance of the pedestal file drawer is 10 3/4"; interior height of the drawer side is 9 1/2". SIDE-TO-SIDE LEGAL SIDE-TO-SIDE A4 WITH LETTER SIDE-TO-SIDE LETTER 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 20" DEPTH (G- OR ASERIES) 3 ⁄«™" 16 ⁄«™" TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" L 1 ⁄«™" FRONT-TO-BACK LETTER ONLY TOTAL CAPACITY=13 ‹«¢" (A4=24 CM FOLDERS) A4 CAPACITY=12 ⁄«¢" LETTER CAPACITY=1 ⁄«™" TOTAL CAPACITY =15 ‹«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY =16 ⁄«™" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 321 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Series Storage All A-Series pedestals are designed to be compatible with Ethospace; Action Office Series 1, 2, and 3; and Liaison systems. They can also be used with Newhouse Group® and Relay® furniture. A-Series storage also blends with Arrio freestanding systems furniture. Front Styles A-Series pedestals offer three different drawer fronts: • The F-front option has centered, recessed oval pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. This recessed pull minimizes the protrusion usually associated with handles and causes minimal obstruction in tight places. Specifying the recessed pull upside down helps accommodate users with limited hand mobility, and specifying the recessed pull in a contrasting color aids workers with visual impairment. • The H-front option has applied arc pulls that can be grasped easily by workers with limited hand mobility; because of its relatively flat design, it causes less obstruction than most applied pulls. The H-front option for the pedestal comes in a solid-color finish only. • The J-front option has applied D-shaped pulls that can also be grasped easily; the wide curve of the pull makes it easy for workers with limited hand mobility to slip their hands through the pull. The J-front option comes in a solid-color finish only. A-SERIES WORK SURFACE-ATTACHED PEDESTALS F-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED OVAL PULLS H-FRONT OPTION: APPLIED ARC PULLS J-FRONT OPTION: D-SHAPED PULLS Suspended Pedestals A-Series suspended pedestals offer a box/file and a box/box/box configuration, along with a pencil/box/file configuration not available in G-Series pedestals. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 322 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Support Pedestals A-Series support pedestals have a dual function—storage and support. Used at either end of a run of Herman Miller systems panels or at the mid-run at a connection point, the support pedestal provides support for both a work surface and the panels from which the work surface hangs. Because a support pedestal attaches to the work surface as well as the panel, it requires a work surface height of 29" and precludes adjusting the height of the work surface. These support pedestals offer three different drawer configurations: file/file, pencil/box/EDP, and box/box/file. Because the support pedestal is fixed in place, it does not offer a choice of bases; it comes with raised feet. The support pedestal eliminates the need for a return or a work surface support panel. Support pedestals are available in nominal 20" and 24" depths; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2" respectively. The 20"-deep pedestal supports a 24"-deep work surface; the 24"-deep pedestal supports a 30"-deep work surface. To match the height of any stationary pedestal used beneath a work surface to the height of the support pedestal used in a workstation or series of workstations, specify the raised-feet option for the stationary pedestal. The file drawer accommodates front-to-back, letter-size hanging files and side-to-side letter, legal, and A4-size files when equipped with a pedestal file converter. The EDP drawer accommodates bound computer paper (12 1/8" by 11 7/8") filed side to side as well as letter-, legal-, and A4-size paper side to side and letter-size paper front to back. Keying and Lock Options All A-Series pedestals are available without locks—as well as with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks. If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 323 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage F-Front Pedestal, Suspended FAF12. Description This pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has recessed oval pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. A file drawer holds letter-size front-toback hanging files. Dimensions For box/file and box/box/box pedestals: • Height is 19 5/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For pencil/box/file pedestals: • Height is 22 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal offers a choice of one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 12" file drawer; or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have fullextension drawer slides. The minimum distance between the suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. L ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 324 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding work surfaces The pencil/box/file suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Newhouse Group table or table desk • Relay table or table desk L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 325 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage F-Front Pedestal, Support FAF13. Description This pedestal attaches to both a work surface and a panel or frame at either the end of a run or mid-run to provide support. The pedestal eliminates the need for a return panel and panel corner connector or a work surface support panel. It has recessed oval pulls and raised feet with 1/2" adjustable glides. The pedestal attaches under a work surface on the left or right side. Attachment hardware is included. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". A 20"-deep pedestal supports a 24"-deep work surface; a 24"-deep pedestal supports a 30"-deep work surface. A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files; an EDP drawer holds EDP-size side-to-side hanging files or letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Dimensions Height is 27 1/4". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2". Planning Considerations This support pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 15" EDP file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer. The 20"-deep support pedestal is used to support a 24"-deep work surface at the end of a work surface run; however, it can be used in the middle of a run to support 30"-deep work surfaces if the work surfaces are ganged. The gap between the support pedestal and the wall run is closed up with a filler plate that comes with the support pedestal and attaches to both the end panel or frame and the work surface. L FILLER PLATE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 326 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. The support pedestal can be reused with a different Herman Miller panel system by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) for EDP drawers separately. To reuse the support pedestal with a different Herman Miller panel system, order the appropriate service parts: With a 20"-deep support pedestal: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241924 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241926 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241928 With a 24"-deep support pedestal: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241925 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241927 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241929 L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 327 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Limitations The support pedestal provides support for a work surface at only the 29" height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 328 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage H-Front Pedestal, Suspended FAH12. Description This pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has applied arc pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. A file drawer holds letter-size front-toback hanging files. Dimensions For box/file and box/box/box pedestals: • Height is 19 5/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For pencil/box/file pedestals: • Height is 22 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal offers a choice of one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 12" file drawer; or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have fullextension drawer slides. The minimum distance between the suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. L ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 329 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding systems work surfaces The pencil/box/file suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Newhouse Group table or table desk • Relay table or table desk L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 330 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage H-Front Pedestal, Support FAH13. Description This pedestal attaches to both a work surface and a panel or frame at either the end of a run or mid-run to provide support. The pedestal eliminates the need for a return panel and panel corner connector or a work surface support panel. It has applied arc pulls and raised feet with 1/2" adjustable glides. The pedestal attaches under a work surface on the left or right side. Attachment hardware is included. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". A 20"-deep pedestal supports a 24"-deep work surface; a 24"-deep pedestal supports a 30"-deep work surface. A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files; an EDP drawer holds EDP-size side-to-side hanging files or letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Dimensions Height is 27 1/4". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2". Planning Considerations This support pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 15" EDP file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer. The 20"-deep support pedestal is used to support a 24"-deep work surface at the end of a work surface run; however, it can be used in the middle of a run to support 30"-deep work surfaces if the work surfaces are ganged. The gap between the support pedestal and the wall run is closed up with a filler plate that comes with the support pedestal and attaches to both the end panel or frame and the work surface. L FILLER PLATE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 331 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. The support pedestal can be reused with a different Herman Miller panel system by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) for EDP drawers separately. To reuse the support pedestal with a different Herman Miller panel system, order the appropriate service parts: With a 20"-deep support pedestal: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241924 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241926 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241928 With a 24"-deep support pedestal: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241925 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241927 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241929 L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 332 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Limitations The support pedestal provides support for a work surface at only the 29"-height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 333 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage J-Front Pedestal, Suspended FAJ12. Description This pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has applied D-shaped pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. A file drawer holds letter-size front-toback hanging files. Dimensions Height is 19 5/8". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal offers a choice of one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have full-extension drawer slides. The minimum distance between the suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) PULL EXTENDS 1 ‹«•" FROM DRAWER FRONT ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 334 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding systems work surfaces L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 335 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage J-Front Pedestal, Support FAJ13. Description This pedestal attaches to both a work surface and a panel or frame at either the end of a run or mid-run to provide support. The pedestal eliminates the need for a return panel and panel corner connector or a work surface support panel. It has applied D-shaped pulls and raised feet with 1/2" adjustable glides. The pedestal attaches under a work surface on the left or right side. A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Attachment hardware is included. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". A 20"-deep pedestal supports a 24"-deep work surface; a 24"-deep pedestal supports a 30"-deep work surface. Dimensions Height is 27 1/4". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2". Planning Considerations This support pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer. The 20"-deep support pedestal is used to support a 24"-deep work surface at the end of a work surface run; however, it can be used in the middle of a run to support 30"-deep work surfaces if the work surfaces are ganged. FILLER PLATE The gap between the support pedestal and the wall run is closed up with a filler plate that comes with the support pedestal and attaches to both the end panel or frame and the work surface. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files with a separate file converter. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 336 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage The support pedestal can be reused with a different Herman Miller panel system by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) To reuse the support pedestal with a different Herman Miller panel system, order the appropriate service parts: With a 20"-deep pedestal: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241924 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241926 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241928 With a 24"-deep support panel: • For attachment to an Action Office Series 1 or 2 panel, service part no. 241925 • For attachment to an Action Office Series 3 panel, service part no. 241927 • For attachment to an Ethospace frame and work surface, service part no. 241929 Limitations The support pedestal provides support for a work surface at only the 29" height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 337 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage G-Series Storage All G-Series pedestals can be used with Ethospace; Action Office Series 1, 2, and 3; and Liaison systems, making them compatible with any office. They can also be used with Newhouse Group and Relay furniture. (The C-front option matches the design details for Newhouse Group furniture; the E-front option matches Relay furniture details.) G-Series storage also blends with Arrio freestanding systems furniture. Front Styles G-Series pedestals also offer three different drawer fronts: • The B-front option has full-width, recessed pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. • The C-front option has centered, recessed pulls and can be specified with either solid-color or veneer drawer fronts; in veneer, there is a choice of recut or natural. • The E-front option has full-width bar pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only; the pull extends 1 3/8" from the drawer front. G-SERIES WORK SURFACE-ATTACHED PEDESTALS B-FRONT OPTION: FULL-WIDTH, RECESSED PULLS C-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED PULLS E-FRONT OPTION: FULL-WIDTH BAR PULLS Suspended Pedestals G-Series suspended pedestals are available in box/file and box/box/box configurations. Support Pedestals G-Series support pedestals are available in box/box/file and file/file configurations. Keying and Lock Options G-Series pedestals are available with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks, but are not available without locks. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 338 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 339 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage B-Front Pedestal, Suspended G5112.B Box/File G5142.B Box/Box/Box G5171.B Box G5172.B File Description This lockable pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has full-width, recessed pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. A file drawer holds letter-size front-toback hanging files. Dimensions For box/file and box/box/box pedestals: • Height is 19 5/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For box pedestals: • Height is 7 1/2". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For file pedestals: • Height is 13 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal offers a choice of one 6" box drawer, one 12" file drawer, one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer, or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have full-extension drawer slides. The minimum distance required between a suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8"; a 1 1/2" distance is required for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a file converter, ordered separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 340 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding work surfaces L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 341 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage B-Front Pedestal, Support NP361. Box/Box/File NP362. File/File Description This lockable pedestal attaches to both a work surface and an Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 panel at either the end of a run or mid-run to provide support. The pedestal eliminates the need for a return panel and panel corner connector or a work surface support panel. It has full-width, recessed pulls and 1/2" adjustable glides. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8"; each pedestal supports a 24"deep work surface. A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions For box/box/file and file/file pedestals: • Height is 28". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations The support pedestal is used to support a 24"-deep work surface at the end of a work surface run; however, it can also be used in the middle of a run to support 30"-deep work surfaces if the work surfaces are ganged. The gap between the support pedestal and the wall run is closed up with a filler plate that comes with the support pedestal and attaches to both the end panel or frame and the work surface. FILLER PLATE Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Limitations The support pedestal provides support for a work surface at only the 29" height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 342 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage C-Front Pedestal, Suspended G5112.C Box/File G5142.C Box/Box/Box Description This lockable pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has centered, recessed pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. Pulls on a file with a solid color front match the front finish; pulls on a file with a veneer front match the case finish. The file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Dimensions Height is 19 5/8". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal is available with one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have full-extension drawer slides. The minimum distance required between a suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8"; a 1 1/2" distance is required for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a file converter, ordered separately. ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 343 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding work surfaces L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 344 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage E-Front Pedestal, Suspended G5112.E Box/File G5142.E Box/Box/Box Description This lockable pedestal mounts under a predrilled hanging or freestanding work surface and has full-width, black umber bar pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". Mounting hardware is included. The file drawer holds letter-size front-toback hanging files. Dimensions Height is 19 5/8". Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". Depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations This suspended pedestal is available with one 6" box drawer and one 12" file drawer or three 6" box drawers. All drawers have full-extension drawer slides. The minimum distance required between a suspended pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8"; a 1 1/2" distance is required for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. The file drawer can be converted to hold side-to-side letter-, legal- and A4-size hanging files with a file converter, ordered separately. PULL EXTENDS 1 ‹«•" FROM DRAWER FRONT ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 345 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Limitations This suspended pedestal cannot be attached under the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay display, high-performance, or computer surface table desk or fourleg-base table • Arrio freestanding work surfaces L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 346 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Pedestal Accessories The drawers in Herman Miller pedestals can be fitted with a series of accessories that subdivide space to hold papers, pens, paper clips, and similar small items and keep them organized for easy retrieval. File drawers can also be outfitted with a converter to accommodate side-to-side filing or a compressor to divide nonhanging files. Drawer Divider, Pedestal FAA10.03 For pencil drawer FAA10.06 For box drawer Description This removable divider is used in a pencil or box drawer. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Width is 12 3/8". Depth is 2". Height is 3" for pencil drawer divider, 6" for box drawer divider. CAN BE PLACED AT ANY POINT Planning Considerations The divider can be placed at any point inside the drawer to divide space. The divider can be moved as required. Multiple dividers can be used in a single drawer. Options The drawer divider can be used along with the Stationary Divider, Pedestal (G5911.), or the Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.), ordered separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 347 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Stationery Divider, Pedestal G5911. Description These four removable dividers are used in box drawers. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Height is 4 5/8". Planning Considerations The divider can be placed to provide access to stationery stored toward or away from the user. Options The divider can be used along with the Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06), or the Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.), ordered separately. STATIONERY DIVIDER WITH PAPER ACCESS FROM FRONT STATIONERY DIVIDER WITH PAPER ACCESS FROM REAR L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 348 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Utility Tray, Pedestal G5912. Description This sectioned tray stores pencils and small items in a pencil or box drawer. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Width is 12 5/8". Height is 1 5/8". Depth is 4 3/4". CAN BE POSITIONED IN FRONT OR REAR Planning Considerations The sectioned tray can be placed at the front of the drawer or at the rear. Options The tray can be used along with the Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06), or the Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.), ordered separately. L SECTIONED TO HOLD AND ORGANIZE PENCILS AND SMALL ITEMS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 349 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage File Converter, Pedestal G5913. Description These black umber brackets convert a file drawer to hold letter-, legal-, and A4size side-to-side hanging files. Two converters are used per drawer. Package contains four. Dimensions Available to fit 12"-high file drawers. Planning Considerations Two converters are required for each 12" drawer to convert the drawer to side-toside filing. L ALLOWS SIDE-TO-SIDE FILING OF HANGING FOLDERS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 350 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage File Compressor G5914. Description These compressors lock into slots in the bottom of a pedestal file drawer or the pull-out shelf of an A-Series freestanding lateral file to divide nonhanging files. Finish is black umber. Package contains four. Dimensions Width is 9". Height is 6 1/4". Planning Considerations A compressor can fit into any pair of slots in the drawer bottom or pull-out shelf and can be moved as needed. The maximum number of compressors for each pedestal file drawer is: • 20"-deep drawer: 8 compressors • 24"-deep drawer: 10 compressors • 28"-deep drawer: 12 compressors The maximum number of compressors for each pull-out shelf is: • 30"-wide shelf: 10 compressors • 36"-wide shelf: 14 compressors • 42"-wide shelf: 18 compressors L MOVABLE, TO ADJUST FOR NONHANGING FILE STORAGE LOCKS INTO ANY 1 OF 8 PAIRS OF SLOTS IN BOTTOM OF DRAWER Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 351 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Pencil Drawers Pencil drawers, in a choice of sizes, configurations, and construction, can be mounted under Action Office Series 2 work surfaces. Pencil Drawer G5010. Description This plastic drawer mounts under a hanging or freestanding work surface to store pencils and other small items. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 21 1/8". Depth is 16 1/4". Height is 1 7/8" at back, 1" at front. Planning Considerations The narrow front profile allows the maximum amount of kneespace under a work surface. Subdivided sections at the front of the drawer accept a variety of small items. NARROW PROFILE TO ALLOW MAXIMUM KNEESPACE DIFFERENT SIZE SECTIONS TO HOLD VARIETY OF SMALL ITEMS Limitations This drawer cannot be suspended under the following products: • 24"-wide work surfaces • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay 30"-wide, four-leg-base table • Some Arrio work surface sizes (See the “Attaching Pencil Drawers” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 352 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage Pencil Drawer, Metal G5012. Description This metal drawer mounts under a hanging or freestanding work surface to store pencils and other small items. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 21 3/4". Depth is 18 5/8". Height is 2 1/2" at back, 1 1/2" at front. Planning Considerations The narrow front profile allows the maximum amount of kneespace under a work surface. SECTIONS SEPARATE SMALL ITEMS Subdivided sections at the front of the drawer accept a variety of small items. Limitations The drawer cannot be mounted under the following products: • 24"-wide work surfaces • 24"-deep Action Office freestanding tables • Action Office 18"-deep work surfaces • Ethospace peninsula with access cover or rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay 30"-wide or 22"-deep 4-legbase table or 48"-wide display table desk • Some Arrio work surface sizes (See the “Attaching Pencil Drawers” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 353 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Style Pencil Drawer AO480. Description This drawer mounts under a predrilled panel-hung work surface or under an Arrio work surface to store pencils and other small items. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 20 3/4". Depth is 15 3/8". Height is 3" at back, 2 1/2" at front. Planning Considerations Subdivided sections at the front of the drawer accept a variety of small items. DIFFERENT-SIZE SECTIONS Limitations This drawer cannot be suspended under some Arrio work surface sizes. (See the “Attaching Pencil Drawers” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 354 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Style Drawers A-style drawers are suspended under a work surface, providing a low-cost alternative to a storage pedestal. These A-style drawers have dividers to hold and organize papers and small items within the drawers. Drawer with Lock AO481. 5 1/2" High AO482. 11 1/2" High Description This lockable drawer mounts under a predrilled panel-hung work surface or freestanding table. It has full-extension suspension. Mounting hardware is included. The 5 1/2"-high drawer stores small items; the 11 1/2"-high drawer stores papers and files. Dimensions Width is 20 3/4". Depth is 14 7/8". Nominal heights are 5 1/2" and 11 1/2"; actual heights are 5 7/8" and 12". Planning Considerations This drawer can be mounted at any of several predrilled locations on the underside of a work surface. 5 ⁄/™"-HIGH DRAWER Options For the 11 1/2"-high drawer, order the optional A-Style Stationery Divider Package (AO490.) separately. For the 5 1/2"-high drawer, order the optional A-Style Drawer Divider Package (AO491.) separately. Limitations This drawer cannot be attached to the underside of an Arrio freestanding work surface. L 11 ⁄/™"-HIGH DRAWER Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 355 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Style Storage Unit with Lock AO483. Description This lockable, two-drawer storage unit mounts under a predrilled panel-hung work surface or freestanding table. It stores small items, papers, and files and has full-extension suspension. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 20 3/4". Depth is 15 1/4". Height is 17 3/4". Planning Considerations This storage unit can be mounted at any of several predrilled locations on the underside of a work surface. Options Order optional accessories separately: • A-Style Stationery Divider (AO490.) • A-Style Drawer Divider Package (AO491.) Limitations This storage unit cannot be attached to the underside of an Arrio freestanding work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 356 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Style Stationery Divider AO490. Description This unit vertically divides an A-Style 11 1/2"-high drawer. Finish is dark tone. Dimensions Width is 15 3/4". Depth is 13". Height is 8 1/4". Limitations This stationery divider cannot be used with an A-style 3"-high pencil drawer or 5 1/2"-high drawer with lock. The stationery divider slots are not removable. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 357 Storage Work Surface-Attached Storage A-Style Drawer Divider Package AO491. Description This package divides materials within an A-Style 5 1/2"-high drawer. It includes four removable dividers and a pencil tray. Finish is dark tone. Dimensions Width is 13 5/8". Depth is 16 1/8". Height is 5 1/4". Planning Considerations The stationery dividers and pencil tray are movable, so that the location of the dividers and pencil tray can be changed to suit the user’s work preferences. PENCIL TRAY AND DIVIDERS CAN BE MOVED Limitations This drawer divider package cannot be used with an A-style 3"-high pencil drawer or 11 1/2"-high drawer with lock. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 358 Storage Freestanding Storage Freestanding Storage Freestanding storage products can be used within a workstation or in centralized storage areas for bulk filing. Because they’re not attached to a work surface, they provide alternatives for relocating storage at will. Freestanding storage includes stationary and mobile pedestals as well as lateral files. There are also several organizers—such as the file drawer organizer—that can allow file drawers set up for letter-sized filing to store other items. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 359 Storage Freestanding Storage Freestanding Pedestal Drawer Storage Pedestals—A-Series or G-Series, stationary or mobile—can be located under squared- and radiused-edge rectangular work surfaces, squared-edge rectangular and round-end peninsulas, and Arrio freestanding work surfaces. They offer an alternative to work surface-attached storage in a workstation. Because A-Series freestanding storage offers additional depths, however, the work surface depth as well as its width must be taken into account in specifying freestanding storage to fit beneath work surfaces. (The “Compatibility Between Work Surface and Storage Depth” chart is a quick reference for fit for wall-attached work surfaces and peninsulas. For considerations of fit for Arrio work surfaces, refer to the Arrio™ Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide.) With A-Series pedestals, certain drawer configurations requiring greater clearance may not fit beneath a work surface at typical heights. Height requirements must be checked carefully; a choice between glides and the raised foot may affect the fit. Since the depth of the Herman Miller work surface has a significant impact on the storage depth, the “Compatibility Between Work Surface and Storage Depth” chart summarizes the information about which freestanding storage fits under various work surfaces. Details about compatibility and fit are covered in the information about each storage type. Compatibility Between Work Surface and Storage Depth Freestanding Storage Type 24"-Deep Work Surface 30"-Deep Work Surface Rectangular Peninsula Stationary Storage 20" deep (G- or A-Series) 24" deep (A-Series) 28" deep (A-Series) Yes Yes No Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No Mobile Storage 20" deep (G-Series) 24" deep (A-Series) Yes Yes* Yes Yes* Yes Yes* Support Pedestals 20" deep (A-Series only) 24" deep (A-Series only) Yes — — Yes — — *Work surface must be at 29" height Note: See “Stationary Pedestal Storage” for storage limitations related to use of 60"-wide work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 360 Storage Freestanding Storage Filing Capacity Provided by Freestanding Pedestals The charts show the total filing inches for pedestal file drawers and EDP file drawers in A- and G-Series storage pedestals. The inside height clearance of the pedestal file drawer is 10 3/4"; interior height of the drawer side is 9 1/2". The inside height clearance of the 15" EDP drawer (A-Series only) is 13 1/8"; interior height of the drawer side is 11 7/8". SIDE-TO-SIDE EDP ONLY (BOUND) SIDE-TO-SIDE LEGAL SIDE-TO-SIDE A4 WITH LETTER SIDE-TO-SIDE LETTER 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 20" DEPTH (G- OR ASERIES) 1 ⁄«™" 3 ⁄«™" N/A TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY=13 ‹«¢" (A4=24 CM FOLDERS) A4 CAPACITY=12 ⁄«¢" LETTER CAPACITY=1 ⁄«™" TOTAL CAPACITY =15 ‹«¢" 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 5 ⁄«•" 16 ⁄«™" TOTAL CAPACITY =16 ⁄«™" 2 CONVERTERS 24" DEPTH (A-SERIES ONLY) FRONT-TO-BACK LETTER ONLY 7 ⁄«•" 20 ⁄«•" TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY=17 ‹«8" A4 CAPACITY=12 ⁄«¢" LETTER CAPACITY=5 ⁄«8" TOTAL CAPACITY =15 ‹«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 2 CONVERTERS 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 12 ⁄«¢" 28" DEPTH (A-SERIES ONLY) 9 fi«•" TOTAL CAPACITY =20 ⁄«8" 11 ‹«•" 24 fi«•" TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" L TOTAL CAPACITY=21 7«8" A4 CAPACITY=12 ⁄«¢" LETTER CAPACITY=9 fi«•" TOTAL CAPACITY =23 fi«•" TOTAL CAPACITY =12 ⁄«¢" TOTAL CAPACITY =24 fi«•" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 361 Storage Freestanding Storage A-Series Pedestals All A-Series pedestals are designed to be visually compatible with all Herman Miller systems and freestanding furniture. Front Styles A-Series pedestals offer three different drawer fronts: • The F-front option has centered, recessed oval pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. This recessed pull minimizes the protrusion usually associated with handles and also causes minimal obstruction in tight places. Specifying the recessed pull upside down helps accommodate users with limited hand mobility, and specifying the recessed pull in a contrasting color aids workers with visual impairment. • The H-front option has applied arc pulls that can be grasped easily by workers with limited hand mobility; because of its relatively flat design, it causes less obstruction than most applied pulls. The H-front option for pedestals comes in a solid-color finish only. • The J-front option has applied D-shaped pulls that can also be grasped easily; the wide curve of the pull makes it easy for workers with limited hand mobility to slip their hands through the pull. The J-front option comes in a solid-color finish only. A-SERIES PEDESTALS F-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED, OVAL PULLS L H-FRONT OPTION: APPLIED ARC PULLS J-FRONT OPTION: D-SHAPED PULLS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 362 Storage Freestanding Storage Stationary Pedestal Storage A-Series stationary pedestals are available in three depths (20", 24", and 28", nominal dimensions); they offer a 3"-high pencil drawer and a 15"-high EDP drawer in addition to the 6" box and 12" file drawers (a total of four drawer heights in four configurations). A-Series stationary pedestals offer the option of either a raised foot that allows the pedestal to fit snugly up under the work surface or an adjustable glide that compensates for variances in carpeting or differences in types of flooring. (Adjustable glides allow an adjustment of 1/2". The raised foot raises the pedestal by 1" and includes 1/2" adjustable glides and additional counterweights.) In addition to allowing interchangeability of glides and the raised foot, these stationary pedestals can be converted into mobile ones by substituting casters for the glides or raised feet. All 20"- and 24"-deep pedestals can be stored beneath any Herman Miller panel-hung work surface. The 28"-deep pedestals fit flush beneath only the 30"-deep work surfaces. Because of the metal support under the 60"-wide work surface, only 20"-deep pedestals fit under 24"-deep work surfaces. The 20"- and 24"-deep pedestals can, however, fit under 30"-deep, 60"-wide work surfaces. The 12"-high file drawer accommodates front-to-back, letter-size hanging files and side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size files when equipped with a pedestal file converter. The EDP drawer accommodates bound computer paper (12 1/8" wide by 11 7/8" high) filed side to side as well as letter-, legal-, and A4-size paper side to side and letter-size paper front to back. Each stationary pedestal is shipped with an integral counterweight for stability. Additional counterweights are required when A-Series stationary pedestals are converted to mobile ones. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 363 Storage Freestanding Storage Mobile Pedestal Storage A-Series mobile pedestals offer three drawer configurations (file/file, pencil/box/file, and box/box/file) and are available in a nominal 24" depth. The file drawer accommodates front-to-back, letter-size hanging files and side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size files when equipped with a pedestal file converter. Dual-wheel casters, field installed, are for use on either carpeted or hard floors. The casters on A-Series mobile storage units can be removed later to convert the pedestal to a stationary pedestal—with either adjustable glides or raised feet (additional counterweights may be needed). The ranges in depth and drawer configuration require that the work surface depth and height be considered when planning where such storage units can be placed. Any mobile pedestal can be stored beneath any depth work surface or rectangular peninsula at a nominal 29" sit-down height, as long as the installation tolerances and glide adjustments allow for the pedestal height. Because A-Series mobile pedestals are 27 3/4" high in all configurations except the pencil/box/file option, they are a tight fit beneath a work surface set at a nominal 29" seated height. To use those 27 3/4"-high pedestals in that situation, the clearance beneath the work surface must be at least 27 3/4", the glide option must be used, and the tolerances and glide adjustments on the panels and pedestals must provide sufficient clearance for the pedestal height. (In applications where the mobile pedestal will be moved frequently, the G-Series pedestal or the lower A-Series pencil/box/file combination is preferable to the tight fit of the A-Series 27 3/4"-high pedestals.) Keying and Lock Options All A-Series freestanding storage units are available without locks as well as with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks. If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 364 Storage Freestanding Storage F-Front Pedestal, Freestanding FAF10. Stationary FAF11. Mobile Description This freestanding pedestal fits below a hanging or freestanding work surface and has recessed oval pulls. The actual depth of a stationary pedestal is 19 5/8", 23 1/2", or 28"; the actual depth of a mobile pedestal is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files; an EDP drawer holds EDP-size side-to-side hanging files or letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Glides adjust a stationary pedestal 1/2"; feet raise a stationary pedestal 1" and include 1/2" adjustable glides and additional counterweights. The mobile pedestal has black umber casters. Dimensions For all stationary pedestals: • Heights are 23 3/8" and 26 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20", 24", and 28"; actual depths are 19 5/8", 23 1/2", and 28"; interior depths are 16 1/2", 20 1/ 8", and 24 5/8". For pencil/box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 24 5/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2"; interior depths are 16 1/2" and 20 1/8". For file/file and box/box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 27 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2"; interior depths are 16 1/2" and 20 1/8". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 365 Storage Freestanding Storage Planning Considerations This freestanding pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 15" EDP file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer in a stationary pedestal. This freestanding pedestal also offers two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 12" file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer in a mobile pedestal. The minimum distance between the pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. When used with squared-edge or radiused-edge work surfaces, most 20"and 24"-deep pedestals require a work surface at least 24" deep; and most 28"deep pedestals require a 30"-deep work surface. When used with Ethospace work surfaces, the cable management trough along the back edge of the work surface takes up some of the room at the rear; therefore, only 20"-deep pedestals can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, and most 24"-deep pedestals fit under a 30"-deep work surface. See “Limitations” for exceptions to these general guidelines. FREESTANDING PEDESTALS: FOR PLACEMENT BENEATH WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL To assure that the top of the stationary pedestal will be flush with the underside of the work surface, specify the stationary pedestal with the raised-feet option. A mobile pedestal can be converted to a stationary one—with either glides or raised feet—by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) MOBILE PEDESTALS: ON CASTERS FOR EASY MOBILITY Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 366 Storage Freestanding Storage Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Order optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) for EDP drawers separately. To convert a mobile pedestal to a stationary one, order the appropriate service parts: To convert to the glide option, order: • Pop rivet, service part no. 134826 • Anti-tip glide, service part no. 134835 • Glide, service part no. 241795 • Glide nut, service part no. 241871 To convert to a raised-foot option, order: • Raised foot, service part no. 241886 • Leveler glide, service part no. 241872 • Screw, service part no. 134827 Limitations F-front freestanding pedestals cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace round-end peninsula with access or 25 1/2"-high rectangular peninsula (pedestal feet won’t fit; pedestal glides will fit) • Some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the “Freestanding Pedestal File Clearance” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The 20"-deep freestanding pedestal cannot fit below the Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray. The 24"- and 28"-deep freestanding pedestals (stationary and mobile) cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office 60"-wide work surface • Newhouse Group table desk, machine return, or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay table desk or display, highperformance, or computer surface table desk L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 367 Storage Freestanding Storage The 24"-deep stationary pedestal also cannot fit below a 24"-deep Ethospace work surface unless a pencil/box/file pedestal is specified; the 28"-deep pedestal cannot fit below a 30"-deep Ethospace work surface unless a pencil/ box/file pedestal is specified. The 24"-deep mobile pedestal also cannot fit below the following products: • Newhouse Group furniture • Ethospace 24"-deep work surfaces or rectangular peninsulas, unless a pencil/box/file configuration is specified • Action Office freestanding tables, unless a pencil/box/file configuration is specified L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 368 Storage Freestanding Storage H-Front Pedestal, Freestanding FAH10. Stationary FAH11. Mobile Description This freestanding pedestal fits below a hanging or freestanding work surface and has applied arc pulls. The actual depth of a stationary pedestal is 19 5/8", 23 1/2", or 28"; the actual depth of a mobile pedestal is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files; an EDP drawer holds EDP-size side-to-side hanging files or letter-size front-to-back hanging files. Glides adjust a stationary pedestal 1/2"; feet raise a stationary pedestal 1" and include 1/2" adjustable glides and additional counterweights. The mobile pedestal has black umber casters. Dimensions For all stationary pedestals: • Heights are 23 3/8" and 26 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20", 24", and 28"; actual depths are 19 5/8", 23 1/2", and 28"; interior depths are 16 1/2", 20 1/8", and 24 5/8". For pencil/box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 24 5/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2"; interior depths are 16 1/2" and 20 1/8". For file/file and box/box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 27 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2"; interior depths are 16 1/2" and 20 1/8". L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 369 Storage Freestanding Storage Planning Considerations This freestanding pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 15" EDP file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer in a stationary pedestal. This freestanding pedestal also offers two 12" file drawers; one 3" pencil drawer, one 6" box drawer, and one 12" file drawer; or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer in a mobile pedestal. The minimum distance between the pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. FREESTANDING PEDESTALS: FOR PLACEMENT BENEATH WORK SURFACE When used with squared-edge or radiused-edge work surfaces, most 20"and 24"-deep pedestals require a work surface at least 24" deep; and most 28"deep pedestals require a 30"-deep work surface. When used with Ethospace work surfaces, the cable management trough along the back edge of the work surface takes up some of the room at the rear; therefore, only 20"-deep pedestals can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, and most 24"-deep pedestals fit under a 30"-deep work surface. See “Limitations” for exceptions to these general guidelines. 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL To assure that the top of the stationary pedestal will be flush with the underside of the work surface, specify the stationary pedestal with the raised-feet option. A mobile pedestal can be converted to a stationary one—with either glides or raised feet—by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for pencil drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.03) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) MOBILE PEDESTALS: ON CASTERS FOR EASY MOBILITY Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 370 Storage Freestanding Storage Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Order optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) for EDP drawers separately. To convert a mobile pedestal to a stationary one, order the appropriate service parts: To convert to the glide option, order: • Pop rivet, service part no. 134826 • Anti-tip glide, service part no. 134835 • Glide, service part no. 241795 • Glide nut, service part no. 241871 To convert to a raised-foot option, order: • Raised foot, service part no. 241886 • Leveler glide, service part no. 241872 • Screw, service part no. 134827 Limitations H-front freestanding pedestals cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace round-end peninsula with access or 25 1/2"-high rectangular peninsula (pedestal with feet won’t fit; pedestal with glides will fit) • Some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the “Freestanding Pedestal File Clearance” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The 20"-deep freestanding pedestal cannot fit below the Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray. The 24"- and 28"-deep freestanding pedestals (stationary and mobile) cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office 60"-wide work surface • Newhouse Group table desk, machine return, or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay table desk or display, highperformance, or computer surface table desk L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 371 Storage Freestanding Storage The 24"-deep stationary pedestal also cannot fit below a 24"-deep Ethospace work surface unless a pencil/box/file pedestal is specified; the 28"-deep pedestal cannot fit below a 30"-deep Ethospace work surface unless a pencil/ box/file pedestal is specified. The 24"-deep mobile pedestal also cannot fit below the following products: • Newhouse Group furniture • Ethospace 24"-deep work surfaces or rectangular peninsulas, unless a pencil/box/file configuration is specified • Action Office freestanding tables, unless a pencil/box/file configuration is specified L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 372 Storage Freestanding Storage J-Front Pedestal, Freestanding FAJ10. Stationary FAJ11. Mobile Description This freestanding pedestal fits below a hanging or freestanding work surface and has applied D-shaped pulls. A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files. The actual depth of a stationary pedestal is 19 5/8", 23 1/2", or 28"; the actual depth of a mobile pedestal is 19 5/8" or 23 1/2". Glides adjust a stationary pedestal 1/2"; feet raise a stationary pedestal 1" and include 1/2" adjustable glides and additional counterweights. The mobile pedestal has black umber casters. Dimensions For all stationary pedestals: • Height is 26 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20", 24", and 28"; actual depths are 19 5/8", 23 1/2", and 28"; interior depths are 16 1/2", 20 1/8", and 24 5/8". For all mobile pedestals: • Height is 27 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20" and 24"; actual depths are 19 5/8" and 23 1/2"; interior depths are 16 1/2" and 20 1/8". Planning Considerations This freestanding pedestal offers a choice of two 12" file drawers or two 6" box drawers and one 12" file drawer. The minimum distance between the pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8", and 1 1/2" for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. L FREESTANDING PEDESTALS: FOR PLACEMENT BENEATH WORK SURFACE 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 373 Storage Freestanding Storage When used with squared-edge or radiused-edge work surfaces, most 20"and 24"-deep pedestals require a work surface at least 24" deep; and most 28"deep pedestals require a 30"-deep work surface. When used with Ethospace work surfaces, the cable management trough along the back edge of the work surface takes up some of the room at the rear; therefore, only 20"-deep pedestals can fit under 24"-deep work surfaces, and most 24"-deep pedestals fit under a 30"-deep work surface. See “Limitations” for exceptions to these general guidelines. To assure that the top of the stationary pedestal will be flush with the underside of the work surface, specify the stationary pedestal with the raised-feet option. MOBILE PEDESTALS: ON CASTERS FOR EASY MOBILITY A mobile pedestal can be converted to a stationary one—with either glides or raised feet—by ordering the appropriate service parts. Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) To convert a mobile pedestal to a stationary one, order the appropriate service parts: To convert to the glide option, order: • Pop rivet, service part no. 134826 • Anti-tip glide, service part no. 134835 • Glide, service part no. 241795 • Glide nut, service part no. 241871 To convert to a raised-foot option, order: • Raised foot, service part no. 241886 • Leveler glide, service part no. 241872 • Screw, service part no. 134827 L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 374 Storage Freestanding Storage Limitations J-front freestanding pedestals cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace round-end peninsula with access or 25 1/2"-high rectangular peninsula (pedestal with feet won’t fit; pedestal with glides will fit) • Some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the “Freestanding Pedestal File Clearance” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The 20"-deep freestanding pedestal cannot fit below the Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray. The 24"- and 28"-deep freestanding pedestals (stationary and mobile) cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office 60"-wide work surface • Ethospace work surfaces, 24"- and 30"-deep, respectively • Newhouse Group table desk, machine return, or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Relay table desk or display, highperformance, or computer surface table desk The 24"-deep mobile pedestal also cannot fit below the following products: • Newhouse Group furniture • Ethospace 24"-deep work surfaces or rectangular peninsulas • Action Office freestanding tables L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 375 Storage Freestanding Storage G-Series Pedestals All G-Series pedestals are designed to be visually compatible with all Herman Miller systems and freestanding furniture. Front Styles G-Series pedestals offer two different drawer fronts: • The B-front option has full-width, recessed pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. • The C-front option has centered, recessed pulls and can be specified either with a solid-color finish or with recut or natural veneer drawer fronts. G-SERIES PEDESTALS B-FRONT OPTION: FULL-WIDTH, RECESSED PULLS C-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED PULLS Stationary Pedestal Storage G-Series stationary pedestals are available only in a 20" nominal depth, with three combinations of 6" box and 12" file drawers. G-Series stationary pedestals have adjustable glides (1/2" adjustment) that compensate for variances in carpeting or differences in types of flooring. In addition to the height-adjustable glides at the back, G-Series stationary pedestals have anti-tip feet at the front. All 20"-deep pedestals can be stored beneath any Herman Miller panel-hung work surface. The 12"-high file drawer accommodates front-to-back, letter-size hanging files and side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size files when equipped with a pedestal file converter. Each stationary pedestal is shipped with an integral counterweight for stability. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 376 Storage Freestanding Storage Mobile Pedestal Storage G-Series mobile pedestals offer one configuration (with one 6" box and one 12" file drawer) and are available in a nominal 20" depth. The file drawer accommodates front-to-back, letter-size hanging files and side-to-side letter-, legal-, and A4-size files when equipped with a pedestal file converter. Dual-wheel casters, field installed, are for use on either carpeted or hard floors. Any G-Series mobile pedestal can be stored beneath a 24"- or 30"-deep Herman Miller work surface at a nominal 29" sit-down height, as long as the installation tolerances and glide adjustments allow for the pedestal height. In applications where the mobile pedestal will be moved frequently, G-Series pedestals (or the lower ASeries pencil/box/file combination) are preferable because of the tight fit of some of the higher A-Series pedestals. Keying and Lock Options G-Series freestanding storage units are available only with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks; they are not available without locks. If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 377 Storage Freestanding Storage B-Front Pedestal, Freestanding G5110.B Stationary (Box/File) G5111.B Mobile (Box/File) G5130.B Stationary (File/File) G5120.B Stationary (Box/Box/File) Description This lockable, freestanding pedestal fits below a hanging or freestanding work surface and has full-width, recessed pulls. A file drawer holds letter-size frontto-back hanging files. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8", 23 1/2", or 28"; the actual depth of a mobile pedestal is 19 5/8". A stationary pedestal has 1/2" adjustable glides. The mobile pedestal has black umber casters. Dimensions For box/file stationary pedestals: • Height is 20 3/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 23 1/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For box/box/file and file/file stationary pedestals: • Height is 26 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depths are nominal 20", 24", and 28"; actual depths are 19 5/8", 23 1/2", and 28"; interior depths are 16 1/2", 20 1/8", and 24 5/8". Planning Considerations Because of its lower height, the box/file pedestal can be used under most hanging work surfaces, even ones at machine height. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 378 Storage Freestanding Storage The minimum distance required between a pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8"; a 1 1/2" distance is required for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) FREESTANDING PEDESTALS: FOR PLACEMENT BENEATH WORK SURFACE Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL Limitations File/file and box/box/file stationary pedestals cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace 25 1/2"-high rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the “Freestanding Pedestal File Clearance” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The file/file and box/box/file drawer configurations are not available in a mobile pedestal. L MOBILE PEDESTALS: ON CASTERS FOR EASY MOBILITY Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 379 Storage Freestanding Storage C-Front Pedestal, Freestanding G5111.C Mobile (Box/File) G5130.C Stationary (File/File) G5120.C Stationary (Box/Box/File) Description This lockable, freestanding pedestal fits below a hanging or freestanding work surface and has centered, recessed pulls. The actual pedestal depth is 19 5/8". A file drawer holds letter-size front-to-back hanging files. A stationary pedestal has 1/2" adjustable glides. The mobile pedestal has black umber casters. Pulls on a file with a solid color front match the front finish; pulls on a file with a veneer front match the case finish. Dimensions For box/file mobile pedestals: • Height is 23 1/4". • Width is 14 5/8"; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". For box/box/file and file/file stationary pedestals: • Height is 26 3/8". • Width is 14 5/8; interior width is 12 1/4". • Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8"; interior depth is 16 1/2". Planning Considerations Because of its lower height, the box/file pedestal can be used under most hanging work surfaces, even ones at machine height. The minimum distance required between a pedestal and an adjacent work surface support panel is 5/8"; a 1 1/2" distance is required for an adjacent return panel or frame with work surface support arm. Options Order optional accessories for box drawers separately: • Drawer Divider, Pedestal (FAA10.06) • Stationery Divider, Pedestal (G5911.) • Utility Tray, Pedestal (G5912.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 380 Storage Freestanding Storage Order optional accessories for file drawers separately: • File Converter, Pedestal (G5913.) • File Compressor (G5914.) • File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) Limitations File/file and box/box/file stationary pedestals cannot fit below the following products: • Action Office freestanding tables • Ethospace 25 1/2"-high rectangular peninsula • Newhouse Group machine return or table with adjustable keyboard tray • Some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the “Freestanding Pedestal File Clearance” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) FREESTANDING PEDESTALS: FOR PLACEMENT BENEATH WORK SURFACE The file/file and box/box/file drawer configurations are not available in a mobile pedestal; the box/file drawer configuration is not available in a stationary pedestal. 1 ⁄«™" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND ADJACENT RETURN PANEL OR FRAME WITH WORK SURFACE SUPPORT ARM; fi«•" MINIMUM DISTANCE BETWEEN PEDESTAL AND WORK SURFACE SUPPORT PANEL MOBILE PEDESTALS: ON CASTERS FOR EASY MOBILITY L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 381 Storage Freestanding Storage Freestanding Lateral File Storage Freestanding lateral files are available in nominal 30", 36", and 42" widths and in A-Series and G-Series, each with their distinctive drawer front styles. The A-Series line offers an additional product—a four-drawer lateral file with a flipper door unit on top. Freestanding lateral files accommodate letter-, legal-, and A4-size paper and suspension files. Inside drawer height clearance (the maximum height for filing materials) is 10 7/8"; the interior height of the drawer side is 9 1/2". Lateral files include 5/8" adjustable leveling glides, drawer labels and label holders, and a side-to-side hanger bar for suspended files. All freestanding lateral files convert to front-to-back filing with separate freestanding lateral file converters. (Front-to-back filing provides the maximum filing inches for letter-size papers.) In addition, the removable file drawer organizer can be used in any lateral file drawer set up for lettersize filing to store items other than files. A positive interlock system allows only one drawer to be opened at a time. Each freestanding lateral file must be further stabilized either with a freestanding lateral file counterweight or by anchoring the file to an adjacent file or wall; knockouts and ganging hardware are included for that purpose. The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth where the clearance height of the work surface exceeds the height of the lateral file and the width is less than the clearance between the work surface supports. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 382 Storage Freestanding Storage Filing Capacity Provided by Freestanding Lateral Files This chart shows total filing inches and configurations for freestanding lateral file drawers. Front-to-back and side-to-side dimensions are given for letter-, legal-, and A4-size documents. The illustrations show the filing configurations used to reach those capacities. 30" WIDE 36" WIDE 42" WIDE 26 fi«•" 32 fi«•" 38 fi«•" SIDE-TO-SIDE LEGAL, A4, LETTER 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED 2 CONVERTERS AND 1 ADAPTER REQUIRED 6 ⁄«•" 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED FRONT-TO-BACK LETTER 16 ⁄«¢" 16 ⁄«¢" 1 CONVERTER REQUIRED FRONT-TO-BACK A4 WITH LEGAL 16 ⁄«¢" 16 ⁄«¢" 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED 16 ⁄«¢" 1 CONVERTER REQUIRED 10 ⁄«™" (LEGAL) 4 ⁄«¢" 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED (LEGAL) 10 ⁄«™" 16 ⁄«¢" 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED 2 CONVERTERS REQUIRED 6 ⁄«™" FRONT-TO-BACK LEGAL 16 ⁄«¢" L 16 ⁄«¢" 16 ⁄«¢" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 383 Storage Freestanding Storage Total Filing Inches for Freestanding Lateral Files 30" Wide 36" Wide 42" Wide Side-to-Side Legal, A4, Letter Per drawer 2 Drawer 3 Drawer 4 Drawer Flipper Door 26 5⁄8" 53 1⁄4" 79 7⁄8" 106 1⁄2" 130 5⁄8" 32 5⁄8" 65 1⁄4" 97 7⁄8" 130 1⁄2" 160 5⁄ 8" 38 5⁄8" 77 1⁄4" 115 7⁄8" 154 1⁄2" 190 5⁄8" Front-to-Back Letter Per drawer 2 Drawer 3 Drawer 4 Drawer 32 1⁄2" 65" 97 1⁄2" 130" 38 5⁄8" 77 1⁄4" 115 7⁄8" 154 1⁄2" 48 3⁄4" 97 1⁄2" 146 1⁄4" 195" Front-to-Back A4 with Legal Per drawer 2 Drawer 3 Drawer 4 Drawer 32 1⁄2" 65" 97 1⁄2" 130" 36 3⁄4" 73 1⁄2" 110 1⁄4" 147" 43" 86" 129" 172" Front-to-Back Legal Per drawer 2 Drawer 3 Drawer 4 Drawer 26 3⁄4" 53 1⁄2" 80 1⁄4" 107" 32 1⁄2" 65" 97 1⁄2" 130" 39" 78" 117" 156" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 384 Storage Freestanding Storage A-Series Lateral Files All A-Series lateral files are designed to be visually compatible with all Herman Miller systems and freestanding furniture. Front Styles A-Series lateral files offer three different drawer fronts: • The F-front option has centered, recessed oval pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. This recessed pull minimizes the protrusion usually associated with handles and also causes minimal obstruction in tight places. Specifying the recessed pull upside down helps accommodate users with limited hand mobility, and specifying the recessed pull in a contrasting color aids workers with visual impairment. • The H-front option has applied arc pulls that can be grasped easily by workers with limited hand mobility; because of its relatively flat design, it causes less obstruction than most applied pulls. The H-front option for pedestals comes in a solid-color finish only. • The J-front option has applied D-shaped pulls that can also be grasped easily; the wide curve of the pull makes it easy for workers with limited hand mobility to slip their hands through the pull. The J-front option comes in a solid-color finish only. A-SERIES LATERAL FILES F-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED, OVAL PULLS L H-FRONT OPTION: APPLIED ARC PULLS J-FRONT OPTION: D-SHAPED PULLS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 385 Storage Freestanding Storage Sizes A-Series freestanding lateral files are available in nominal 30", 36", and 42" widths, with two, three, or four drawers, or with four file drawers and a flipper door above them. Behind the flipper door is a pull-out shelf with three dividers (more can be added) for holding and separating nonhanging files, books, and binders, or other similar items. 4-DRAWER LATERAL FILE WITH FLIPPER DOOR A-Series lateral files come with adjustable glides or—for two-drawer lateral files only—the option of raised feet with adjustable glides. (The raised feet add 1 1/8" to the unit’s height.) Keying and Lock Options All A-Series freestanding storage units are available without locks as well as with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks. If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 386 Storage Freestanding Storage F-Front Freestanding Lateral File FAF22. 2 Drawers FAF23. 3 Drawers FAF24. 4 Drawers FAF25. 4 Drawers with Flipper Door Description This lateral file holds letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. It has recessed oval pulls, 1/2" adjustable glides, and a positive interlock system that permits only one drawer or pull-out shelf to open at a time. The actual file depth is 19 5/8". The actual file width is 29 5/8", 35 5/8", or 41 5/8". Raised feet, available on twodrawer units only, raise the file 1" and have 1/2" adjustable glides and a counterweight. Dimensions Widths are nominal 30", 36", and 42"; actual widths are 29 5/8", 35 5/8", and 41 5/8"; interior widths are 26 1/8", 32 1/8", and 38 1/8". MUST BE ANCHORED, GANGED TO ANOTHER FILE, OR STABILIZED WITH COUNTERWEIGHT Heights are 26 3/8" (2 drawers), 38 3/4" (3 drawers), 51 1/8" (4 drawers), and 64 1/2" (4 drawers with flipper door). Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8". Planning Considerations The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth that is at least 29" high. The width of the lateral file must be less than the clearance between the work surface supports. The glides have a 5/8" adjustment range to compensate for uneven floors. The raised-foot option adds 1 1/8" of adjustment to the height of the twodrawer file; the glides used with the raised feet also have a 5/8" adjustment range. L GLIDES PROVIDE fi«•" ADJUSTMENT RANGE W CLEARANCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS MUST BE EQUAL TO OR GREATER THAN WIDTH OF LATERAL FILE TO USE FILE BENEATH WORK SURFACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 387 Storage Freestanding Storage Each freestanding lateral file must be anchored, ganged to another file, or stabilized with a counterweight. When two 42"-wide files with four drawers or two 42"-wide files with four drawers and a flipper door are ganged side to side, a counterweight must also be attached to each. The counterweight may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on any freestanding file or as a separate, field-installed option. Options Order the optional File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File (FAA20.), separately to convert side-to-side filing to front-to-back filing. Order the optional File Compressor (G5914.) for the pull-out shelf separately. Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) separately. Order the Counterweight (G5935.) separately if not specified as a permanent, factory-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 388 Storage Freestanding Storage H-Front Freestanding Lateral File FAH22. 2 Drawers FAH23. 3 Drawers FAH24. 4 Drawers FAH25. 4 Drawers with Flipper Door Description This lateral file holds letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. It has applied arc pulls, 1/2" adjustable glides, and a positive interlock system that permits only one drawer or pull-out shelf to open at a time. The actual file depth is 19 5/8". The actual file width is 29 5/8", 35 5/8", or 41 5/8". Raised feet, available on twodrawer units only, raise the file 1" and have 1/2" adjustable glides and a counterweight. Dimensions Widths are nominal 30", 36", and 42"; actual widths are 29 5/8", 35 5/8", and 41 5/8"; interior widths are 26 1/8", 32 1/8", and 38 1/8". MUST BE ANCHORED, GANGED TO ANOTHER FILE, OR STABILIZED WITH COUNTERWEIGHT Heights are 26 3/8" (2 drawers), 38 3/4" (3 drawers), 51 1/8" (4 drawers), and 64 1/2" (4 drawers with flipper door). Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8". Planning Considerations The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth that is at least 29" high. The width of the lateral file must be less than the clearance between the work surface supports. The glides have a 5/8" adjustment range to compensate for uneven floors. The raised-foot option adds 1 1/8" of adjustment to the height of the twodrawer file; the glides used with the raised feet also have a 5/8" adjustment range. L GLIDES PROVIDE fi«•" ADJUSTMENT RANGE W CLEARANCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS MUST BE EQUAL TO OR GREATER THAN WIDTH OF LATERAL FILE TO USE FILE BENEATH WORK SURFACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 389 Storage Freestanding Storage Each freestanding lateral file must be anchored, ganged to another file, or stabilized with a counterweight. When two 42"-wide files with four drawers or two 42"-wide files with four drawers and a flipper door are ganged side to side, a counterweight must also be attached to each. The counterweight may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on any freestanding file or as a separate, field-installed option. Options Order the optional File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File (FAA20.), separately to convert side-to-side filing to front-to-back filing. Order the optional File Compressor (G5914.) for the pull-out shelf separately. Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) separately. Order the Counterweight (G5935.) separately if not specified as a permanent, factory-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 390 Storage Freestanding Storage J-Front Freestanding Lateral File FAJ22. 2 Drawers FAJ23. 3 Drawers FAJ24. 4 Drawers FAJ25. 4 Drawers with Flipper Door Description This lateral file holds letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. It has applied Dshaped pulls, 1/2" adjustable glides, and a positive interlock system that permits only one drawer or pull-out shelf to open at a time. The actual file depth is 19 5/8". The actual file width is 29 5/8", 35 5/8", or 41 5/8". Raised feet, available on twodrawer units only, raise the file 1" and have 1/2" adjustable glides and a counterweight. Dimensions Widths are nominal 30", 36", and 42"; actual widths are 29 5/8", 35 5/8", and 41 5/8"; interior widths are 26 1/8", 32 1/8", and 38 1/8". Heights are 26 3/8" (2 drawers), 38 3/4" (3 drawers), 51 1/8" (4 drawers), and 64 1/2" (4 drawers with flipper door). MUST BE ANCHORED, GANGED TO ANOTHER FILE, OR STABILIZED WITH COUNTERWEIGHT Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8". Planning Considerations The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth that is at least 29" high. The width of the lateral file must be less than the clearance between the work surface supports. The glides have a 5/8" adjustment range to compensate for uneven floors. The raised-foot option adds 1 1/8" of adjustment to the height of the twodrawer file; the glides used with the raised feet also have a 5/8" adjustment range. L GLIDES PROVIDE fi«•" ADJUSTMENT RANGE W CLEARANCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS MUST BE EQUAL TO OR GREATER THAN WIDTH OF LATERAL FILE TO USE FILE BENEATH WORK SURFACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 391 Storage Freestanding Storage Each freestanding lateral file must be anchored, ganged to another file, or stabilized with a counterweight. When two 42"-wide files with four drawers or two 42"-wide files with four drawers and a flipper door are ganged side to side, a counterweight must also be attached to each. The counterweight may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on any freestanding file or as a separate, field-installed option. Options Order the optional File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File (FAA20.), separately to convert side-to-side filing to front-to-back filing. Order the optional File Compressor (G5914.) for the pull-out shelf separately. Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) separately. Order the Counterweight (G5935.) separately if not specified as a permanent, factory-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 392 Storage Freestanding Storage G-Series Lateral Files All G-Series lateral files are designed to be visually compatible with all Herman Miller systems and freestanding furniture. Front Styles G-Series pedestals and lateral files offer two different drawer fronts: • The B-front option has full-width, recessed pulls and comes in a solid-color finish only. • The C-front option has centered, recessed pulls and can be specified either with a solid-color finish or with recut or natural veneer drawer fronts. G-SERIES LATERAL FILES B-FRONT OPTION: FULL-WIDTH, RECESSED PULLS C-FRONT OPTION: CENTERED, RECESSED PULLS Sizes G-Series freestanding lateral files are available in nominal 30", 36", and 42" widths, with two, three, or four drawers. Lateral files come with adjustable glides that compensate for uneven floors but do not significantly affect the height of the file. Keying and Lock Options G-Series freestanding storage units are available only with individually keyed locks or keyed-alike locks; they are not available without locks. If desired, all lockable drawers and pedestals can be keyed alike; this means that one key can be used to lock and unlock a group of components, whether wall attached, work surface attached, or freestanding. Keyed-alike components are shipped with lock cylinders installed and with lock plugs shipped separately and tagged for product and location as specified. When the keyed-alike option is not specified, all lock cylinders and plugs are shipped installed and randomly numbered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 393 Storage Freestanding Storage B-Front Freestanding Lateral File G5210.B 2 Drawers G5220.B 3 Drawers G5230.B 4 Drawers Description This lockable lateral file holds letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. It has full-width, recessed pulls; 1/2" adjustable glides; and a positive interlock system that permits only one drawer to open at a time. The actual file depth is 19 5/8". The actual file width is 29 5/8", 35 5/8", or 41 5/8". Dimensions Widths are nominal 30", 36", and 42"; actual widths are 29 5/8", 35 5/8", and 41 5/8"; interior widths are 26 1/8", 32 1/8", and 38 1/8". MUST BE ANCHORED, GANGED TO ANOTHER FILE, OR STABILIZED WITH COUNTERWEIGHT Heights are 26 3/8" (2 drawers), 41 1/8" (3 drawers), and 53 1/2" (4 drawers). Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8". Planning Considerations The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth that is at least 29" high. The width of the lateral file must be less than the clearance between the work surface supports. GLIDES PROVIDE fi«•" ADJUSTMENT RANGE The glides have a 5/8" adjustment range to compensate for uneven floors. Each freestanding lateral file must be anchored, ganged to another file, or stabilized with a counterweight. When two 42"-wide files with four drawers are ganged side to side, a counterweight must also be attached to each. W CLEARANCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS MUST BE EQUAL TO OR GREATER THAN WIDTH OF LATERAL FILE TO USE FILE BENEATH WORK SURFACE The counterweight may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on any freestanding file or as a separate, field-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 394 Storage Freestanding Storage Options Order the optional File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File (FAA20.), separately to convert side-to-side filing to front-to-back filing. Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) separately. Order the Counterweight (G5935.) separately if not specified as a permanent, factory-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 395 Storage Freestanding Storage C-Front Freestanding Lateral File G5210.C 2 Drawers G5220.C 3 Drawers G5230.C 4 Drawers Description This lockable lateral file holds letter-, legal-, and A4-size hanging files. It has centered, recessed pulls; 1/2" adjustable glides; and a positive interlock system that permits only one drawer to open at a time. The actual file depth is 19 5/8". The actual file width is 29 5/8", 35 5/8", or 41 5/8". Pulls on a file with a solid color front match the front finish; pulls on a file with a veneer front match the case finish. Dimensions Widths are nominal 30", 36", and 42"; actual widths are 29 5/8", 35 5/8", and 41 5/8"; interior widths are 26 1/8", 32 1/8", and 38 1/8". MUST BE ANCHORED, GANGED TO ANOTHER FILE, OR STABILIZED WITH COUNTERWEIGHT Heights are 26 3/8" (2 drawers), 41 1/8" (3 drawers), and 53 1/2" (4 drawers). Depth is nominal 20"; actual depth is 19 5/8". Planning Considerations The two-drawer lateral file can be located under a work surface of any depth that is at least 29" high. The width of the lateral file must be less than the clearance between the work surface supports. GLIDES PROVIDE fi«•" ADJUSTMENT RANGE The glides have a 5/8" adjustment range to compensate for uneven floors. Each freestanding lateral file must be anchored, ganged to another file, or stabilized with a counterweight. When two 42"-wide files with four drawers are ganged side to side, a counterweight must also be attached to each. W CLEARANCE BETWEEN WORK SURFACE SUPPORTS MUST BE EQUAL TO OR GREATER THAN WIDTH OF LATERAL FILE TO USE FILE BENEATH WORK SURFACE The counterweight may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on any freestanding file or as a separate, field-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 396 Storage Freestanding Storage Options Order the optional File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File (FAA20.), separately to convert side-to-side filing to front-to-back filing. Order the optional File Drawer Organizer (B4961.) separately. Order the Counterweight (G5935.) separately if not specified as a permanent, factory-installed option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 397 Storage Freestanding Storage File Converter, Freestanding Lateral File FAA20. Description These black umber brackets convert any freestanding lateral file drawer to hold letter, legal-, and A4-size front-to-back hanging files. Two converters are used per drawer. Package contains four. The file converter package for the 36"wide file includes two file adapters to maximize filing capacity; use one adapter per drawer. Dimensions Available to fit 30"-, 36"-, and 42"-wide drawers. FILE CONVERTER Planning Considerations Two file converters are required in each drawer for front-to-back, letter-size filing. One end of the hanging file attaches over the converter, the other over the side of the file drawer. In wider drawers, where there is a middle front-to-back row of files, the files hang over both converters. The file converter package for 36"-wide files also includes two file adapters to maximize filing capacity for letter-size filing (use one adapter per drawer). L IN MIDDLE ROW, FILES HANG BETWEEN 2 CONVERTERS FOR END ROWS, FILES ATTACH OVER DRAWER SIDE AND CONVERTER Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 398 Storage Freestanding Storage Counterweight G5935. Description This counterweight attaches to the inside back of a freestanding lateral file to stabilize a file that is not anchored or ganged to another file. The counterweight for a 30"-wide file includes two plates; the counterweight for a 36"- or 42"-wide file includes four plates. Dimensions Width is 11". Height is 19". Planning Considerations Counterweights may be specified as a permanent, factory-installed option on files or—by specifying this product number—as a separate product for field installation. L COUNTERWEIGHTS STABILIZE FILE WHEN NOT ANCHORED OR GANGED Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 399 Display Components Introduction Display Components Introduction The Action Office system provides both tackable and writing surfaces for the vertical display of information in office and conference areas. There are also clips and hangers to hold artwork, presentation papers, drawings, coats, umbrellas, and other items on a vertical panel surface. Tackboards are available in the rounded-corner A-style, as well as the rolled-edge B-style for tackboards and marker boards. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 401 Display Components A-Style Tackboard AO610. Description This tackboard displays notes, photographs, or art. It has a fabric surface and includes attachment hardware. This single-sided tackboard attaches to a panel or wall strip. Dimensions Heights are 11 1/2", 15 1/2", 30", and 48". (The 30" height is available only in a 30" width; the 48" height is available only in 24" and 48" widths. The 11 1/2" height is not available in a 36" width.) Widths are 24", 30", 36", 48", and 60". Planning Considerations Tackboards can be suspended at any height. ATTACHES TO PANELS OR WALL STRIPS TASK LIGHT 15 ⁄«™" TACKBOARD 11 ⁄«™" TACKBOARD (ALLOWS ROOM FOR TOOL BAR BELOW) TOOL BAR WORK SURFACE AT HEIGHT OF 29" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 402 Display Components A-Style Marker Board AO630. Description This board attaches to a panel or wall strips and has a white, erasable writing surface. It includes a 20"-wide tray and attachment hardware. Dimensions Available in three sizes: • 24" high by 48" wide • 30" high by 30" wide • 48" high by 48" wide Planning Considerations In placing the marker board, allow clearance for the 2 7/8"-deep marker/ eraser trough. ATTACHES TO PANELS OR WALL STRIPS The tray is always 20" wide, regardless of the width of the marker board. 20"-WIDE TRAY ON MARKER BOARD OF ANY WIDTH L PROTRUDES 2 ‡«•" FROM WALL OR PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 403 Display Components Display Clip AO640. Description This clip hangs from the top of a panel to hold notes, drawings, or presentation papers. Finish is medium tone. Package contains two. Dimensions Width is 2 1/2". Height is 2 1/4". HOOKS OVER RECTANGULAR PANEL TOP CAP AT ANY POINT ALONG PANEL WIDTH Depth is 3". Planning Considerations Because the portion of the display clip that hooks over the top is squared, the display clip can be attached only to panels with rectangular top caps. The display clip can be attached at any point along the panel width. Limitations The display clip cannot be used on a panel with an oval top cap. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 404 Display Components B-Style Tackboard A3410. Description This tackboard attaches to a panel or wall strips to display notes, photographs, or art. It has a fabric surface and includes attachment hardware. Dimensions Available in 12", 16", 20", 30", and 48" heights and in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths. The 30" height is available only in a 30" width; the 48" height is available only in a 48" width. ATTACHES TO PANELS OR WALL STRIPS Planning Considerations Tackboards can be suspended at any height. TASK LIGHT 20" TACKBOARD 16" TACKBOARD (ALLOWS ROOM FOR TOOL BAR BELOW) TOOL BAR WORK SURFACE AT HEIGHT OF 29" L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 405 Display Components B-Style Marker Board A3510. Description This board attaches to a panel or wall strips and has a white, erasable writing surface. It includes a 20"-wide tray and attachment hardware. Dimensions Available in three sizes: • 24" high by 48" wide • 30" high by 30" wide • 48" high by 48" wide Planning Considerations In placing the marker board, allow clearance for the 2 7/8"-deep marker/ eraser trough. ATTACHES TO PANELS OR WALL STRIPS The tray is always 20" wide, regardless of the width of the marker board. 20"-WIDE TRAY ON MARKER BOARD OF ANY WIDTH L PROTRUDES 2 ‡«•" FROM WALL OR PANEL Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 406 Lighting Introduction Lighting Introduction Herman Miller offers users a range of task lighting options to address performance requirements and cost issues in properly illuminating today’s office. These products address not only illumination, but also the issues of energy efficiency, energy codes, and visual performance requirements for paper tasks and the computer environment. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 407 Lighting Introduction Lighting Issues Although intensity, or quantity of light, is an important variable in determining task visibility, the quality of light actually has the greater impact. Quality of light, in terms of task visibility, is primarily related to the angle at which light strikes a task. Light from some angles can reduce task visibility, creating what is referred to as veiling reflections (reflected glare). With proper optical control, veiling reflections can be reduced and visual performance enhanced. REFLECTED GLARE Optical control is typically a function of the task light lens or a series of lenses and reflectors. When light passes through a well-designed and molded acrylic lens, it can be redirected at specifically designed angles. The proprietary lens used in Herman Miller’s standard and energy-efficient task lights significantly reduces veiling reflections by directing light onto the task from the appropriate angles. As well as providing high-quality illumination on the task, it also contains a series of prisms that eliminates any direct brightness if the task light is mounted above eye level. The Lumisoft task lights use dual, injection-molded batwing lenses, a metal shield, and an internal reflector to produce a patented optical system that delivers virtually glare-free illumination. The panel-mounted task light uses a pair of lenses that control the brightness of the fixture, if it is used above eye level, and provides a very high quality of task-level illumination. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 408 Lighting Introduction Planning Considerations for Lighting In office environments, several different types of lighting should be considered together to produce optimal comfort and productivity. These include general illumination, task lighting, daylight, and accent and display lighting. General Lighting General lighting provides background illumination for the entire office. Typically, it consists of recessed fluorescent fixtures, providing direct illumination. General lighting can also be provided by indirect fixtures that are pendent-mounted from the ceiling, integrated into the furniture, or wall mounted. Indirect fixtures illuminate the ceiling, which, in turn, reflects the light back down into the office space. Indirect lighting is sometimes referred to as ambient lighting, but technically any type of general illumination can be referred to as ambient lighting. DIRECT LIGHTING— PROJECTS LIGHT DIRECTLY DOWN INTO WORK SPACE INDIRECT LIGHTING— REFLECTS LIGHT FROM CEILING BEFORE LIGHT REACHES WORK SPACE Before energy conservation and the use of computers in the office, general lighting usually provided the intensity of light required for task performance. Today, opportunities exist for lowering the lighting intensity levels from general lighting systems if supplemental task lighting is provided at all task locations. Lower general lighting levels can significantly reduce energy loads and often create better visual environments, especially for computer tasks. The advent of electronic ballasts and long-life lamps has also enabled task lighting products to deliver the highest levels of visual performance and the greatest degree of lighting efficiency. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 409 Lighting Introduction Task Lighting Task lighting illuminates a specific work area within a work space. Current office lighting standards suggest the use of low-level general illumination (20 to 50 footcandles), supplemented by task lights to increase the illuminance level at specific task locations. For this application, the quality of light that illuminates the task is critical for good task visibility. Task lighting should utilize the best available optical control to avoid veiling reflections and direct glare when a task light is mounted above eye level. Offices with intensive computer usage require special considerations. When illumination for a paper task is adjacent to a computer screen, high-quality light is especially important and dimming control is a useful option. Providing lower lighting levels on the paper task may be helpful to balance the brightness between the two tasks for maximum comfort and performance, especially with dark-background computer screens. DIRECTS LIGHT ONTO WIDE WORK AREA Under-shelf task lights may not be useful with a computer located directly beneath the same shelf. The task light will primarily light the top of the monitor and perhaps create too much light in the area surrounding the computer. Eliminating the shelf above the monitor allows enough general lighting to surround the computer to create a better balance of brightness for the eye. LOW-LEVEL LIGHTING FROM SIDE IDEAL FOR LIGHTING PAPERWORK NEXT TO COMPUTER L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 410 Lighting Introduction Daylight While natural light in an office can have very positive psychological effects on workers, it must be used carefully or controlled to offset the dangers it poses. Daylight can cause severe vision problems, as it may produce glare, veiling reflections, and adaptation problems. Adaptation is the function of the eye adapting to various levels of brightness. Although the eye can adapt to tremendous variations of brightness, viewing brightness extremes simultaneously within a specific field of view can cause eye strain, fatigue, and a reduction of visual performance. (Sunlight is typically 100 times brighter than interior illumination levels. Even after passing through tinted glass, sunlight that strikes dark surfaces, such as carpeting, can exceed comfortable brightness recommendations. A cloudy sky can be 1,000 times brighter than a computer screen.) BRIGHTNESS OF DAYLIGHT IS NEARLY 1,000 TIMES THAT OF COMPUTER SCREEN To maintain the benefits of natural light and avoid the problems its excessive brightness can produce, careful planning and placement of furniture and equipment are required. Additionally, selection of window treatment and workstation orientation are critical. Selective placement of panels can provide an effective means of blocking excessive brightness and controlling views. In workstations that contain computers, care should be taken to avoid direct views of windows and sunlight or the reflection of daylight onto the computer screen. Accent and Display Lighting Accent and display lighting is used in the office environment to add visual interest and to create appropriate visual cues. Light can be used to define space, create a sense of orientation, and provide highlight and shadow, allowing for greater visual clarity. Accent and display lighting can entail using wall washing to highlight a vertical surface or using an under-shelf light to accent a display shelf. This type of lighting is especially important in offices using indirect lighting for general illumination. Such offices otherwise appear flat, dull, and uninteresting. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 411 Lighting Introduction Task Lighting Products Lamp All Herman Miller linear task lights use energy-efficient fluorescent lamps. The lamp is a T8, rapid-start lamp (265 ma., tri-phosphor), often referred to by its various trade names or designations as Octron (Osram-Sylvania) or Trimline (General Electric). The color temperature is 3,500 degrees Kelvin, which represents a neutral color temperature between warm and cool. A typical fixture, for use beneath a 48" shelf, uses a 36", 25-watt lamp, 5 watts less than a T12 lamp at 30 watts. This lamp also has fuller spectral distribution, which provides better color rendition; its color-rendition index is about 75. The life of this lamp is rated at 20,000 hours, based on operating the lamp for three hours every time it is started. With longer operating time per start, lamp life increases. Lens The basic task light uses an acrylic prismatic lens, which obscures the lamp and diffuses light. Its primary application is for secondary work surfaces and display areas. Herman Miller’s standard task light and energy-efficient task light use an injectionmolded, proprietary, batwing lens. This custom-designed, optical-control lens provides high-quality illumination across the work surface and limits direct fixture brightness when mounted above eye level. The transaction surface task light also uses a batwing lens. The Lumisoft task light uses dual, injection-molded batwing lenses; a metal shield; and an internal reflector to produce a patented optical system that delivers virtually glare-free illumination. The panel-mounted task light adds an overlay to a batwing lens to diffuse the light from the fluorescent tube over the entire surface of the batwing lens. This improves the quality of light and reduces direct fixture brightness. ELEVATION BATWING LENS PLAN VIEW WORK SURFACE BATWING LENS DIRECTS LIGHT AT AN ANGLE TO MINIMIZE REFLECTED GLARE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 412 Lighting Introduction Task Light Choices • Basic task light: A utilitarian housing/lens package. A basic task light for use in display areas and secondary task areas; developed to respond to situations requiring an economical initial cost. The fixture uses a T8, 3500K, rapid-start lamp, a prismatic lens, and a normal-power-factor magnetic ballast. • Standard task light: A task light for general applications providing high-quality illumination across the work surface. This fixture utilizes a batwing lens; a T8, 3500K, rapid-start lamp; and a normal-power-factor magnetic ballast. • Energy-efficient task light: A task light for general applications with minimum energy use that provides high-quality illumination across the work surface. This fixture will meet any local or state energy codes and utilizes a batwing lens; a T8, 3500K, rapid-start lamp; and a high-power-factor magnetic ballast. Options include an electronic ballast for additional energy savings and a three-level dimming option. • Lumisoft task light: A highly energy-efficient task light that provides task-level illumination with virtually no direct or reflected glare. This fixture uses dual highperformance batwing lenses, an energy-efficient electronic ballast, and a T8, 3500K, fluorescent lamp rated at 20,000 hours of operation. It can be specified with a three-way dimmer and an occupancy sensor. The light is available as a standard linear task light or as part of a chain of one starter light and up to seven add-on lights that can be powered from a single receptacle, yet retain their independent on-off function. • Panel-mounted task light: A highly energy-efficient linear task light that delivers high-quality task lighting in systems environments that do not have overhead storage components for attachment. It uses a batwing lens with an overlay, an electronic ballast, and a T8, 3500K, fluorescent lamp. • Pavo portable task light: A portable task light with the capability to be mounted where needed (on a panel or frame, on the back or side edge of a work surface, or on a freestanding base on a work surface) and be positioned to place illumination exactly where needed. The Pavo task light uses a computer-designed asymmetrical reflector that provides side-angle light distribution. The optical system is augmented by an ergonomic fixture that is articulated to allow the light to be directed for completely glare-free illumination. The task light uses only a 13watt lamp to deliver 100 foot-candles of illumination on a task and has articulated arms and a grab ring for positioning the fixture. • Transaction surface task light: A light that mounts under an Action Office transaction surface or an Arrio desktop shelf unit to provide uniform illumination across a work surface. This fixture uses a batwing lens, an electronic ballast, and a T8, 3500K, fluorescent lamp. In addition, Herman Miller’s task light offering includes an adapter that allows task lights to be mounted under storage/display shelves. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 413 Lighting Task Light, Basic G6130. G6131. (Chicago) Description This light mounts under a flipper door unit or shelf to light a work surface. It has a normal-power-factor ballast and includes a T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature. The light is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware and three cord management clips are included. The 24"-wide light includes one preheat fluorescent lamp; 30"- to 60"-wide lights include one rapid-start fluorescent lamp. The 60"-wide light can be specified only with a 60"-wide flipper door unit or shelf; smaller lights cannot mount under 60"wide storage products. Dimensions Available in widths to match standard 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" shelf and flipper door unit widths. Planning Considerations This basic task light is designed to deliver lighting for use in display areas and for secondary work surfaces. It diffuses light with an acrylic prismatic lens and uses a housing with visible screws, making it the least expensive of Herman Miller task lights and particularly suitable for bid situations. The basic task light has a 7' grounded cord set that exits at the rear right corner and an on/off rocker switch located at the back right of the fixture’s exposed surface. (The Chicago version has a 6' cord set with a fuse plug.) Basic task lights are available to meet specialized municipal or national electrical requirements. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 414 Lighting Limitations The basic task light delivers a relatively low-quality illumination, resulting in low visual performance. It uses an acrylic prismatic lens, which diffuses light but cannot distribute it at specific angles to reduce glare and minimize veiling reflections. The 24"-wide task light, with its preheat fluorescent lamp, does not match the color rendition of the other sizes of this basic task light. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 415 Lighting Task Light, Standard G6150. G6151. (Chicago) G6153. (New York City) Description This light mounts under a flipper door unit or shelf to uniformly light a work surface. It has a normal-power-factor ballast and includes a T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature and batwing lens. The light is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware and three cord management clips are included. The 24"-wide light includes one preheat fluorescent lamp; 30"- to 60"-wide lights include one rapid-start fluorescent lamp. The 60"-wide light can be specified only with a 60"-wide flipper door unit or shelf; smaller lights cannot mount under 60"wide storage products. Dimensions Available in widths to match standard 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" shelf and flipper door unit widths. Planning Considerations This standard task light is designed to deliver inexpensive, highly uniform, general-purpose task lighting. It uses an acrylic, injection-molded batwing lens to project light across a user’s field of vision, reducing glare and minimizing veiling reflections. DIFFUSES LIGHT OVER ENTIRE WORK SURFACE The standard task light has a 7' grounded cord set that exits at the rear right corner and an on/off rocker switch located at the back center of the light. (The Chicago version has a 6' cord set with a fuse plug.) The 24"-wide light is most effective if it is used in conjunction with other lights, where it can be supplemented with spillover illumination from adjacent lights. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 416 Lighting Standard task lights are available to meet specialized municipal or national electrical requirements. Limitations The 24"-wide task light, with its preheat fluorescent lamp, does not match the color rendition of the other sizes of this standard task light. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 417 Lighting Task Light, Energy Efficient G6120. G6121. (Chicago) G6123. (New York City) Description This light mounts under a flipper door unit or shelf to uniformly light a work surface. It has an energy-efficient highpower-factor, magnetic ballast or an electronic ballast and includes a T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature and batwing lens. The light is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware and three cord management clips are included. The 24"-wide light includes one preheat fluorescent lamp; 30"- to 60"-wide lights include one rapid-start fluorescent lamp. The 60"-wide light can be specified only with a 60"-wide flipper door unit or shelf; smaller lights cannot mount under 60"wide storage products. Dimensions Available in widths to match standard 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" shelf and flipper door unit widths; nominal 24"wide task light available only with highpower-factor ballast without dimmer. LIGHTS ENTIRE WORK SURFACE Planning Considerations This task light is designed to deliver a very high degree of energy-efficient, highly uniform, general-purpose task lighting. It uses an acrylic, injectionmolded batwing lens to project light across a user’s field of vision, reducing glare and minimizing veiling reflections. This task light is available with either a high-power-factor, magnetic ballast (with or without dimming) or an electronic ballast without dimming. The highpower-factor, magnetic ballast with trilevel dimming provides a significant reduction in electrical consumption. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 418 Lighting The energy-efficient task light has a 9' grounded cord set that exits at the rear right corner and an on/off rocker switch located at the back center of the light. (The Chicago version has a 6' cord set with a fuse plug.) The 24"-wide light is most effective if it is used in conjunction with other lights, where it can be supplemented with spillover illumination from adjacent lights. Energy-efficient task lights are available to meet specialized municipal or national electrical requirements. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 419 Lighting Lumisoft Task Light G6140. Standard G6141. Standard (Chicago) G6142. Daisy Chain Starter G6143. Daisy Chain Add-On Description This light mounts under a flipper door unit or shelf to uniformly light a work surface. It has an electronic ballast, T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature, and dual batwing lenses. The light also has a patented optical system that effectively eliminates glare. It is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware is included. This light is available with a three-step dimmer and an occupancy sensor to automatically turn the light on and off. The 60"-wide light can be specified only with a 60"-wide flipper door unit or shelf; smaller lights cannot mount under 60"wide storage products. The standard and daisy chain starter lights have two cord management clips; the daisy chain add-on light has one. LIGHTS ENTIRE WORK SURFACE The daisy chain system allows a run of lights to be operated from a single power source. A series of add-on lights is plugged into one starter light to operate up to eight lights from a single outlet; each light has an independent on/ off switch. The daisy chain add-on light has a 24" cord. Dimensions Available in widths to match standard 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" shelf and flipper door unit widths. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 420 Lighting Planning Considerations This task light is designed to deliver the highest quality of energy-efficient, highly uniform task lighting. The daisy chain starter and add-on lights are designed for use in situations where a single receptacle must be used to power multiple lights. (The power source for the add-on light is a daisy chain starter task light or an add-on light attached to a daisy chain starter task light.) Because a daisy-chain configuration requires fewer receptacles for lighting, it can reduce significantly the number and expense of powered panels specified for a work station. The Lumisoft task light uses an internal reflector to diffuse the direct output of the lamp and redirect the light through two acrylic, injection-molded batwing lenses; this reduces glare and minimizes veiling reflections by keeping light from passing directly from the lamp to the task area. With its high-power-factor electronic ballast, it also provides a significant reduction in electrical consumption. This high-performance task light has a grounded cord set that exits at the rear and an on/off rocker switch located at the center of the light. The standard task light has a 9' cord set that exits at the center and can be routed to either the left or the right. (The Chicago version has a 9' cord set with a four-amp fuse plug.) The daisy chain starter also has a 9' cord set, but it exits on either the left or the right, depending on which is specified. (The exit location and plug-in location of the cord can be reversed later in the field.) The cord set on the add-on task light is 24" long; it also exits on either the left or the right, depending on which is specified. (The exit location and plug-in location of the cord can be reversed later in the field.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 421 Lighting This high-performance task light has an electronic ballast, with or without threelevel dimming. It is also available with an occupancy sensor option that automatically turns the light on and then off after an office is unoccupied for 15 minutes. The dimming mechanism and the occupancy sensor also play a role in reducing electrical consumption. Each standard Lumisoft task light requires its own receptacle; it cannot be used as a starter light to power Lumisoft add-on task lights in a chain. The Lumisoft starter and add-on task lights are required for that configuration. Each starter task light requires its own receptacle; but it can be used as a starter lamp to power add-on Lumisoft task lights in a chain. Up to eight task lights (one daisy chain starter and seven add-on lights) can be powered from one receptacle; each light is turned on and off independently, including the starter light. The starter light must be the first in the sequence of lights, with the other lights to either the right or the left, depending on the cord exit location specified. In specifying the right-hand starter light, the cord exit location is on the right-hand side of the light at the rear and the addon lights are plugged in on the left. The left-hand starter light has the cord exit location on the left and the add-on lights to the right. STARTER LIGHT MUST BE FIRST IN SEQUENCE REAR ADD-ON ADD-ON STARTER FRONT UP TO 7 ADD-ON LIGHTS INDEPENDENT ON/OFF FUNCTION 24" MAXIMUM OF 24" (FROM CORD EXIT LOCATION TO PLUG-IN LOCATION) ADD-ON (RIGHT EXIT) STARTER (RIGHT EXIT) STARTER (LEFT EXIT) ADD-ON (LEFT EXIT) REAR FRONT ADD-ON LIGHTS CAN BE ADDED AT LEFT OR RIGHT, BUT NOT BOTH (CAN BE REVERSED IN FIELD) If the configuration of the lighting changes or the lights are used in another location, however, the cord exit and plug-in locations on all the lights can be reversed and the add-on lights can be reattached in the opposite direction. Although shorter task lights can be used beneath wider flipper door units or shelves, a maximum of 24" (from cord exit location to plug-in location) is allowed between a daisy chain starter and adjacent add-on task lights that must be linked. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 422 Lighting A version of the standard task light is available to meet Chicago municipal codes; the standard task light meets electrical requirements for most other municipal or national codes, particularly New York City and Canada. Limitations There is no Lumisoft task light to fit beneath 24"-wide flipper door units or shelves. The daisy chain starter and add-on task lights do not meet Chicago, New York City, or San Francisco municipal codes; however, they meet specialized electrical requirements for most other municipal or national codes. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 423 Lighting Task Light, Transaction Surface G6220. G6221. (Chicago) Description This light mounts under an Action Office transaction surface or Arrio desktop shelf unit to uniformly light a work surface. It has an electronic ballast, T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature, and batwing lens. The light cannot be used with an Ethospace transaction surface or 24"-wide Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 transaction surface. It is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Available in nominal 20", 38", and 53" widths; actual widths are 20 3/4", 38", and 53 1/8" respectively. ATTACHES TO UNDERSIDE OF TRANSACTION SURFACE Planning Considerations This task light is intended to provide uniform lighting for task areas under an Action Office transaction surface or an Arrio desktop shelf unit. It uses an acrylic extruded batwing lens to bounce light across a user’s field of vision, reducing glare and minimizing veiling reflections. With its electronic ballast, it provides a significant reduction in electrical consumption. This task light has a 6' grounded cord set that exits at the rear center of the light and an on/off switch located at the back center of the light. (The Chicago version has a 6' cord set with a fuse plug.) For Action Office Series 1 and Series 2 Transaction Surfaces: The transaction surface can accept any transaction surface task light that is narrower in width. The exception is the 24"-wide transaction surface, which cannot accept any task light. For Action Office Series 3 Transaction Surfaces: In selecting the appropriate-width task light, allowance must be made for any overhanging ends on the transaction surface and any clearance taken up by dimension-adding connectors. The chart below recommends the appropriate task light width for each transaction surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 424 Lighting Transaction Surface Width Task Light Width 24"-37" 42" 43" 48"-55" 60" 62" 67"-86" 20" 38"* 20" 38"* 53"* 38"* 53"* * A shorter task light can also fit, but it provides less illumination. For Ethospace Transaction Surfaces: Ethospace transaction surfaces cannot accept any transaction surface task lights. For Arrio Desktop Shelf Units: The chart below recommends the appropriate task light width for each Arrio desktop shelf unit. Desktop Shelf Unit Width Task Light Width 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 20" 20" 20" 38"* 38"* * The 20"-wide task light can also fit, but it provides less illumination. Transaction surface task lights are available to meet specialized municipal or national electrical code requirements. Limitations The transaction surface task light cannot be used with an Ethospace transaction surface or a 24"-wide Action Office Series 1 or Series 2 transaction surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 425 Lighting Panel-Mounted Task Light G6230. G6231. (Chicago) Description This light hangs from an Action Office panel or Ethospace frame to uniformly light a work surface. It has an electronic ballast, T8 lamp with a 3500° Kelvin color temperature, and batwing lens with an overlay. The light has a 9/16" cord that exits from the left or right side. It is UL listed and CSA certified. Mounting hardware and two cord management clips are included. A wider light can mount on a narrower panel or frame. Dimensions Available in nominal widths to match standard 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" modular panel and frame widths. Cord extends 9/16" beyond edge of light at point of cord exit. Planning Considerations This task light is intended to light task areas that do not have a flipper door unit or shelf above them that will accept an undershelf task light. Because the mounting hardware can be placed at any position along the back of the light, the task light can be mounted off-module on a panel or frame that is narrower than the light. This allows a longer light to be centered, but extend beyond the sides of the panel or frame to which it is attached, or to extend offcenter beyond one or both sides of a panel or frame. This task light can also span adjacent panels or frames whose widths equal the width of the task light. This task light is designed to deliver the highest quality of energy-efficient, highly uniform, general-purpose task lighting. HEIGHT ADJUSTABLE IN 1" INCREMENTS BETWEEN 12"-24" 24" PANELS 24" 24" 42" 42" LIGHT, CENTERED ON 24"-WIDE PANEL 24" 24" 24" 42" 42" LIGHT, POSITIONED OFF-MODULE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 426 Lighting This task light uses an internal reflector to diffuse the direct output of the lamp; the light is redirected through an acrylic overlay and an extruded batwing lens with a series of precise optical prisms that direct light at angles to reduce glare and minimize veiling reflections. With its high-power-factor electronic ballast, it also provides a significant reduction in electrical consumption. The panel-mounted task light can be mounted at any height, in 1" increments, in the slots in the hanger rails at the sides of a panel or frame. (For effective lighting, however, the bottom of the light fixture should be between 12" and 24" above the work surface; 16" is recommended.) The light can be specified to hang on either Action Office panels or Ethospace frames, but the brackets for the task light are not interchangeable between the systems. (Brackets for mounting the light on another Herman Miller system are available as replacement parts. Action Office panel brackets can be substituted in the field for the Ethospace frame brackets, and vice versa, by ordering the replacement brackets directly from the Herman Miller customer service representative at Garcy/SLP, 1-800-2217913.) This task light has a 9' grounded cord set that exits at either the left or the right end plate and an on/off rocker switch located at the top right of the light. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 427 Lighting Because the cord extends 9/16" beyond the end of the light, certain planning considerations must be observed to prevent obstructions: • Two panel-mounted task lights mounted adjacent to one another at the same height must be specified so that the cords exit at the outside end of each. • When a panel-mounted task light is mounted next to a flipper door unit or shelf or to an Action Office tackboard, the cord must exit on the side opposite the hanging component. • The cord cannot exit at the corner of the workstation in any Ethospace corner configuration or in an Action Office Series 3 corner configuration with an adjacent flipper door unit, shelf, or tackboard. (This applies whether the panels or frames are of equal height or of unequal heights with a change-of-height finished end.) • When a flipper door unit, shelf, or Action Office tackboard is used in the corner of a corner configuration, a panel-mounted task light on the corner’s perpendicular wall must be at a height that does not interfere with the depth of the flipper door unit, shelf, or tackboard. Panel-mounted task lights are available to meet specialized municipal or national electrical requirements. Limitation In certain corner configurations, in certain change-of-height configurations, or in certain configurations carrying flipper door units, shelves, or tackboards, there is not sufficient clearance for the task light cord to exit. See the planning considerations for specific planning guidelines to deal with these situations. CORDS MUST EXIT AT OUTSIDE ENDS ADJACENT PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHTS AT SAME HEIGHT PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHT NEXT TO FLIPPER DOOR UNIT OR SHELF OR ACTION OFFICE TACKBOARD CORD CAN EXIT AT CORNER CORD CANNOT EXIT AT CORNER PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHT PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHT ETHOSPACE CORNER CONFIGURATION PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHT ACTION OFFICE CORNER CONFIGURATION ADJACENT HANGING COMPONENT ACTION OFFICE SERIES 3 PANELS— CORD CANNOT EXIT AT CORNER ACTION OFFICE SERIES 1 AND 2 PANELS—CORD CAN EXIT AT CORNER ACTION OFFICE CORNER CONFIGURATION WITH ADJACENT FLIPPER DOOR UNIT, SHELF, OR TACKBOARD PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHTS FLIPPER DOOR UNIT L CORD MUST EXIT OPPOSITE HANGING COMPONENTS PANEL-MOUNTED TASK LIGHT AND HANGING COMPONENT ON PERPENDICULAR WALL MUST BE AT DIFFERENT HEIGHTS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 428 Lighting Pavo Portable Task Light G6420. Description This light hangs from a panel or frame, clamps to a hanging or freestanding work surface, or sits on a work surface. It has a 13-watt compact fluorescent lamp, a grab ring on the fixture head, and adjustable arms that allow light to be directed. The arms extend up to 24" and rotate 360°. The fixture head pivots up 90°, down 40°, and rotates 360°. The arm pivot joints and base are black; the fixture head end plates, fixture head attachment, and arms are neutral accent colors. The light is UL listed and CSA certified. The light cannot clamp to the side of a Newhouse Group table desk, back of a 24"-deep Newhouse Group table desk, or side of a Flex-Edge work surface. The light cannot be panel or frame mounted in an Action Office Series 3 or Ethospace 90° corner. Dimensions Height of arm is 20" (two segments of 8" and 12"); height of light housing is 3 1/4". Depth of housing is 8 1/4"; with grab ring and pivot head, depth is 11 1/2". Depth of horizontal arm extension is 8". Width of housing is 9 1/2"; with grab ring, width is 15 1/4". Clamp mounting base is 2" wide, 4" (nominal) deep, and 5 1/2" high. Freestanding base is nominal 11 1/2" wide and 7 1/2" deep. Panel or frame mounting base is 2" wide and 3 1/4" high. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 429 Lighting Planning Considerations This task light is suitable in a number of situations: where totally glare-free illumination is required (because of the difficulty of the task or the importance of speed and accuracy to the task), where glossy materials are used, where there are no shelves to which a linear, highperformance task light can be mounted, and where task lighting is required on freestanding work surfaces. 3 MOUNTING OPTIONS Because it can be specified to mount in the slots of a hanger rail on a panel or frame, to clamp onto a work surface, or to be used freestanding on a work surface, the portable task light provides many options for positioning the fixture to provide glare-free illumination, for supplementing or replacing traditional under-shelf task lighting, or for providing lighting where traditional task lights cannot be used. The panel- or frame-mounted version comes with two brackets—one for mounting the light into the hanger rail slot on the left side of the panel and one for mounting the light into the vertical hanger rail slot on the right side of the panel. Because the combination of the bracket and the base of the fixture’s mounting arm extends across both hanger rail slots and slightly onto the adjacent panel or frame, no hanging components can be hung adjacent to the task light bracket. The panel- or frame-mounted version can be mounted at any height, in 1" increments, in the vertical hanger rails at the sides of the panel or frame. It can be specified to hang on either Action Office panels or Ethospace frames, but the brackets for the task light are not interchangeable between the systems. (The brackets for mounting the light on Action Office panels can be substituted in the field for the Ethospace frame brackets, and vice versa, by ordering the replacement brackets directly from the Herman Miller customer service representative at Garcy/SLP, 1-800-2217913.) L MOUNT ON PANEL OR FRAME CLAMP TO WORK SURFACE SIT FREESTANDING ON WORK SURFACE HANGING COMPONENTS CANNOT BE ATTACHED ADJACENT TO PANEL-MOUNTED LIGHT BRACKET AND ARM BASE EXTEND BEYOND HANGER RAIL SLOT ADJACENT TO ONE BEING USED FOR MOUNTING LIGHT Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 430 Lighting The clamp version can attach to all Herman Miller freestanding or hanging work surfaces. It can be attached at nearly any point along the back or sides of the work surface. (See “Limitations” for the few exclusions or restrictions.) No matter where the light is attached, however, it is critical to position the fixture head so that it does not bounce light directly into the worker’s eyes, causing reflected glare. For glare-free illumination, the fixture head should be placed to the side of the task, with the head of the fixture in a direction parallel to the task. (See illustration at right.) The fixture head should also be parallel to the surface being illuminated (see illustration at right) and be at or slightly below eye level. (On the panel-mounted version, the armature bracket should be attached close to the work surface for easiest positioning and for positioning the fixture head close enough to the work surface to prevent glare in the worker’s eyes.) POSITIONING OF PORTABLE TASK LIGHT PARALLEL TO ILLUMINATED SURFACE TO SIDE OF, AND PARALLEL TO, TASK To prevent the user from obstructing the illumination while working, the head of the fixture should be mounted to the left if the worker is right handed and to the right if the worker is left handed. (See illustration at right.) To aid in positioning the light over the work surface, the articulated arms allow the head to be adjusted over a radius of 24" (maximum). The grab ring encircling the head is used to position the light for effective illumination. (The arm has a tension adjustment at each pivot joint that allows the fixture to be tightened to lock it into place or remain looser for easier repositioning.) RIGHT HANDED—FIXTURE HEAD TO LEFT LEFT HANDED—FIXTURE HEAD TO RIGHT With the appropriate service parts, a panel-mounted, clamp, or freestanding version can be transformed into any one of the other versions. (These service parts are ordered directly from the Herman Miller customer service representative at Garcy/SLP, 1-800-2217913.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 431 Lighting This task light has a computer-designed optical system that provides superior asymmetrical light distribution, without direct or reflected glare. It features an energy-efficient 13-watt compact fluorescent lamp. It has a 120-volt magnetic ballast with a disconnect feature for easy routing of the cord and plug. It has a 9' cord set, in addition to the 24" of cord that follows the contours of the dual articulating arms; an on/off rocker switch is located in the back center on the fixture head. This task light meets electrical requirements for most municipal and national codes, particularly Chicago, New York City, and Canada. CLAMP MUST ALIGN WITH CUTOUTS Limitations The portable task light cannot be mounted in the slotted hanger strips at the 90° juncture of two Action Office Series 3 panels or Ethospace frames. In clamping the task light to the back of an Ethospace work surface, the clamp must be positioned to align with one of the cutouts in the trough. TROUGH ETHOSPACE WORK SURFACES The Pavo task light cannot clamp onto the side of a wall-attached or Arrio work surface at the point where the work surface support or leg is attached or onto the side of a wall-attached work surface when a work surface support panel is used. On Newhouse Group table desks, the light cannot be clamped to the side of any work surface because of the interference caused by the legs. The light also cannot be clamped to the back of a 24"-deep Newhouse work surface but can attach at the cable port opening. (The clamp does decrease the amount of room left for cable passage.) The light cannot be clamped to the side of a FlexEdge work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 432 Lighting Display Shelf Adapter, Task Light G6191. Description These dark tone adapters are used to mount a task light under an A- or B-style storage/display shelf. Two adapters are required for mounting the task light. Package contains two. Dimensions Height is 6 1/2". Depth is 9 5/8". Planning Considerations The adapter can be used with a basic, standard, or energy-efficient task light. The task light requires two adapters for mounting. PERMITS TASK LIGHT UNDER STORAGE/DISPLAY SHELF TO PROVIDE NORMAL WORK SURFACE LIGHTING This adapter can accommodate any size task light. Limitations This adapter cannot be used with the Lumisoft task light. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 433 Machine Support Tools Introduction Machine Support Tools Introduction Herman Miller provides a variety of freestanding and work surface-attached products to support the use of computers and other electronic equipment in offices. The products are adjustable, designed for the maximum amount of individual control. They can be a crucial element in employers’ efforts to make the workplace more accommodating for people with disabilities, as well as for the increasing number of workers who spend long hours working on computers. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 435 Machine Support Tools Introduction Ergonomic and Planning Considerations for Machine Support Tools Herman Miller machine support tools take into account not only the variety and amount of electronic equipment in a modern office, but also the human factors related to how effectively a worker can use that equipment. At the heart of these products is the ability to position the user, the equipment, and the documents in the right relationship to one another—for ease of viewing and ease of use. Often, machine support tools are used in conjunction with specialty work surfaces (such as heightadjustable work surfaces or ones with platforms to hold monitors), lighting, work tools, and seating to address the needs of the electronic office place. Achieving a more effective working environment through the use of machine support tools involves a number of issues: Distance from Monitors and Documents Monitors and documents that are too close to the worker require extra effort for near focusing; likewise, distances too great may make them hard to see. While a distance of 20" to 30" between the user and the equipment or documents is generally recommended, being able to meet personal preferences or the needs of multiple users is ideal. As the median age of the U.S. work force increases, there is likely to be a corresponding increase in the number of workers who want to view the monitor screen from further away to lessen eye fatigue. IDEAL DISTANCE: 20"–30" Herman Miller machine support tools, like document stands, equipment support stands, keyboard trays, and their supporting adjustable armatures, allow the user to properly align—and quickly reposition—documents and equipment to meet personal preferences or physiological needs. Keyboard trays and platforms, for example, incorporate a gravity-lock system that allows workers to set the position of their keyboard anywhere along a roughly 6" range of travel. They also offer extended, dualswivel arms that allow keyboard trays and platforms to fit into tight, L-shaped configurations; and a choice of long and short tracks that allows these machine support tools to be installed on narrower or irregularly shaped work surfaces. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 436 Machine Support Tools Introduction Range of User Sizes Situations like shared workstations, multi-shift operations, and free-address offices mean that a number of users, in a range of sizes and shapes, are likely to be using the same workstation at any given time for perhaps a wide range of tasks. SAME STATION, 2 DIFFERENT PEOPLE Adjustable keyboard trays—especially ones with a wide range of movement—make it easy to accommodate various sizes of users without changing the height of the work surface. (The extended arms on Herman Miller’s keyboard trays have an 8" vertical range.) The capability to adjust the keyboard tray allows a worker to avoid awkward postures by properly adjusting the keyboard to achieve neutral postures, which put the least amount of strain on body parts; the adjustable keyboard tray also minimizes awkward reaches or twisting motions by bringing the keyboard closer to the body. Products like Scooter® stands and turntables allow for shared use of equipment or enable a work area to be set up quickly to handle inputting. Alternatives to Keyboarding Now that computer use is common among workers of all types and at all levels, keyboards are no longer the sole input device. Over 95 percent of the personal computers currently sold can operate a mouse as well. Many workstations, however, force users to operate the mouse from awkward positions that increase their risk of injury. OVEREXTENDED POSITION AWKWARD POSITION Herman Miller offers a number of mouse tray options that attach either to keyboard trays or platforms directly or beneath the work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 437 Machine Support Tools Introduction Various Input Postures Computer users work in a variety of postures. Depending on the task being performed, the person’s stature, the type of chair being used, personal preference, and other factors, the worker can be sitting in a rigid posture, a reclined position, or any position between these two extremes. The posture chosen can have an effect on the angle of the keyboard tray or platform. For example, setting the keyboard at a negative angle when working from an upright posture is an acceptable position and is becoming more common. As a result, Herman Miller keyboard trays and platforms incorporate 30 degrees of tilt in the trays (+15/-15 degrees from the neutral position). NEED FOR KEYBOARD TRAY TO CHANGE ANGLE OF KEYBOARD TO MATCH SEATED POSTURE Workers with Special Needs As the U.S. work force ages and its median age increases, the incidence of users with limited grip is rising. (This limited-grip problem can also be one of the frequent results of carpal tunnel surgery.) Similarly, the diversity of that work force has added more workers to the lower end of the anthropometric scale and workers of smaller stature can experience problems adjusting keyboard trays. Most of these problems are related to supporting the weight of the keyboard and tray while adjusting the height of the product. This weight can, in extreme cases, be in excess of 15 pounds. Recognizing these problems, Herman Miller has incorporated into its product line mechanisms that can address these issues. Several Herman Miller input-device support products are available with an alternative to the standard knob. A paddle mechanism allows workers with limited grip strength or similar problems to adjust their keyboard tray or platform—difficult or impossible for them to do in the past. All Herman Miller keyboard trays and platforms also include an internal spring that assists the user in adjusting the height of the product. The spring, in conjunction with the single adjustment knob, simplifies the adjustment process for all workers. While providing solutions to these needs is not the sole domain of machine support tools, they can play a significant role in providing ergonomic benefits to workers. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 438 Machine Support Tools Keyboard Holder with Palm Rest, Fully Adjustable G7719. Description This black umber holder attaches to a rectangular or corner work surface to hold a detached keyboard. It has an extended-length arm that extends 8". The holder has horizontal and tilt adjustments and swivels for storage beneath the work surface. It tilts over a 30° range (-15° to +15°) and has an 8" vertical range; a padded palm rest adjusts vertically over a 1 1/8" range. The holder adjusts for keyboards 5 1/2" to 9" deep. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The holder is available with a 17 3/4"- or 21"-long track. The paddle option allows easier adjustment for individuals with limited grasping ability. Dimensions Palm rest width is 19 1/2". 8" VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT 12 ‹«¢" Depth is 12 3/4" (from front edge of palm rest to back edge of clamps). Length of track is 21" for standard track, 17 3/4" for short track. Planning Considerations This keyboard holder uses rubber-tipped clamps that adjust to the depth of the keyboard. Since the holder clamps to the keyboard, it keeps the keyboard from slipping backward when positioned at a negative angle. TILT -15Å TO +15Å PADDED PALM REST (1 ⁄«•" VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT) CLAMPS ADJUST TO FIT KEYBOARDS 5 ⁄«™" TO 9" DEEP The clamp mechanism of the holder is particularly suited to small corners, since it requires only enough space for the keyboard itself (there is no tray). The extended-length arm on the keyboard holder allows the keyboard holder to clear the adjacent edges of a 36"-wide corner work surface or provides additional extension wherever needed. The shorter track allows the keyboard holder to fit beneath narrower-depth work surfaces. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 439 Machine Support Tools The keyboard holder, with either a knob or a paddle adjustment, extends 6" below the bottom of the work surface in its stored position. The palm rest is independently adjustable, allowing the user to adjust the height to accommodate any keyboard thickness or personal work preference. This fully adjustable keyboard holder provides a great deal of flexibility in accommodating workers who are in wheelchairs or who have physical challenges. The paddle option allows easier vertical adjustment for individuals with grasp limitations. This keyboard holder also provides the highest level of adjustment for workers who spend much of their workday at a computer. The keyboard holder can be used with the following work surfaces: • 36"-, 42"-, and 48"-wide corner work surfaces • 24"- and 30"-deep hanging rectangular systems work surfaces (holder may not completely fit under a 24"-deep work surface for storage, especially with the shorter track) • all peninsula work surfaces • all 30"- and 36"-deep Action Office rectangular freestanding work surfaces • some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes (See the "Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) An optional mouse tray can be attached to the side of the keyboard holder. Options Order the optional Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 440 Machine Support Tools Limitations The keyboard holder can be used with 24"-deep freestanding work surfaces and with returns only if the short track is ordered. The keyboard holder may not completely store under a 24"-deep work surface, even with the short-track option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 441 Machine Support Tools Keyboard Platform, Extended Dual Swivel, with Standard Tray G7720.T Description This platform attaches to a rectangular or corner work surface to support a detached keyboard. It has an extendedlength arm that extends 8". The platform has horizontal, vertical, and tilt adjustments and swivels for storage beneath the work surface. It tilts over a 30° range (-15° to +15°) and has a spring-assisted arm to ease the 8" vertical adjustment. Swivel points at both ends of the arm allow a variety of positions while remaining parallel with the edge of the work surface. The platform is predrilled for a mouse tray. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. PIVOT POINTS DUAL-SWIVEL ARM ALLOWS 18" PIVOT TO LEFT OR RIGHT 8" VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT TILT -15Å TO +15Å The platform is available with a 17 3/4"or 21"-long track. 10" DEEP Dimensions Width is 22". Depth is 10". Length of track is 21" for standard track, 17 3/4" for short track. Planning Considerations The two swivel points on this keyboard platform—one at each end of the armature—allow users to pivot the keyboard about 18" to the right or left while still keeping it parallel to the edge of the work surface. This dual swivel and the extended-length arm enable the user to position the keyboard to either side for left- or right-handed mousing. The platform can be mounted in tight corners formed by rectangular work surfaces, or on work surfaces with irregular or curved edges. On systems work surfaces with different depths, the dual pivots allow a computer to be placed at either end or both ends of the work surface and a keyboard platform to be mounted under the work surface between them; the keyboard platform can be oriented either way. L DUAL-SWIVEL ARM ALLOWS KEYBOARD TO CLEAR TIGHT 90Å ANGLES… …AND IRREGULAR OR CURVED EDGES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 442 Machine Support Tools The shorter track allows the keyboard platform to fit beneath narrower work surfaces. The keyboard platform extends 6" below the bottom of the work surface in its stored position. The dual-swivel keyboard platform provides a high degree of flexibility for accommodating workers who are in wheelchairs or who have physical challenges. It also provides the highest level of adjustment for workers who spend much of their workday at a computer. The keyboard platform can be used with the following work surfaces: • 36"-, 42"-, and 48"-wide corner work surfaces • 24"- and 30"-deep hanging rectangular systems work surfaces (holder may not completely fit under a 24"-deep work surface for storage, especially with the shorter track) • all peninsula work surfaces • all 30"- and 36"-deep Action Office rectangular freestanding work surfaces • some Arrio freestanding rectangular work surface sizes and front edge configurations (See the “Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) This standard-tray version can accept an optional palm rest. An optional mouse tray, ordered separately, can be attached to the side of the keyboard platform. Options Order the optional Palm Rest, Keyboard Tray (G7790.), separately. Order the optional Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 443 Machine Support Tools Limitations The keyboard platform can be used with 24"-deep freestanding work surfaces and with returns only if the short track is ordered. The keyboard platform may not completely store under a 24"-deep work surface, even with the short-track option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 444 Machine Support Tools Keyboard Platform, Extended Dual Swivel, with Clamp Tray G7720.C Description This black umber platform attaches to a rectangular or corner work surface to support a detached keyboard. It has an extended-length arm that extends 8". The platform has horizontal, vertical, and tilt adjustments and swivels for storage beneath the work surface. It tilts over a 30° range (-15° to +15°) and adjusts for keyboards 5 1/2" to 9" deep. The spring-assisted arm eases the 8" vertical adjustment. Swivel points at both ends of the arm allow a variety of positions while remaining parallel with the edge of the work surface. 8" VERTICAL Attachment hardware is included. ADJUSTMENT Shipped knocked down. PIVOT POINTS DUAL-SWIVEL ARM ALLOWS 18" PIVOT TO LEFT OR RIGHT 12 ‹«¢" The platform is available with a 17 3/4"or 21"-long track. TILT -15Å TO +15Å Dimensions Width is 19 1/2". Depth is 12 3/4". PADDED PALM REST (1 ⁄«•" VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT) Length of track is 21" for standard track, 17 3/4" for short track. Planning Considerations The two swivel points on this keyboard platform—one at each end of the armature—allow users to pivot the keyboard about 18" to the right or left while still keeping it parallel to the edge of the work surface. This dual swivel and the extended-length arm enable the user to position the keyboard to either side for left- or right-handed mousing. The platform can be mounted in tight corners formed by rectangular work surfaces, or on work surfaces with irregular or curved edges. On systems work surfaces with different depths, the dual pivots allow a computer to be placed at either end or both ends of the work surface and a keyboard platform to be mounted under the work surface between them; the keyboard platform can be oriented either way. L DUAL-SWIVEL ARM ALLOWS KEYBOARD TO CLEAR TIGHT 90Å ANGLES… CLAMPS ADJUST TO FIT KEYBOARDS 5 ⁄«™" TO 9" DEEP KNOB ADJUSTS HORIZONTAL AND TILT MOVEMENT …AND IRREGULAR OR CURVED EDGES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 445 Machine Support Tools The shorter track allows the keyboard platform to fit beneath narrower work surfaces. The keyboard platform with the clamp tray uses rubber-tipped clamps that adjust to the depth of the keyboard to keep the keyboard from slipping backward when positioned at a negative angle. The clamp mechanism is suited to small corners, since it requires only enough space for the keyboard itself (there is no tray). The clamp-tray version also features an adjustable palm rest that accommodates any keyboard thickness or personal work preference. The keyboard platform extends 6" below the bottom of the work surface in its stored position. The dual-swivel keyboard platform provides a high degree of flexibility for accommodating workers who are in wheelchairs or who have physical challenges. It also provides the highest level of adjustment for workers who spend much of their workday at a computer. The keyboard platform can be used with the following work surfaces: • 36"-, 42"-, and 48"-wide corner work surfaces • 24"- and 30"-deep hanging rectangular systems work surfaces (holder may not completely fit under a 24"-deep work surface for storage, especially with the shorter track) • all peninsula work surfaces • all 30"- and 36"-deep Action Office rectangular freestanding work surfaces • some Arrio freestanding rectangular work surface sizes and front edge configurations (See the “Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) An optional mouse tray, ordered separately, can be attached to the side of the keyboard platform. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 446 Machine Support Tools Options Order the optional Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray (G7740.C), separately. Limitations The keyboard platform can be used with 24"-deep freestanding work surfaces and with returns only if the short track is ordered. The keyboard platform may not completely store under a 24"-deep work surface, even with the short-track option. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 447 Machine Support Tools Keyboard Tray, Fully Adjustable G7715. Description This tray attaches to a work surface to support a detached keyboard. It has horizontal, vertical, and tilt adjustments and swivels for storage beneath the work surface. The tray tilts over a 30° range (-15° to +15°) and has a standardor extended-length arm that is spring assisted to ease vertical adjustment. It is predrilled for a mouse tray. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. The standard-length arm extends 4" and has a 5 3/4" vertical range. The extended-length arm extends 8" and has an 8" vertical range; it is available with a 17 3/4"- or 21"-long track. The paddle option allows easier adjustment for individuals with limited grasping ability. Dimensions Tray width is 22". Tray depth is 10". Standard-length arm (G7715.04) extends 4" on 17 3/4"-long track, with 5 3/4" vertical range. Extended-length arm (G7715.08) extends 8" on 21"-long or 17 3/4"-long track, with 8" vertical range. Planning Considerations The keyboard tray can be ordered with either a standard-length arm or an extended-length arm. The extendedlength arm allows the tray to clear the adjacent edges of a 36"-wide corner work surface or provide additional extension wherever needed. TILT -15Å TO +15Å 5 ‹«¢" The shorter track allows the keyboard tray with extended-length arm to fit beneath narrower-depth work surfaces. Specify the extended-length arm for use with corner work surfaces, 30"-deep rectangular hanging work surfaces, or Arrio concave corner table desks or when greater arm extension is needed. L KEYBOARD TRAY LOCKS IN POSITION IN USE KEYBOARD STORES BENEATH WORK SURFACE WHEN NOT IN USE SINGLE KNOB OR PADDLE ON ARM MECHANISM FOR BOTH HEIGHT AND TILT ADJUSTMENTS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 448 Machine Support Tools The keyboard tray with either a knob or a paddle adjustment extends 6" below the bottom of the work surface in its stored position. The fully adjustable keyboard tray provides a high degree of flexibility for accommodating workers who are in wheelchairs or who have physical challenges. The paddle option allows easier vertical adjustment for individuals with grasp limitations. This keyboard tray also provides the highest level of adjustment for workers who spend much of their workday at a computer. The keyboard tray can be used with the following work surfaces: • 42"- and 48"-wide hanging corner work surfaces; 36"-wide hanging work surfaces (with extended-length arm only) • 24"- and 30"-deep hanging rectangular systems work surfaces (keyboard tray with extended-length arm may not completely fit under a 24"-deep work surface for storage, especially with the shorter track) • all peninsula work surfaces • all 30"- and 36"-deep Action Office rectangular freestanding work surfaces and—with the standardlength arm—24"-deep freestanding work surfaces • some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes and front edge configurations (See the “Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The keyboard tray accepts the optional palm rest to provide a soft front edge. An optional mouse tray can be attached to the side of the keyboard tray. Options Order the optional Palm Rest, Keyboard Tray (G7790.), separately. Order the optional Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T), separately. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 449 Machine Support Tools Limitations The keyboard tray with extended-length arm can be used with 24"-deep freestanding work surfaces and with returns only if the short track is ordered. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 450 Machine Support Tools Keyboard Tray, Adjustable G7716. Description This tray attaches to a work surface to support a detached keyboard. It has horizontal and tilt adjustments and swivels for storage beneath the work surface. The tray height is fixed at 2 1/4" below the bottom of the work surface. It is predrilled for a mouse tray. Attachment hardware is included. Shipped knocked down. TILT 0Å–15Å 3 ‹«•" FIXED Dimensions Tray width is 22". Tray depth is 10". Length of track is 17 3/4". Planning Considerations The adjustable keyboard tray tilts 15° and extends 6" below the bottom of the work surface in its stored position. KEYBOARD STORES BENEATH WORK SURFACE WHEN NOT IN USE While it does not have a vertical adjustment, the adjustable keyboard tray offers some flexibility in accommodating workers who are in wheelchairs or who have physical challenges. It also offers horizontal and tilt adjustments for workers who spend much of their workday at a computer. The keyboard tray can be used with the following work surfaces: • all hanging corner work surfaces • 24"- and 30"-deep hanging rectangular systems work surfaces • all peninsula work surfaces • all freestanding Action Office rectangular work surfaces • some Arrio freestanding work surface sizes and front edge configurations (See the “Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) The keyboard tray accepts the optional palm rest to provide a soft front edge. An optional mouse tray can be attached to the side of the keyboard tray. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 451 Machine Support Tools Options Order the optional Palm Rest, Keyboard Tray (G7790.), separately. Order the optional Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray (G7740.T), separately. Limitations The adjustable keyboard tray does not have vertical adjustability. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 452 Machine Support Tools Palm Rest, Keyboard Tray G7790. Description This palm rest provides a soft contact surface on the front edge of a keyboard tray. Finish is black umber. Dimensions Width is 18". Planning Considerations The palm rest can be attached to most Herman Miller keyboard trays. Limitations The palm rest cannot be used with the following products: • Extended dual-swivel keyboard platform with clamp tray • Fully adjustable keyboard holder with palm rest • Action Office keyboard drawer without lock • Burdick Group™ keyboard tray • Scooter stand L SLIPS ONTO FRONT EDGE OF KEYBOARD TRAY Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 453 Machine Support Tools Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Standard Tray G7740.T Description This tray attaches to a keyboard tray or to an extended dual-swivel keyboard platform with standard tray to support a mouse or other input device. Its tilt mechanism allows the tray to remain flat when the keyboard holder is tilted. The tray swivels for storage beneath the keyboard and can be installed on the left or right side. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 8"; depth is 8". Mouse tray for standard tray fits flush to keyboard tray and extends 8" from right or left of keyboard tray. CAN ALSO ATTACH ON LEFT Planning Considerations The polycarbonate surface is conducive to moving and tracking with an input device. ATTACHES TO KEYBOARD TRAY OR EXTENDED DUAL-SWIVEL KEYBOARD PLATFORM 30Å TILT 8" 8" The keyboard product to which the mouse tray attaches must be ordered separately. These products include the fully adjustable keyboard tray, the adjustable keyboard tray, and the extended dual-swivel keyboard platform with standard tray. Limitations This mouse tray cannot be attached directly to a work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 454 Machine Support Tools Mouse Tray, Keyboard Tray Attached, Clamp Tray G7740.C Description This tray attaches to a keyboard holder with palm rest or to an extended dualswivel keyboard platform with clamp tray to support a mouse or other input device. Its tilt mechanism allows the tray to remain flat when the keyboard holder is tilted. The tray swivels for storage beneath the keyboard and can be installed on the left or right side. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 8"; depth is 8". Mouse tray for clamp tray extends 14", 15", or 16" from right or left of swivel mechanism base (to fit different-size keyboard trays). Planning Considerations The polycarbonate surface is conducive to moving and tracking with an input device. This mouse tray with clamp tray can be mounted in one of three positions, depending on the width of the keyboard being used. CAN ALSO ATTACH ON LEFT 30Å TILT ATTACHES TO KEYBOARD HOLDER OR EXTENDED DUAL-SWIVEL KEYBOARD PLATFORM TOTAL EXTENSION 14"-16" 8" 8" The keyboard product to which the mouse tray attaches must be ordered separately. These products include the fully adjustable keyboard holder with palm rest and the extended dual-swivel keyboard platform with clamp tray. Limitations This mouse tray cannot be attached directly to a work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 455 Machine Support Tools Mouse Tray, Work Surface Attached G7741. Storable G7742. Adjustable/Storable Description This tray attaches to a work surface and supports a mouse or other input device. It swivels for storage beneath the work surface. The tray cannot be used with a Flex-Edge work surface. Attachment hardware is included. The storable tray has a horizontal adjustment and a fixed height at 5/16" below the bottom of the work surface. The adjustable/storable tray has horizontal and vertical adjustments; the vertical adjustment is 5 3/4". Dimensions Width is 8"; depth is 8". Planning Considerations The adjustable/storable version has both horizontal and vertical adjustments. The storable version has only horizontal adjustment. 5 ‹«¢" TOTAL HEIGHT ADJUSTMENT 8" 8" ATTACHES TO WORK SURFACE Limitations The mouse tray should be positioned so that it does not interfere with the horizontal adjustability of any keyboard tray that is also attached to the work surface. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 456 Machine Support Tools A-Style Keyboard Drawer AO479. Description This drawer mounts under a panel-hung or freestanding work surface to store a detached keyboard. It cannot mount under a 24"- or 30"-wide rectangular work surface or a 36"-wide corner work surface. Mounting hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 27 7/8". Depth is 14 5/8". Height is 3 1/4". Planning Considerations This keyboard drawer slides in and out to store a detachable keyboard after use. The housing for the keyboard drawer is fixed in position below the work surface. To assure sufficient knee clearance, consider the dimensions of the housing. SLIDES IN AND OUT Limitations The keyboard tray does not adjust horizontally or vertically; therefore, it does not easily accommodate workers in wheelchairs or with special needs, nor does it offer as much relief for workers with computer-intensive jobs. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 457 Machine Support Tools CPU Holder, Adjustable G7810. Description This holder mounts under a work surface and holds a computer processing unit (CPU). The holder slides out 11 1/2" and swivels 360° for easier access to connections at the back of the CPU. Straps on the holder support a CPU of up to 65 pounds and a maximum outside dimension of 60". Finish is black umber. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 5 3/8". Depth is 13 1/4". Perimeter (with straps extended) is 60" maximum. Planning Considerations This CPU holder fits beneath any type of work surface (wall attached or freestanding), including returns. CAN BE ATTACHED TOWARD REAR OF WORK SURFACE TO MINIMIZE VISIBILITY AND MAXIMIZE LEGROOM The CPU holder can be attached toward the rear of the work surface, making the CPU less visible and giving the user more legroom. This CPU holder accommodates CPUs up to 65 pounds and up to 60" in circumference. STRAPS EXPAND TO HOLD CPUS UP TO 60" CIRCUMFERENCE Limitations On narrower work surfaces, the CPU holder extends further to the front, minimizing legroom beneath the work surface. Attachment under the Relay highperformance table desk is not recommended. The adjustable CPU holder cannot be attached to all Arrio freestanding work surface sizes. (See the “Attaching Machine Support Tools” matrix in the Arrio Freestanding Systems Furniture Planning Guide to determine compatibility with specific work surfaces.) L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 458 Machine Support Tools CPU Holder NP280. Description This wire-formed steel rack mounts under a 24"- or 30"-deep Action Office work surface, 24"- or 30"-deep Ethospace bullnose work surface, or 30"-deep Action Office freestanding table. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 7". Height is 23". Depth is 19". Planning Considerations On deeper work surfaces, the CPU holder can be attached toward the rear of the work surface, making the CPU slightly less visible and giving the user more legroom. This CPU holder accommodates the weight of any CPU that fits the dimensions of the holder. Limitations On narrower work surfaces, the CPU holder extends further to the front, minimizing legroom beneath the work surface. L CAN BE ATTACHED TOWARD REAR OF WORK SURFACE TO MINIMIZE VISIBILITY AND MAXIMIZE LEGROOM Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 459 Machine Support Tools Scooter® Stand M1100. Description This mobile, adjustable platform holds a detached keyboard and stores under a work surface or table desk in the lowered position. Shipped knocked down. Dimensions Width of base is 24"; depth is 14". Width of tray is 22"; depth is 11". Height is adjustable from 22" to 30". Planning Considerations This stand can hold a keyboard or a telephone or other small ancillary office equipment (calculator, dictaphone, etc.) or be used as a lectern, an ancillary work surface, a personal work desk, or a training desk. IN LOWERED POSITION, CAN BE STORED BENEATH WORK SURFACE This mobile stand tilts to four positions within a 20° range; this adjustability accommodates most workers, including workers with special reach and access needs and wheelchair users. The stand accommodates the Scooter document stand, ordered separately. Options Order the optional Scooter Document Stand (M1190.) separately. Limitations The keyboard tray palm rest does not fit on the Scooter stand. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 460 Machine Support Tools Scooter Document Stand M1190. Description This stand attaches to the base of the Scooter platform for document display and stores below the platform when not in use. It includes an elastic band cursor. Dimensions Width is 17 1/2". Depth is 4 3/8". Height is 10 7/8". Planning Considerations The document stand automatically locks in place when rotated upward. The elastic-band cursor stretches the width of the stand for reading documents up to 15" wide. L ELASTIC-BAND CURSOR FOR EASE OF READING DOCUMENT STAND PIVOTS DOWN AND BEHIND SCOOTER STAND WHEN NOT IN USE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 461 Machine Support Tools Freestanding Monitor Lift NP494. Description This monitor lift sits on a work surface. It has a counterbalance mechanism that permits the user to raise or lower 15 to 35 pounds of equipment over a 7" height range. The monitor lift includes a nonskid mat to keep equipment from sliding in the tray. Dimensions For bottom tray: • Width is 10". • Depth is 12 3/4" For monitor tray: • Width is 12 3/4". • Depth is 12 3/4" Lift height adjustment is 7". 7" HEIGHT RANGE Planning Considerations Because it is freestanding, this monitor lift enables any work surface to provide an adjustable-height platform for computer equipment. The monitor lift is not secured to the work surface; therefore, it can be positioned to suit the exact needs and work habits of the individual user. It does not require the work surface to be physically altered to accommodate the monitor lift. NOT PHYSICALLY SECURED TO WORK SURFACE NON-SKID MAT L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 462 Machine Support Tools Machine Support Tray G7710. Description This freestanding tray supports a computer monitor or other electronic equipment. It rotates 349° and tilts within a 20° range. Dimensions Width and depth are 18 1/8". Height is adjustable to 4 3/4". Planning Considerations The nonskid surface prevents slipping. The adjustability that this tray provides for a computer monitor is particularly helpful to workers with visual and musculoskeletal impairments. Two 3" wire access holes manage wires and cables, and an automatic pivot stop prevents tangled wires. L WIRE ACCESS HOLES MANAGE WIRES AND CABLES Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 463 Machine Support Tools Turntable G7712. Description This freestanding platform holds a computer monitor and rotates 349° for shared use. Dimensions Width is 18". Depth is 30 1/8". Height is 1 7/8". Planning Considerations A 2" wire access hole manages wires and cables, and an automatic pivot stop prevents tangled wires. REQUIRES MINIMUM 35" CLEARANCE For use in an open panel frame, the turntable requires a minimum 35" inside panel frame clearance. Use with an open panel frame requires a pass-through cover. L REQUIRES PASS-THROUGH COVER WHEN USED WITH OPEN PANEL FRAME Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 464 Work Tools Introduction Work Tools Introduction Easily movable work tools maximize the efficiency of work areas, organize the work process, and provide additional usable space by keeping materials off the work surface. In addition, work tools can fill the special needs of workers with disabilities by putting items closer to their reach and by limiting or reducing the weight and volume to be lifted. These tools can also help organize the work sequence for persons with cognitive or visual impairment. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 465 Work Tools Rail Tools Rail Tools Rail-hung work tools provide accessible yet out-of-the-way storage, organization of often-used items, and space for visual display. Rail tools hang from the rail on a tool bar, which itself attaches to either a panel or a wall strip. In placing tool bar-hung work tools effectively, consider the depth of the tools, which affects usable work surface space, and how the tools attach to the tool bar, which affects the use of vertical space. When a tool bar is used over a work surface, place deeper tool bar tools to the side and shallower tools in the center. This provides an unobstructed primary work area and accessible storage. Tool bars and work tools allow optimum placement of tools and materials for workers with visual, reach, or mobility limitations. SHALLOW TOOLS TOWARD CENTER WIDER TOOLS AT SIDES ALL TOOLS EASILY ACCESSIBLE—WITH PLENTY OF ROOM ON WORK SURFACE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 466 Work Tools Rail Tools Placing a tool bar adjacent to a work surface makes use of corner space that is often wasted; this is especially important in a small workstation. Deeper rail tools can provide substantial storage without decreasing the amount of primary work area. TOOL BAR MAKES USE OF CORNER SPACE Tools placed on tool bars outside a workstation provide a drop-off or pick-up point that can minimize work interruptions. The outside tool bar can also provide display or storage space. On an open shelf, deeper rail tools allow for the efficient use of space. WORK TOOLS OUTSIDE OFFICE MINIMIZE INTERRUPTIONS AND ADD CONVENIENCE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 467 Work Tools Rail Tools Tool Bar A3610. Description This tool bar attaches to a panel or wall strips and has one rail to hold work tools. Dimensions Available in 24", 30", 36", 42", 48", and 60" widths to match all standard panel widths. Height is 3 1/2". Depth is 1 1/2". Planning Considerations The tool bar attaches to the panel hanger slots that are at 1" increments. Order work tools separately. Limitations The tool bar cannot be used within a flipper door unit. L ATTACHES TO SLOTTED HANGER RAIL AT END OF EACH PANEL—ADJUSTABLE IN 1" INCREMENTS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 468 Work Tools Rail Tools Paper Tray G7110. Description This tray hangs from a rail or stands alone to horizontally store letter- or legal-size papers. The tray comes with four clips that allow trays to stack vertically. ATTACHES AT TOP Dimensions Available in 10" and 16" widths. Height is 2 7/8". CAN BE STACKED Depth is 12 1/4". CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING ON SHELF OR WORK SURFACE Paper Tray, Metal G7111. Description This tray hangs from a rail to store folders and documents. Each tray has a front lip for labeling. Package contains six. 9" (229) 11" (279) ATTACHES AT TOP Dimensions Available in 4" (nominal), 6", and 9" widths; actual width of 4" tray is 3 3/4". TOP 2-3/4" (70) SIDE Height is nominal 2 3/4". Depth is 9" on the 4"- and 6"-wide trays and 11" on the 9"-wide tray. 3-3/4" (95) 6" (152) 9" (229) TOP TOP 2-3/4" (70) SIDE L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 469 Work Tools Rail Tools ATTACHES AT TOP Vertical Tray G7120. Description This tray hangs from a rail or stands alone to vertically store papers, binders, and folders. Dimensions Available in 4" and 8" widths. Height is 7 5/8". Depth is 12 1/4". SHELF Planning Considerations Because the trays extend beyond the front edge of the shelf when placed straight on, they will not allow a flipper door to close tightly. The trays can be placed completely inside a flipper door unit if used sideways. CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING Vertical Tray, Metal NP282. Description This tray hangs from a tool bar, rail tile, or rail, or it stands alone to hold small forms. Dimensions Width is 4". Height is 4 1/2". Depth is 9". ATTACHES AT TOP Planning Considerations The bottom lip extends beyond the sides of the tray to provide easy access to forms. SHELF CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 470 Work Tools Rail Tools Diagonal Tray G7130. ATTACHES HERE Description This tray hangs from a rail or stands alone to store papers and folders. It has three transparent dividers that move to support left- or right-handed activities. Dimensions Width is 13 1/4". Height is 10 1/8". Depth is 12 1/8". SHELF CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING Diagonal Tray NP283. Description This tray hangs from a tool bar, rail tile, or rail, or it stands alone to hold small forms. Dimensions Width is 10". Height is 2 1/4". Depths are 6" and 9". Planning Considerations Forms held in the tray can be slanted to the left or right, depending on the user's work preference. ATTACHES AT TOP SHELF CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 471 Work Tools Rail Tools Arch G7150. Description This arch hangs from a rail to hold papers, folders, binders, and books. Package contains four. Dimensions Double arch is 7" wide, 7 1/4" high, and 4 1/2" deep. Triple arch is 10" wide, 10" high, and 5 3/4" deep. ATTACHES AT MIDDLE Planning Considerations The arch is available with two or three arched dividers. Organizer Tray G7210. Description This sectioned tray hangs from a rail to store and organize small items. Dimensions Width is 11 1/4". Height is 1". Depth is 6 5/8". L ATTACHES AT TOP Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 472 Work Tools Rail Tools Mini-Shelf G7310. Description This shelf hangs from a rail to hold or display small items. Dimensions Available in 15", 24", and 30" widths. Height is 2 5/8". Depth is 6 1/2". ATTACHES AT TOP Planning Considerations For vertical storage, use a 5"-deep rail divider above the mini-shelf. Certain applications restrict the use of the mini-shelf to only the top rail of the Newhouse Group tool fence. For appropriate applications, see the Newhouse Group Furniture Planning Guide. Options To divide items on the mini-shelf, order the small-size Rail Divider (G7320.05) separately. L CAN BE USED WITH SMALL RAIL DIVIDERS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 473 Work Tools Rail Tools Rail Divider G7320. Description This divider hangs from a rail to separate books, folders, and binders on a shelf. Dimensions Small divider is 1" wide, 2 1/2" high, and 5" deep. Large divider is 2" wide, 5 3/8" high, and 10" deep. ATTACHES AT TOP AND BOTTOM SMALL DIVIDERS CAN BE USED WITH MINI-SHELF Planning Considerations The 5" depth is for use with the minishelf; the 10" depth is for use with the 15 1/2"-high shelf. LARGE DIVIDERS CAN BE USED WITH 15 ⁄«™"-HIGH SHELF AND… L …ABOVE WORK SURFACE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 474 Work Tools Rail Tools Mini-Tackboard G7410. Description This cork surface snaps onto a rail to display notes and other small papers. Dimensions Width is 10". ATTACHES AT TOP AND BOTTOM Height is 3". Depth is 1/4". Message Holder G7411. Description This holder hangs from a rail and has three arches to hold message pads and notes. Package contains four. ATTACHES AT MIDDLE Dimensions Width is 2 1/2". Height is 4 3/8". Depth is 2 7/8". Day Calendar Holder G7412. ATTACHES AT TOP Description This holder hangs from a rail or sits on a work surface to hold standard 3 1/2" x 6" calendar refills. Package contains four; calendar refills are not included. Dimensions Width is 7 5/8". Height is 3 3/4". Depth is 7 1/2". L CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 475 Work Tools Rail Tools Card File G7413. Description This file hangs from a rail or sits on a work surface to hold standard 2 1/4" x 4" cards. Package contains four; cards are not included. ATTACHES AT TOP Dimensions Width is 3". Height is 2". CAN ALSO BE FREESTANDING Depth is 7 1/4". Tape Dispenser G7414. Description This dispenser hangs from a rail and holds 3/4"-wide tape. Package contains four; tape is not included. Dimensions Width is 1 5/8". ATTACHES AT TOP Height is 2 7/8". Depth is 5 3/8". Hanger Peg G7149. Description This peg twist-locks into place on a rail to hold clipboards, keys, scissors, or other small items. Package contains four. Dimensions Width is 3/4". Height is 1 1/2". Depth is 1 1/4". L HOLDS FABRIC SWATCHES, KEYS, OR OTHER SMALL ITEMS Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 476 Work Tools Armature Tools Armature Tools HOLDS TELEPHONE TRAY OR DOCUMENT STAND OFF WORK SURFACE ARMATURE ATTACHES TO WORK SURFACE AT BACK OR SIDES The armature, a movable support arm, holds a variety of organizing tools above the work surface. The armature allows tools not in use to be moved easily out of the way. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 477 Work Tools Armature Tools Armature G7510. Description This armature attaches to a hanging or freestanding work surface, credenza, or Arrio work surface to elevate a document stand or telephone tray. Attachment hardware is included. Dimensions Width is 12 7/8", adjustable to 19". Height is 4 3/8". Planning Considerations The armature pivots 360° and extends 6" from the initial position. The armature frees space on the work surface and brings documents and phone equipment into closer reach— these benefits are particularly advantageous for workers with limited reach. HOLDS TELEPHONE TRAY OR DOCUMENT STAND OFF WORK SURFACE When squared-edge work surfaces with grommets are used with Series 3 panels, the fit is tight between the work surface and the panel. An alternative is to attach the armature in the space created by the grommet, although the room left for cable passage will be less. With other work surfaces, there is enough room between the work surface and the panel or frame to accept the armature. Options Order these products separately: • Document Stand (G7610.) • Telephone Tray (G7630.) Limitation The armature cannot clamp onto the side of a wall-attached or Arrio work surface at the point where the work surface support or leg is attached or onto the side of a wall-attached work surface when a work surface support panel is used. L Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 478 Work Tools Armature Tools Document Stand G7610. Description This adjustable, translucent stand attaches to an armature to hold documents. It includes a horizontal cursor. Dimensions Width is 10 1/2". Height is 12". Planning Considerations The total vertical adjustment is 5 1/2". When the document stand is raised to the maximum height it will pivot 330°; at all other heights it will pivot 180°. The stand tilts back from a vertical position. The document stand must be attached to an armature. Order the Armature (G7510.) to attach the document stand to an Action Office, Ethospace, or Arrio freestanding systems work surface or to a Relay work surface or credenza. Order the Armature (D4294.) to attach the stand to a Newhouse Group table desk with cable port or the table with adjustable keyboard tray. L TOTAL VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT IS 5 ⁄«™" Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 479 Work Tools Armature Tools Telephone Tray G7630. Description This tray attaches to an armature to hold a telephone. Dimensions Available in 9" (nominal) and 13" widths. Actual width of 9" tray is 8 7/8"; actual width of 13" tray is 13". Actual depth of 9" tray is 10 3/8"; actual depth of 13" tray is 9 1/2". Planning Considerations The 13"-wide telephone tray features a forward tilt and includes a receiver rest that mounts on the front of the tray. FOR STANDARD-SIZE TELEPHONE The 9"-wide telephone tray does not have a forward tilt and does not include a receiver rest. Both trays pivot 210°. Both telephone trays must be attached to an armature. Order the Armature (G7510.) to attach the tray to an Action Office, Ethospace, or Arrio freestanding systems work surface or to a Relay work surface or credenza. Order the Armature (D4294.) to attach the tray to a Newhouse Group table desk with cable port or the table with adjustable keyboard tray. L FORWARD-TILT MECHANISM RECEIVER REST SIZED TO HOLD LARGE-SET TELEPHONE Action Office® Series 2 Planning Guide 480